Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you drive off, please familiarise yourself with your vehicle and read this manual,
especially the safety and warning notices.
This will help you to obtain the maximum
pleasure from your vehicle and to avoid
endangering yourself and others.
The equipment or product designation of your
vehicle may vary depending on:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
specification
Ravailability
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art.
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
You cannot therefore base any claims on the
data, illustrations or descriptions contained
in this manual.
The following are integral parts of the vehicle:
ROwner's
Manual
Instructions
RService Booklet
RSupplements relating to vehicle equipment
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. When you sell the vehicle, always pass
the documents on to the new owner.
RBrief
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in the interactive Owner's Manual on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.de/
betriebsanleitung
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
2185840281Z102 É2185840281Z1028ËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 23
Introduction ......................................... 19
Safety ................................................... 33
Opening and closing ........................... 67
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 83
Lights and windscreen wipers ........... 97
Climate control ................................. 109
Driving and parking .......................... 127
On-board computer and displays .... 193
Stowing and features ....................... 247
Maintenance and care ...................... 265
Breakdown assistance ..................... 277
Wheels and tyres .............................. 301
Technical data ................................... 315
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket ........................................ 258
4ETS
see ETS/4ETS
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 219
Function/notes ................................ 57
Warning lamp ................................. 241
Active Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 204
Display message ............................ 229
Function/notes ............................. 186
Active Driving Assistance package . 186
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 205
Display message ............................ 228
Function/information .................... 189
Active multicontour seat .................... 88
Active Park Assist
Display message ............................ 229
Active Parking Assist
Function/notes ............................. 173
Active Service System PLUS
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 61
Adaptive brake lamps ......................... 58
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 100
Adaptive Main-Beam Assist
Display message ............................ 223
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 208
Additives
Engine oil ....................................... 321
Airbag
Important safety guidelines ............. 36
Airbags
Activation ......................................... 35
Front airbag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 38
Kneebag ........................................... 38
Pelvis airbag .................................... 39
Sidebag ............................................ 38
Windowbag ...................................... 39
Air conditioning
3-zone THERMOTRONIC luxury
automatic air conditioning ............. 112
Activating/deactivating ................. 113
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode ................................ 117
Auxiliary heating/ventilation .......... 119
Controlling automatically ............... 114
Cooling with air dehumidification . . 114
Demisting the windscreen ............. 116
Rear control panel ......................... 113
Setting the air distribution ............. 115
Setting the airflow ......................... 116
Setting the air vents ...................... 124
Setting the temperature ................ 115
Setting the temperature (rear
compartment) ................................ 115
Switching the residual heat function on/off ..................................... 118
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate control .................................. 111
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air dehumidification
Activating/deactivating with cooling ................................................. 114
Air distribution
Setting ........................................... 115
Air filter (white display message) .... 225
Airflow
Setting ........................................... 116
AIR FLOW ........................................... 114
AIRMATIC
Display message ............................ 226
Function/notes ............................. 167
Suspension tuning ......................... 168
Vehicle level .................................. 167
Air pressure
see Tyre pressure
Air-recirculation mode
Activating/deactivating ................. 117
Air vents ............................................. 124
Glove compartment ....................... 124
Important safety information ......... 123
Rear ............................................... 124
Index
Setting the centre air vents ........... 124
Setting the side air vents ............... 124
Alarm system
see ATA
Alertness Assistant
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 208
Setting the colour (on-board computer) ............................................. 208
AMGMenu (on-board computer) ....... 212
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension (CLS 63 AMG) ...................... 169
Anti-glare film .................................... 264
Anti-lock Brake System
see ABS
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA
Anti-theft system
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 63
Immobiliser ...................................... 63
Interior motion sensor ..................... 64
Tow-away protection ........................ 64
Aquaplaning ....................................... 151
Ashtray ............................................... 257
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 203
ASSYST PLUS
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
ASSYST PLUS service interval display ..................................................... 269
Displaying a service message (onboard computer) ............................ 270
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 63
Function ........................................... 63
Switching off the alarm .................... 63
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 204
Display message ............................ 226
Function/notes ............................. 177
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 200
Automatic car wash .......................... 271
Automatic engine start
With ECO start/stop function ........
Automatic engine switch-off
With ECO start/stop function ........
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever .....................
Display message ............................
Driving tips ....................................
Emergency running mode ..............
Kickdown .......................................
Malfunction ....................................
Program selector button ................
Pulling away ...................................
Selector lever ................................
Starting ..........................................
Auxiliary heating ...............................
Adjusting (on-board computer) ......
Display message ............................
Important safety information .........
Auxiliary heating/ventilation ...........
Display message ............................
Remote control ..............................
Auxiliary ventilation ..........................
133
132
136
234
138
142
138
142
138
131
136
130
119
210
236
119
120
123
120
119
B
Bag hook ............................................ 252
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 57
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
Plus) ...................................................... 57
Battery
Changing (auxiliary heating
remote control) .............................. 121
Changing (key) ................................. 71
Charging ........................................ 292
Checking (key) ................................. 70
Disconnecting ................................ 292
Display message ............................ 225
Important safety guidelines (key) ..... 70
Installation location ....................... 291
Jump-starting ................................. 294
Reconnecting ................................. 293
Removing/fitting ........................... 292
Safety notes .................................. 290
Belt
see Seat belt
5
6
Index
Belt tensioner
Activation ......................................... 35
Function ........................................... 45
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 204
Display message ............................ 229
Function/notes ............................. 183
Bonnet
Closing ........................................... 267
Display message ............................ 235
Opening ......................................... 266
Boot
Automatic opening ........................... 76
Emergency release .......................... 77
Important safety guidelines ............. 75
Opening automatically from
inside ............................................... 77
Boot lid
Display message ............................ 235
Opening dimensions ...................... 326
Boot load (maximum) ........................ 323
Bottle holder ...................................... 256
Box (boot) ........................................... 252
Brake fluid
Notes ............................................. 322
Brake lamps
Adaptive ........................................... 58
Display message ............................ 222
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 57
BAS .................................................. 57
BAS PLUS ........................................ 57
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 322
Display message ............................ 220
High-performance brake system .... 150
Important safety notes .................. 149
Parking brake ................................ 148
Warning lamp ................................. 238
Breakdown
see Flat tyre
Bulbs
Overview ........................................ 105
C
Care
Automatic car wash ....................... 271
Display ........................................... 274
Exterior lighting ............................. 273
High-pressure cleaner .................... 272
Matt paintwork .............................. 272
Night View Assist Plus ................... 274
Notes ............................................. 270
Paint .............................................. 272
Plastic trim .................................... 275
Reversing camera .......................... 274
Seat belt ........................................ 276
Seat covers .................................... 275
Sensors ......................................... 274
Tail pipes ....................................... 274
Trim strips ..................................... 275
Wheels ........................................... 272
Windows ........................................ 273
Wiper blades .................................. 273
Wooden trim .................................. 275
CD player/CD changer(on-board
computer) .......................................... 201
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 209
Key .................................................. 68
Central unlocking
Key .................................................. 68
Centre console ..................................... 30
Changing bulbs
Headlamps ..................................... 104
Changing gears .................................. 138
Child-proof locks
Rear doors ....................................... 55
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 46
Restraint systems ............................ 46
Child seat
Automatic recognition ..................... 48
Display message ............................ 217
ISOFIX .............................................. 49
On the front-passenger seat ............ 47
Recommendations ........................... 54
Suitable positions ............................ 52
Troubleshooting ............................... 51
Cigarette lighter ................................ 258
Index
Climate control
Activating/deactivating rear window heating ................................... 117
Activating/deactivating the auxiliary heating/ventilation ................. 120
Convenience opening/closing (air
recirculation) ................................. 118
Demisting the windows .................. 117
Important safety information ......... 110
Indicator lamp ................................ 114
Problems with "cooling with air
dehumidification" ........................... 114
Problems with the rear window
heating .......................................... 117
Setting the climate mode (AIR
FLOW) ............................................ 114
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 116
Clock (on-board computer) ............... 206
Cockpit ................................................. 24
Collapsible spare wheel
see Emergency spare wheel
Combination switch ............................ 99
Constant headlamp mode
see Daytime driving lights
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 198
Convenience box ............................... 252
Convenience closing feature .............. 79
Convenience opening/closing
Air-recirculation mode ................... 118
Convenience opening feature ............ 79
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 268
Display message ............................ 224
Notes ............................................. 322
Temperature (on-board computer) . 212
Temperature gauge ........................ 194
Warning lamp ................................. 244
Cooling
see Climate control
Cornering light function (display
message) ............................................ 221
Crash-responsive emergency lighting ....................................................... 104
Cruise control
Cruise control lever .......................
Display message ............................
Cup holder .........................................
Centre console ..............................
Rear compartment .........................
Current fuel consumption (onboard computer) ...............................
152
231
255
255
255
198
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Data, technical ..................................
Date (on-board computer) ................
Daytime driving lights
Display message ............................
Switching on/off (on-board computer) .............................................
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer) .............................................
Interior lighting (on-board computer) .............................................
Diesel particle filter ..........................
Digital speedometer .........................
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message ............................
Setting for driving on the right/
left (on-board computer) ................
DIRECT SELECT lever
see Automatic transmission
Display (cleaning instructions) ........
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS service interval display ................................................
Brakes ...........................................
Calling up (on-board computer) .....
Clearing (on-board computer) ........
Driving systems .............................
Engine ............................................
Key ................................................
KEYLESS-GO ..................................
Lamps ............................................
Safety systems ..............................
Tyres ..............................................
Vehicle ...........................................
316
206
223
207
208
209
149
198
221
207
274
269
219
215
215
226
224
236
236
221
215
232
234
7
8
Index
Distance warning signal (warning
lamp) .................................................. 246
DISTRONIC PLUS
Deactivating ................................... 160
Display message ............................ 230
Displays in the multifunction display ................................................ 160
Driving tips .................................... 161
Function/notes ............................. 154
Setting the specified minimum
distance ......................................... 159
Warning lamp ................................. 246
Door
Automatic locking ............................ 74
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 209
Display message ............................ 235
Emergency locking ........................... 75
Emergency unlocking ....................... 75
Opening (from the inside) ................ 74
Door control panel
Overview .......................................... 32
Doors
Important safety notes .................... 73
Drinks holder
see Cup holder
Drive program
Automatic ...................................... 139
Manual ........................................... 141
Drive program display ...................... 136
Drive system
Active Blind Spot Assist ................. 186
Driving on flooded roads .................. 151
Driving safety system
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist System
PLUS) ............................................... 57
Electronic Brake-force Distribution .................................................. 61
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 58
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction
System) ........................................... 59
Important safety guidelines ............. 56
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 57
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 61
Adaptive brake lamps ...................... 58
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 57
Overview .......................................... 56
PRE-SAFE® Brake ............................. 61
Driving system
Active Lane Keeping Assist ............ 189
Active Parking Assist ..................... 173
Driving systems
Active Driving Assistance package ................................................. 186
AIRMATIC ...................................... 167
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension (CLS 63 AMG) .................. 169
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 177
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 183
Cruise control ................................ 152
Distronic Plus ................................ 154
HOLD function ............................... 165
Lane Keeping Assist ...................... 185
Lane package ................................ 183
Night View Assist Plus ................... 180
Parktronic ...................................... 170
RACE START (AMG vehicles) .......... 166
Reversing camera .......................... 176
Speed Limit Assist ......................... 178
Speedtronic ................................... 162
Driving tips ........................................ 138
Braking .......................................... 150
Distronic Plus ................................ 161
Downhill gradients ......................... 149
Driving on flooded roads ................ 151
Wet road surface ........................... 150
Winter ............................................ 151
DVD audio (on-board computer) ...... 201
E
EASY-ENTRY feature ............................ 92
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 211
EASY-EXIT feature ............................... 92
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 211
Crash-responsive ............................. 92
EASY-PACK convenience box ........... 252
EASY-PACK quickfold ........................ 251
Index
EBD (Electronic Brake-force Distribution)
Display message ............................ 220
Function/notes ................................ 61
ECO start/stop function
General information ....................... 131
Switching on/off (AMG vehicles) ... 133
Switching on/off (except AMG
vehicles) ........................................ 133
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electronic Brake-force Distribution
see EBD
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP®
Electronic Traction System
see ETS/4ETS
Emergency key element
Function/notes ................................ 69
Emergency locking
Vehicle ............................................. 75
Emergency release
Fuel filler flap ................................. 145
Emergency running mode
Automatic transmission ................. 142
Emergency spare wheel
Inflating the collapsible spare
wheel ............................................. 288
Notes/data .................................... 313
Storage location ............................ 280
Stowing .......................................... 280
Emergency unlocking
Boot ................................................. 77
Vehicle ............................................. 75
Engine
Running irregularly ......................... 134
Starting problems .......................... 134
Starting the engine with the key .... 130
Starting with KEYLESS GO ............. 130
Stopping ........................................ 148
Warning lamp (engine diagnostics) ............................................... 244
Engine electronics ............................. 316
Malfunction .................................... 134
Engine number .................................. 319
Engine oil
Additives ........................................ 321
Checking the oil level ..................... 267
Display message ............................ 225
Filling capacity ............................... 321
Notes about oil grades ................... 320
Temperature (on-board computer) . 212
Topping up ..................................... 268
Viscosity ........................................ 321
Environmental protection
Note ................................................. 19
Returning an end-of-life vehicle ....... 19
Error messages
see Display messages
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 60
Activating/deactivating (except
AMG vehicles) .................................. 59
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 204
ETS/4ETS ........................................ 59
Important safety guidelines ............. 58
Warning lamp ................................. 242
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System) ...................................................... 59
Exhaust tail pipe (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 274
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ......................................... 93
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) .......... 94
Folding in/out (automatically) ......... 93
Folding in/out (electrically) ............. 93
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer) ...................................... 211
Out of position ................................. 94
Parking position ............................... 94
Resetting ......................................... 93
Storing settings (memory function) ................................................. 95
F
Fatigue Assist
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Fire extinguisher ............................... 278
First-aid kit ......................................... 278
9
10
Index
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the
spare wheel ................................... 284
MOExtended tyres (tyres with runflat characteristics) ........................ 289
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 281
Raising the vehicle ......................... 285
TIREFIT kit ...................................... 281
Floormat ............................................. 264
Frequencies
Garage door opener ....................... 264
Mobile phone ................................. 317
Two-way radio ................................ 317
Fuel
Notes ............................................. 319
Notes about consumption ............. 320
Refuelling ....................................... 142
Tank content/reserve fuel ............. 319
Troubleshooting ............................. 146
Fuel consumption
Current (on-board computer) ......... 198
see Technical data
Fuel filler flap
Emergency release ........................ 145
Opening/closing ............................ 144
Fuel filter (white display message) . 225
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer) ...................................... 198
Gauge .............................................. 26
Fuel tank
Capacity ........................................ 319
Fuse allocation chart (vehicle tool
kit) ...................................................... 279
Fuses
Fuse box in the boot ...................... 299
Fuse box in the engine compartment .............................................. 299
Notes ............................................. 298
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ..................... 263
Frequencies ................................... 264
Notes ............................................. 261
Opening/closing the garage door ..
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ...................................
Gear indicator (on-board computer) ..................................................
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Genuine wood trim and trim strips
(cleaning instructions) ......................
Glove compartment ..........................
262
261
212
316
275
248
H
Hazard warning lamps ...................... 101
Headlamp cleaning system .............. 102
Headlamp flasher .............................. 101
Headlamps
Misting up ...................................... 103
Head restraints
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 86
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 86
Adjusting (rear) ................................ 87
Fitting/removing (rear) .................... 87
Luxury .............................................. 87
see NECK-PRO head restraints/
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Heating
see Air conditioning
High-pressure cleaners .................... 272
Hill start assist .................................. 131
HOLD function
Display message ............................ 227
Function/notes ............................. 165
I
Immobiliser .......................................... 63
Indicator and warning lamps
ABS ................................................ 241
Brakes ........................................... 238
Coolant .......................................... 244
Distance warning signal ................. 246
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 246
Engine diagnostics ......................... 244
ESP® .............................................. 242
ESP® OFF ....................................... 243
Fuel tank ........................................ 244
Overview .......................................... 28
Reserve fuel ................................... 244
Index
Seat belt ........................................ 239
SPORT handling mode ................... 243
SRS ................................................ 243
Tyre pressure monitor ................... 246
Instrument cluster
Displays ........................................... 26
Overview .......................................... 26
Submenu (on-board computer) ...... 205
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 28
Intelligent Light System
Display message ............................ 223
Setting dipped-beam headlamps
for driving on the right/left (onboard computer) ............................ 207
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 207
Interior lighting
Automatic control system .............. 104
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 209
Emergency lighting ........................ 104
Manual control ............................... 104
Reading lamp ................................. 103
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) ....... 206
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 208
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 208
Interior motion sensor ........................ 64
ISOFIX child seat securing system .... 49
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 279
Using ............................................. 285
Jump-starting ..................................... 294
see Jump-starting
K
Key
Changing the battery ....................... 71
Checking the battery ....................... 70
Convenience closing feature ............ 79
Convenience opening feature .......... 79
Display message ............................ 236
Malfunction ...................................... 72
Modifying the programming ............. 69
Starting the engine ........................ 130
KEYLESS-GO
Button ............................................ 129
Convenience closing ........................ 79
Display message ............................ 236
Locking ............................................ 69
Starting the engine ........................ 130
Unlocking ......................................... 69
Key positions
Key ................................................ 129
KEYLESS GO .................................. 129
Kickdown ................................... 138, 141
Kneebag ............................................... 38
L
Lane-change assistant
see Active Blind Spot Assist
see Blind Spot Assist
Lane Keeping Assist
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 205
Display message ............................ 228
Function/information .................... 185
Lane package ..................................... 183
Lashing eyelets ................................. 252
Lights
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
(on-board computer) ...................... 209
Active light function ....................... 102
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 99
Cornering light function ................. 102
Daytime driving lights ...................... 99
Dipped-beam headlamps ................. 99
Driving abroad ................................. 98
Foglamps (extended range) ........... 103
Hazard warning lamps ................... 101
Light switch ..................................... 98
Main-beam headlamps ................... 100
Motorway mode ............................. 103
Rear foglamp ................................... 99
Setting brightness for display/
switches (on-board computer) ....... 206
Setting the ambient lighting
brightness (on-board computer) .... 208
11
12
Index
Setting the ambient lighting colour (on-board computer) ................ 208
Switching the Adaptive Highbeam
Assist on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 208
Switching the daytime driving
lights on/off (on-board computer) . 207
Switching the exterior lighting
delayed switch-off on/off (onboard computer) ............................ 208
Switching the Intelligent Light
System on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 207
Switching the surround lighting
on/off (on-board computer) .......... 208
Light sensor (display message) ....... 223
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control ................................ 152
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 155
Variable SPEEDTRONIC ................. 163
Loading guidelines ............................ 248
Locking
Automatic ........................................ 74
Emergency locking ........................... 75
From the inside (central locking
button) ............................................. 74
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 209
Lubricant additives
see Additives
Luggage net ....................................... 250
Lumbar support ................................... 89
4-way lumbar support ...................... 89
Luxury head restraint ......................... 87
M
M+S tyres ........................................... 303
Main-beam headlamps
Display message ............................ 222
Malfunctions
see Display messages
Manual drive program ...................... 141
Massage function (PULSE) ................. 88
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) . . 272
Memory card (on-board computer) . 201
Memory function ................................. 95
Menu (on-board computer)
AMG ............................................... 212
Assistance ..................................... 203
Audio ............................................. 200
DISTRONIC PLUS ........................... 160
DVD ............................................... 201
Menu overview .............................. 197
Navigation ..................................... 199
Service ........................................... 205
Settings ......................................... 205
Telephone ...................................... 201
Trip ................................................ 198
TV .................................................. 201
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 215
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
Sun visor ........................................ 257
see Exterior mirrors or Rear-view mirror
Mobile phone ..................................... 259
Frequencies ................................... 317
Installation ..................................... 317
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 201
Transmission output (maximum) .... 317
Mobile telephone
see Mobile phone .......................... 259
Modifying the programming
Key .................................................. 69
MP3
Operating (on-board computer) ..... 201
see separate operating instructions
Multicontour seat ................................ 87
Multifunction display ........................ 196
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer . 195
Overview .......................................... 29
N
Navigation
On-board computer ....................... 199
see separate operating instructions
NECK-PRO head restraints
Operation ......................................... 41
Resetting after being triggered ........ 41
Index
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
Operation ......................................... 41
Resetting after being triggered ........ 41
Night View Assist Plus
Activating/deactivating ................. 181
Cleaning ......................................... 274
Function/notes ............................. 180
Malfunction .................................... 183
Problem ......................................... 183
Notes on running in a new vehicle . . 128
O
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 46
Important safety guidelines ............. 34
Odometer ........................................... 198
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
AMG menu ..................................... 212
Assistance menu ........................... 203
Audio menu ................................... 200
Convenience submenu .................. 211
Display messages .......................... 215
Factory settings ............................. 212
Heating submenu ........................... 210
Important safety notes .................. 194
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 205
Light submenu ............................... 207
Menu overview .............................. 197
Message memory .......................... 215
Navigation menu ............................ 199
Operating the TV ............................ 201
Operating video DVD ..................... 201
Operation ....................................... 195
Service menu ................................. 205
Settings menu ............................... 205
Standard display submenu ............ 198
Telephone menu ............................ 201
Time/Date submenu ..................... 206
Trip menu ...................................... 198
Vehicle submenu ........................... 209
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature
Display ........................................... 195
Overhead control panel
Overview .......................................... 31
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 56
P
Paint code .......................................... 318
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) . . . 272
Parking ............................................... 147
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 173
Display message ............................ 229
PARKTRONIC ................................. 170
Reversing camera .......................... 176
Parking brake .................................... 148
Display message ............................ 220
Parking lamp (display message) ...... 222
Parking position
Exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side ................................. 94
PARKTRONIC
Activating/deactivating ................. 172
Function/notes ............................. 170
Malfunction .................................... 173
Problem ......................................... 173
Sensor range ................................. 170
Warning display ............................. 171
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp ...................................................... 48
Permanent display (on-board computer) .................................................. 206
Permanent Speedtronic .................... 164
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) . 275
Power windows
see Side windows
Pre-emptive occupant safety system
see PRE-SAFE®
PRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS)
Activating/deactivating (onboard computer) ............................ 204
Display message ............................ 217
Function/notes ................................ 61
PRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS)
Warning lamp ................................. 246
13
14
Index
PRE-SAFE® system
Display message ............................ 216
Operation ......................................... 40
Program selector ............................... 139
Program selector button .................. 138
Pulling away
Automatic transmission ................. 131
R
RACE START (AMG vehicles) ............. 166
RACETIMER (on-board computer) .... 212
Radar sensor system
Country overview ........................... 327
Display message ............................ 227
Radar system sensors
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 210
Radio
Changing a station (on-board
computer) ...................................... 200
see separate operating instructions
Rain closing feature
Sliding sunroof ................................. 81
Range (on-board computer) ............. 198
Rear compartment
Setting the air vents ...................... 124
Setting the temperature ................ 115
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator ........................................ 44
Rear foglamp (display message) ...... 222
Rear-view mirror
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic) .......... 94
Dipping (manual) .............................. 92
Rear window blind ............................ 257
Rear window heating
Malfunction .................................... 117
Switching on/off ........................... 117
Refuelling ........................................... 142
Remote control
Auxiliary heating ............................ 120
Changing the batteries (auxiliary
heating) ......................................... 121
Reserve (fuel tank)
see Fuel
Reserve fuel
Display message ............................ 225
Warning lamp ................................. 244
Residual heat
Switching on/off ...........................
Restraint systems
see SRS
Rev counter ........................................
Reversing camera
Function/notes .............................
Reversing camera (cleaning
instructions) ......................................
Reversing lamp (display message) . .
Reversing lamps (changing bulbs) . .
Roller sunblind
Rear window ..................................
Roof carrier ........................................
Roof load (maximum) ........................
Route
see Route guidance (on-board
computer)
Route guidance (on-board computer) ..................................................
118
194
176
274
223
106
257
254
323
199
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 46
Child restraint systems .................... 46
Safety systems
see Driving safety systems
Seat
Active multicontour seat .................. 88
Seat backrest (rear)
Folding forwards/back .................. 251
Seat belt
Adjusting the driver's and frontpassenger seat belt ......................... 43
Belt force limiter .............................. 45
Belt tensioner .................................. 45
Cleaning ......................................... 276
Display message ............................ 215
Fastening ......................................... 43
Important safety guidelines ............. 42
Rear seat belt status indicator ......... 44
Releasing ......................................... 44
Switching belt adjustment on/off
(on-board computer) ...................... 211
Warning lamp (function) ................... 44
Index
Seat belts
Adjusting the height ......................... 44
Warning lamp ................................. 239
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 86
Adjusting lumbar support ................ 89
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support .................................................. 89
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 86
Cleaning the cover ......................... 275
Correct driver's seat position ........... 84
Important safety instructions ........... 85
Multicontour seat ............................ 87
Storing settings (memory function) ................................................. 95
Switching seat heating on/off ......... 89
Switching the seat ventilation on/
off .................................................... 90
Seat ventilation
Malfunction indicator lamp .............. 90
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 274
Service indicator
see ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
Service menu (on-board computer) . 205
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 322
Coolant (engine) ............................ 322
Engine oil ....................................... 320
Fuel ................................................ 319
Important safety notes .................. 319
Notes ............................................. 319
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 212
On-board computer ....................... 205
Shift ranges ....................................... 140
Showing the distance display (onboard computer) ............................... 203
Sidebag ................................................ 38
Side window
Important safety notes .................... 78
Side windows
Convenience closing ........................ 79
Convenience opening ...................... 79
Opening/closing .............................. 78
resetting .......................................... 80
Troubleshooting ............................... 80
Sliding sunroof
Important safety information ........... 80
Opening/closing .............................. 81
Rain closing feature ......................... 81
Resetting ......................................... 81
Troubleshooting ............................... 81
Snow chains ...................................... 304
Socket ................................................ 258
Cockpit .......................................... 258
Rear compartment ......................... 259
Spare wheel
Notes/data .................................... 313
Storage location ............................ 280
Storing ........................................... 280
see Emergency spare wheel
Speed Limit Assist
Activating/deactivating message
function (on-board computer) ........ 203
Displaying (on-board computer) ..... 203
Display message ............................ 227
Function/notes ............................. 178
Speed limiter
SPEEDTRONIC ............................... 162
Speedometer
Digital speedometer (on-board
computer) ...................................... 198
Segments ...................................... 195
Setting the unit (on-board computer) ............................................. 205
Speedtronic
Display message ............................ 231
Permanent ..................................... 164
Variable ......................................... 163
SPEEDTRONIC
Function/notes ............................. 162
SPORT handling mode
Activating/deactivating (AMG
vehicles) .......................................... 60
Warning lamp ................................. 243
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Display message ............................ 218
Introduction ..................................... 35
Warning lamp ................................. 243
Warning lamp (function) ................... 35
Standard display (on-board computer) .................................................. 198
15
16
Index
Starting the engine
Important safety notes .................. 130
Station
see Radio
Steering (display message) .............. 235
Steering wheel
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 91
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 91
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 195
Important safety instructions ........... 90
Memory function (storing settings) ................................................ 91
Steering wheel heating .................... 91
Storing settings (memory function) ................................................. 95
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .... 139
Steering wheel heating
Malfunction indicator lamp .............. 92
Stowage compartments
Armrest (under) ............................. 249
Centre console .............................. 249
Centre console (rear compartment) ............................................. 250
Cup holder ..................................... 255
Glove compartment ....................... 248
Rear ............................................... 250
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 250
Stowage space
Important safety information ......... 248
Stowage well
Boot floor (underneath) ................. 254
Submenu (on-board computer)
Convenience .................................. 211
Factory setting ............................... 212
Heating .......................................... 210
Instrument cluster ......................... 205
Lights ............................................. 207
Standard display ............................ 198
Time/Date ..................................... 206
Vehicle ........................................... 209
Summer opening
see Convenience opening feature
Summer tyres .................................... 303
Sun visor ............................................ 256
Supplemental Restraint System
see SRS
Surround lighting (on-board computer) .................................................. 208
Suspension tuning .................... 168, 169
Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 63
T
Tail lamp (display message) ............. 222
Technical data
CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY ....... 324
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY .............. 323
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY .......................................... 325
CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY ....... 325
CLS 500 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY .......................................... 323
CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY .............. 323
CLS 63 AMG .................................. 324
Notes ............................................. 316
Tyres/wheels ................................. 310
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 202
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 201
Number from the phone book ........ 202
Redialling ....................................... 203
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 202
Telephone compartment .................. 249
Temperature
Coolant .......................................... 194
Coolant (on-board computer) ......... 212
Engine oil (on-board computer) ...... 212
Outside temperature ...................... 195
Setting ........................................... 115
TEMPOMAT
Function/notes ............................. 152
Through-loading feature ................... 251
Tilt/sliding sunroof
see Sliding sunroof
Time (on-board computer) ................ 206
Timer (on-board computer) .............. 212
TIREFIT kit .......................................... 281
Top Tether ............................................ 50
Total distance recorder .................... 198
Tow-away protection .......................... 64
Towing
Important safety notes .................. 295
Index
Towing away
Fitting the towing eye .................... 296
Removing the towing eye ............... 297
Transmission position display ............................................. 136, 137
Transmission positions .................... 137
Trip computer (on-board computer) .................................................. 198
Trip meter
Calling up ....................................... 198
Resetting (on-board computer) ...... 199
Turn signal (display message) ......... 221
Turn signal lamps ................................ 99
TV
Operating (on-board computer) ..... 201
see Separate operating instructions
Two-way radio
Frequencies ................................... 317
Installation ..................................... 317
Transmission output (maximum) .... 317
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
Tyre grip ............................................. 151
Tyre pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 307
Display message ............................ 232
Not reached (TIREFIT) .................... 283
Pressure loss warning .................... 306
Reached (TIREFIT) .......................... 283
Recommended ............................... 305
Tyre pressure monitor
Function/notes ............................. 307
Restarting ...................................... 308
Warning lamp ................................. 246
Tyres
Checking ........................................ 302
Direction of rotation ...................... 310
Flat tyre ......................................... 281
MOExtended tyres (tyres with runflat characteristics) ........................ 289
Replacing ....................................... 309
Storing ........................................... 310
Tyre size (data) .............................. 310
Tyre tread ...................................... 303
Tyres and wheels (important
safety information) ........................... 302
U
Unladen weight ................................. 323
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 75
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 74
V
Vanity mirror
Sun visor ........................................ 257
Variable Speedtronic ........................ 163
Vehicle
Emergency unlocking ....................... 75
Equipment ....................................... 19
Individual settings (on-board computer) ............................................. 205
Leaving parked up ......................... 149
Lowering ........................................ 288
Raising ........................................... 285
Towing away .................................. 295
Tow-starting ................................... 295
Transporting .................................. 298
Vehicle data
see Technical data
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 323
Vehicle electronics ........................... 316
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 318
Vehicle level .............................. 167, 169
Vehicle level (display message) ....... 226
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 279
Vehicle weights ................................. 323
Vents
see Air vents .................................. 124
Video (DVD) ........................................ 201
Video DVD (on-board computer) ...... 201
VIN ...................................................... 318
W
Warning and indicator lamps
LIM (cruise control) ........................ 152
LIM (DISTRONIC PLUS) .................. 155
LIM (variable SPEEDTRONIC) ......... 163
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF ................ 48
Warning triangle ................................ 278
17
18
Index
Washer fluid (display message) ....... 236
see Washer fluid (display message)
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 288
Wheel chock ...................................... 285
Wheels
Changing/replacing ....................... 309
Changing a wheel .......................... 284
Checking ........................................ 302
Cleaning ......................................... 272
Fitting a wheel ............................... 287
Removing a wheel .......................... 286
Storing ........................................... 310
Tightening torque ........................... 288
Wheel size/tyre size ...................... 310
Windowbag
Display message ............................ 218
Operation ......................................... 39
Windows
see Side windows
Windows (cleaning instructions) ..... 273
Windscreen
Demisting ...................................... 116
Windscreen washer system ............. 269
Windscreen wipers
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 107
Switching on/off ........................... 106
Troubleshooting ............................. 107
Winter driving ............................ 151, 303
Winter tyres
Limiting the speed (on-board computer) ............................................. 209
M+S tyres ...................................... 303
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 273
Replacing ....................................... 107
Introduction
Protection of the environment
Notes
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of integrated
environmental protection.
The objectives are for the natural resources
which form the basis of our existence on this
planet to be used sparingly and in a manner
which takes the requirements of both nature
and humanity into account.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. You should
bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions
Ryour
Ravoid short trips as these increase fuel con-
sumption.
sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight.
Rkeep an eye on the vehicle's fuel consumption.
Rremove roof racks once you no longer need
them.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Ralways have maintenance work carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Personal driving style
Rmake
Rdo not depress the accelerator pedal when
starting the engine.
Rdo not warm up the engine with the vehicle
stationary.
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
frequent, sudden acceleration.
Rchange gear in good time and use each gear
only up to ⅔ of its maximum engine speed.
Rswitch off the engine in stationary traffic.
Ravoid
Returning used vehicles
Mercedes-Benz will take back your
Mercedes-Benz to dispose of it in an environmentally responsible manner, in accordance
with the European Union (EU) End of Life
Vehicles Directive.
The End of Life Vehicles Directive applies to
vehicles of up to 3.5 t gross vehicle weight, in
accordance with national regulations. For
several years, Mercedes-Benz has been
meeting all the legal requirements for a
design which allows for recycling and reuse.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants which can recycle your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner. The options for recycling vehicles and
parts are constantly being developed and
improved. This means that your MercedesBenz will also continue to meet even the
increased recycling quotas in the future in
good time. You can obtain further information
from your national Mercedes-Benz homepage
or your national hotline number.
Vehicle equipment
This manual describes all the standard and
optional equipment of your vehicle available
at the time of publication of the Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not
feature all functions described here. This also
refers to safety-related systems and functions. The equipment in your vehicle may
therefore differ from that shown in the
descriptions and illustrations. All the systems
found in your vehicle are listed in the original
Z
19
20
Introduction
purchase agreement of your vehicle. Should
you have any questions concerning equipment and operation, please consult a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Operating safety
Safety notes
G Risk of accident and injury
Always have work on the vehicle carried out
by a qualified specialist workshop. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems as well as maintenance work
must be carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. The workshop must have the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose.
G Risk of accident and injury
Some safety systems only function when the
engine is running. You should therefore never
switch off the engine when driving. Otherwise,
the safety systems of your vehicle may not
function correctly and as a result will no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In addition, there is a risk that you may
lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an
accident.
G Risk of accident and injury
Work carried out incorrectly, or alterations
made to the vehicle, e.g. re-routing of cables
under coverings, could cause the safety systems of your vehicle to stop working properly.
The safety systems would thus no longer protect you and other persons as intended. In
addition, there is a risk that you may lose control of your vehicle and thus cause an accident.
All work and alterations to the vehicle, e.g.
installations or modifications, should therefore be carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G Risk of accident
If you drive over obstacles at high speed or if
the vehicle bottoms out in rough terrain, it
could cause heavy impacts to the vehicle
underbody, tyres or wheels. This could cause
your vehicle to be damaged, which in turn
might lead to an accident. This also applies to
vehicles which are equipped with underbody
protection.
You should therefore drive over obstacles
slowly. Prevent the vehicle from bottoming
out when driving off-road and if necessary,
have your vehicle inspected at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
If work on electronic equipment and its software is carried out incorrectly, this equipment
could stop working. The electronic systems
are networked via interfaces. Tampering with
these electronic systems could cause malfunctions in systems which have not been
modified. Malfunctions such as these can
seriously jeopardise the vehicle's operating
safety and therefore your own safety.
You should therefore have all work and modifications to electronic components carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles to improve their quality or safety.
If you did not purchase your vehicle from an
authorised specialist dealer and your vehicle
has never been inspected at a MercedesBenz Service Centre, it is possible that your
vehicle is not registered in your name with
Mercedes-Benz. Mercedes-Benz can only
inform you about vehicle checks if it has your
registration data.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Introduction
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership.
(e.g. airbag deployment or ESP® intervention).
This data is used exclusively to:
Rassist
Correct use
Observe the following information when using
your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
"Technical data” section in this manual
Rnational road traffic regulations
Rnational road traffic licensing regulations
Rthe
G Risk of injury
Various warning stickers are affixed to your
vehicle. Their purpose is to draw your attention, and the attention of others, to various
dangers. Therefore, do not remove any warning stickers unless the sticker clearly states
that you may do so.
If you remove the warning stickers, you or
others could be injured by failing to recognise
certain dangers.
Implied warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions are not covered either by
Mercedes-Benz implied warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty of
Daimler AG.
in the rectification of faults and
defects
Rhelp Mercedes-Benz optimise and develop
vehicle functions
The data cannot be used to trace the vehicle's
movements.
When your vehicle is serviced by MercedesBenz, this technical information can be read
out from the fault memory. This is performed
by authorised employees of the MercedesBenz service network using special diagnostic computers.
After a fault has been rectified, the information is deleted from the memory. Other memory data is constantly overwritten.
Other devices that store data
Depending on the equipment level, your vehicle may feature communications and/or
entertainment systems (e.g. navigation devices, telephone systems). These allow you to
save and edit data required for the operation
of the respective device.
Further information on operation (e.g. on
deleting data) can be found in the separate
operating instructions.
Data stored in the vehicle
Fault data
Components critical for vehicle operation are
equipped with fault data memories as standard. There are also data storage devices
which record the technical reactions of vehicle components to certain driving situations
Z
21
22
Cockpit .................................................
Instrument cluster ..............................
Multifunction steering wheel .............
Centre console ....................................
Overhead control panel ......................
Door control panel ..............................
24
26
29
30
31
32
At a glance
23
24
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
139
;
Cruise control lever
=
Instrument cluster
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
136
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
170
C
Overhead control panel
31
D
Climate control systems
110
E
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
129
129
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
90
G
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
90
91
H
Combination switch
99
I
Parking brake
Function
Page
J
On-board diagnostics connection
152
K
Opens the bonnet
266
26
L
Releases the parking brake
148
M
Light switch
N
Night View Assist Plus
148
98
180
25
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Overhead control panel
;
PARKTRONIC warning display
170
=
Cruise control lever
152
?
Instrument cluster
26
A
Horn
B
DIRECT SELECT lever
136
C
Steering wheel gearshift
paddles
139
D
Light switch
E
F
Function
Page
G
Opens the bonnet
H
On-board diagnostics connection
I
Ignition lock
Start/Stop button
J
Adjusts the steering wheel
manually
90
K
Adjusts the steering wheel
electrically
Steering wheel heating
90
91
98
L
Combination switch
99
Night View Assist Plus
180
M
Parking brake
148
Releases the parking brake
148
N
Climate control systems
110
31
266
129
129
26
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Displays
i Instrument cluster, kilometres
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
195
;
Multifunction display
196
=
Rev counter
194
?
Coolant temperature
194
A
Fuel gauge
27
At a glance
Instrument cluster
i Instrument cluster, miles
Function
Function
Page
:
Speedometer with segments
195
;
Multifunction display
196
Page
=
Rev counter
194
?
Coolant temperature
194
A
Fuel level
Instrument cluster
28
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
:
1
Page
Function
F
Tyre pressure monitor
246
G
Seat belt
239
H
Diesel engine: preglow
÷ ESP® in AMG vehicles
130
I
Coolant
244
J
Rear foglamp
K
Main-beam headlamps
238
ESP®
M SPORT handling
mode in AMG vehicles
242
;
Distance warning signal
246
=
ESP® OFF
242
?
Turn signal
99
A
Brakes (red)
238
243
B
Brakes
L
C
Dipped-beam headlamps
ABS
241
M
D
This lamp has no function
SRS
243
N
E
Reserve fuel
Engine diagnostics
244
(yellow)1
Only on certain vehicles.
Page
243
99
100
99
244
Multifunction steering wheel
29
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio system/COMAND
APS; see the separate operating instructions
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the separate
operating instructions
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits phone book/redial
memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume or operates the RACETIMER in
AMG vehicles
8
Mute
Page
196
Function
A
B
201
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects the submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms selections and
hides display messages
%
Back or deactivates LINGUATRONIC
Page
197
197
30
Centre console
At a glance
Centre console
Function
:
Page
Audio system/COMAND
APS; see separate operating instructions
Function
Page
E
Auxiliary heating
119
F
Stowage compartment
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Power socket
248
257
258
258
;
Seat heating
89
=
Seat ventilation
90
?
PARKTRONIC
170
G
Suspension tuning
168
A
ECO start/stop function
131
H
Level setting
167
B
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp
I
48
Stowage compartment
248
C
J
Hazard warning lamps
101
Selects the drive program
138
D
K
Rear window roller sunblind
257
Audio/COMAND controller
Overhead control panel
31
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
:
;
=
?
A
u Switches the rear
interior lighting on/off
Page
Function
B
104
| Switches the automatic interior lighting control on/off
104
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
103
ë Deactivates towaway protection
64
Rear-view mirror
92
3 Opens/closes the
sliding sunroof
Page
81
C
Buttons for the garage door
opener
261
D
ê Deactivates the interior motion sensor
64
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
103
c Switches the front
interior lighting on/off
104
E
F
32
Door control panel
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
:
Page
r45=
Stores settings for the seat,
exterior mirrors and steering wheel
95
;
Adjusts the seat electrically
86
=
&% Locks/unlocks
the doors
74
?
Opens the door
74
A
7Zª\
Adjusts and folds the exterior mirrors in/out electrically
93
W Opens/closes the
side windows
78
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the side windows in the
rear compartment
56
o Opens the boot lid
76
B
C
D
Vehicle equipment ..............................
Occupant safety ..................................
Children in the vehicle ........................
Driving safety systems .......................
Anti-theft systems ..............................
34
34
46
56
63
Safety
33
34
Occupant safety
Vehicle equipment
Safety
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Occupant safety
Important safety notes
Seat belts, together with belt tensioners, belt
force limiters and airbags, are complementary, coordinated restraint systems. They
reduce the risk of injury in specific, predefined types of accident situations and
thereby increase occupant safety. However,
seat belts and airbags generally do not protect against objects penetrating the vehicle
from the outside.
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, make
sure that:
Rthe
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 84).
Rthe seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 43).
Rthe airbags can inflate unrestricted if
deployed (Y page 36).
Rthe steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 84).
Rthe restraint systems have not been modified.
i An airbag increases the protection of
vehicle occupants wearing a seat belt. As
such they are only an additional restraint
system which complements, but does not
replace, the seat belt. All vehicle occupants
must wear their seat belt correctly at all
times, even if the vehicle is equipped with
airbags. Airbags are not deployed in all
types of accidents, e.g. in situations where
airbag deployment would not increase the
protection afforded by a correctly worn
seat belt. Airbag deployment only provides
increased protection if the seat belt is worn
correctly because:
Rthe seat belt helps to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation
to the airbag.
Rfor example, in a head-on collision, the
seat belt can more adequately prevent
the occupant from being propelled
towards the point of the impact, and is
thus better suited to prevent injury.
Therefore, in accident situations where an
airbag is deployed, it only provides protection in addition to the seat belt if the seat
belt is being worn correctly.
G Risk of accident and injury
If service work is not carried out correctly, the
operating safety of your vehicle may be affected. This could cause you to lose control of
your vehicle and cause an accident. Moreover, the safety systems may no longer be
able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop. The workshop
must have the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
Modifications to or work performed incorrectly on the following parts can result in the
restraint systems not functioning as intended:
Rthe
restraint system, consisting of seat
belts and their anchorage points, belt tensioners, belt force limiters and airbags
Rthe wiring
Rnetworked electronic systems
Occupant safety
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
Introduction
SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming
into contact with the vehicle's interior in the
event of an accident. It can also reduce the
effect of the forces to which occupants are
subjected during an accident.
SRS consists of:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp
Rairbags
Rairbag
control unit (with crash sensors)
tensioners
Rbelt force limiters
Rbelt
SRS warning lamp
SRS functions are checked regularly when
you switch on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Therefore, malfunctions
can be detected in good time.
The 6 SRS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
G Risk of injury
If SRS is malfunctioning, individual systems
may be activated unintentionally or may not
be triggered in the event of an accident with
a high rate of vehicle deceleration.
A malfunction has occurred if:
Rthe
6 SRS warning lamp does not light
up when the ignition is switched on.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp does not go out after a few
seconds.
Rthe engine is running and the 6 SRS
warning lamp lights up again.
In this case, have SRS checked immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a MercedesBenz Service Centre for this purpose.
In particular, work relevant to safety or on
safety-related systems must be carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Triggering of belt tensioners, belt force
limiters and airbags
During the first stage of a collision, the airbag
control unit evaluates important physical
data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as
Rduration
Rdirection
Rmagnitude
Based on the evaluation of this data, the airbag control unit pre-emptively triggers the
belt tensioners in the first stage.
i The front belt tensioners can only be trig-
gered if the seat belt tongues on the front
seats are correctly engaged in the seat belt
buckles.
If there is an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a longitudinal direction, the front airbags are also deployed.
Your vehicle has adaptive, two-stage front airbags. The airbag control unit evaluates vehicle deceleration or acceleration in the event
of a collision. When the first deployment
threshold is reached, the front airbag is filled
with enough propellant gas to reduce the risk
of injuries. The front airbag is fully deployed
if a second deployment threshold is exceeded
within a few milliseconds.
Z
Safety
Airbags and belt tensioners could fail to
deploy or be triggered in an accident despite
the deceleration force being sufficient to trigger the systems, or could be triggered unintentionally. For this reason, never make any
modifications to the restraint systems.
Therefore, you must not tamper with electronic components or their software.
35
Safety
36
Occupant safety
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
rate of deceleration or acceleration of the
vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature.
The triggering process must take place in
good time at the start of the collision.
i Not all airbags are deployed in an acci-
dent. The different airbag systems work
independently of each other.
How the airbag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration, and the apparent type of accident:
Rhead-on
collision
impact
Roverturn
Rside
Airbags
Important safety notes
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupant.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang, and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
The airbag installation locations are identified
by the AIRBAG symbol.
G Risk of injury
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the risk
of serious or even fatal injury caused by airbag
deployment:
Rthe
RAll
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag
nor do they provide an indication of airbag
deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e.g. the bonnet or the wing, without an airbag
being deployed. This is the case if only parts
which are relatively easily deformed are affected and the deployment threshold is not
reached. Conversely, airbags may be
deployed even though the vehicle suffers only
minor deformation. This is the case if, for
example, very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are hit and sufficient
deceleration occurs as a result.
vehicle occupants – in particular, pregnant women – must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back against
the backrest, which should be positioned
as close to the vertical as possible. The
head restraint must support the back of the
head at about eye level.
RAlways secure children less than 1.50 m tall
and under 12 years of age in suitable child
restraint systems.
RAll vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag
as possible. The driver's seat position must
allow the vehicle to be driven safely. The
driver's chest should be as far away from
the centre of the driver's airbag cover as
possible.
RMove the front-passenger seat as far back
as possible. This is especially important if
you have secured a child in a child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
RVehicle occupants – in particular, children
– must not lean their heads into the area of
the window in which the sidebag/windowbag is deployed.
Occupant safety
child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger airbag has
been disabled. On the front-passenger
seat, the front-passenger airbag is disabled
if a child restraint system with automatic
child seat recognition is fitted to the frontpassenger seat. The 4 PASSENGER
AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp must be continuously lit.
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle
does not have automatic child seat recognition, or your rearward-facing child
restraint system does not have automatic
child seat recognition, children must be
secured in a child restraint system on a
suitable seat in the rear. If you secure a
forward-facing child restraint system to the
front-passenger seat, you must move the
front-passenger seat as far back as possible.
RMake sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in the pockets of items of
clothing.
RDo not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover of
the driver's/front-passenger airbag, particularly when the vehicle is in motion.
RDo not put your feet on the dashboard.
ROnly hold the steering wheel by the rim.
This allows the airbag to be fully deployed.
You could be injured if the airbag is
deployed and you are holding the inside of
the steering wheel.
RDo not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
RMake sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle occupants and the area where the airbags are
deployed.
RDo not place any objects between the seat
backrest and the door.
RDo not hang any hard objects, for example,
coat hangers, on the grab handles or coat
hooks.
RDo not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders,
to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injury
being caused by an airbag due to the high
speed at which the airbag must be deployed.
G Risk of injury
Airbag functionality can only be assured if the
following parts are not covered and no badges
or stickers are attached to them:
Rpadded
steering wheel boss
cover below the steering column
Rfront-passenger airbag cover
Router side of front seat bolsters
Rside trim next to the rear seat backrest
Rroof frame cover between the front A-pillar
and the C-pillar in the rear compartment
Rkneebag
G Risk of injury
A small amount of powder is released when
an airbag is deployed. The powder could
cause short-term breathing difficulties in people with asthma or other respiratory problems.
In order to prevent breathing difficulties, you
should leave the vehicle as soon as it is safe
to do so. You can also open the window to
allow fresh air to enter the interior. The powder does not constitute a health hazard and
does not indicate that there is a fire in the
vehicle.
G Risk of injury
The airbag parts are hot after the airbag has
been deployed. Do not touch them as you
could burn yourself.
Have the airbags replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, occupants are
not protected by the airbags in the event of
another accident.
Z
Safety
RRearward-facing
37
38
Occupant safety
Front airbags
Safety
The front airbags increase protection for the
driver's and front-passenger's head and
chest.
systems on the front-passenger side are
triggered. Have restraint systems that have
been triggered replaced.
Driver's kneebag
i The driver's kneebag is only available in
certain countries.
The driver's kneebag increases protection of
the driver against:
Rknee
injuries
injuries
Rlower leg injuries
Rthigh
Driver's airbag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger airbag ;
deploys in front of and above the glove compartment.
They are deployed:
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
Rif the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rif the seat belt is fastened
Rindependently of other airbags in the vehicle
If the vehicle overturns, the front airbags are
generally not deployed unless the system
detects high vehicle deceleration in a longitudinal direction.
Front-passenger airbag ; is only deployed if
the front-passenger seat is occupied or if the
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp in the centre console is not lit
(Y page 48). This means that a child
restraint system with automatic child seat
recognition has not been fitted to the frontpassenger seat or has been fitted incorrectly.
! Do not place heavy objects on the front-
passenger seat. This could cause the system to identify the seat as being occupied.
In the event of an accident, the restraint
Driver's kneebag : is always deployed along
with the driver's airbag and inflates underneath the steering column.
Sidebags
G Risk of injury
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
When deployed, the sidebags offer additional
protection for the thorax of the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the
impact occurs. However, they do not protect
the:
Rhead
Rneck
Rarms
only use seat covers that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The seat covers must have a special tear seam
for sidebags/pelvisbags. Otherwise, the sidebag/pelvisbag cannot deploy correctly and
would fail to provide the intended protection
in the event of an accident. Appropriate seat
covers can be obtained, for example, from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Pelvisbag deployment enhances the level of
protection of the vehicle occupants on the
side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
Front sidebags : and rear sidebags ;
deploy next to the outer seat cushions.
The sidebags are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
If the vehicle overturns, the sidebags are generally not deployed. They are deployed if the
system detects high vehicle deceleration or
acceleration in a lateral direction and determines that sidebag deployment can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt.
Rat
Pelvisbags
i Pelvisbags are only available in certain
countries.
G Risk of injury
If you wish to use seat covers, Mercedes-Benz
recommends that, for safety reasons, you
Pelvisbags : deploy next to and below the
outer seat cushions. They are deployed:
Ron the side on which an impact occurs
Rat the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rindependently of the belt tensioners
The pelvisbags are generally not deployed if
the vehicle overturns, unless the system
detects high vehicle deceleration or acceleration in a lateral direction and determines
that they can offer additional protection to
that provided by the seat belt.
Windowbags
The windowbags enhance the level of protection for the head (but not chest or arms) of
Z
39
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
40
Occupant safety
the vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle on which the impact occurs.
The windowbags are integrated into the side
of the roof frame and deploy in the area
extending from the front door (A-pillar) to the
rear door (C-pillar).
vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS, BAS PLUS
or PRE-SAFE® Brake
Rif the radar sensor system detects an imminent danger of collision in certain situations (on vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS)
Rin critical situations involving driving
dynamics, e.g. if the vehicle oversteers or
understeers significantly due to physical
limits being exceeded or if the vehicle
swerves to avoid an obstacle at a speed of
over 140 km/h.
PRE-SAFE® takes the following measures
depending on the hazardous situation detected:
Rthe
front seat belts are pre-tensioned.
with the memory function: under
accident conditions, it adjusts the frontpassenger seat if it is in an unfavourable
position.
Rvehicles with a multicontour seat or an
active multicontour seat: the air pressure
in the side bolsters on the seat cushion and
the side bolsters on the backrest is
increased.
Rif the vehicle skids, the sliding sunroof/
panorama sliding sunroof and the side windows are closed so that only a small gap
remains.
If the hazardous situation passes without
resulting in an accident, PRE-SAFE® slackens
the belt pretensioning. The air pressure in the
side bolsters on the multicontour seat/active
multicontour seat is reduced again. All settings made by PRE-SAFE® can then be
reversed.
If the seat belts are not released:
Rvehicles
Windowbags : are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rregardless of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Rindependently of seat belt use
Rif the vehicle overturns and the system
determines that windowbag deployment
can offer additional protection to that provided by the seat belt
Rindependently of the front airbags
Rat
PRE-SAFE® (preventative occupant
protection)
PRE-SAFE® takes pre-emptive measures to
protect occupants in certain hazardous situations.
PRE-SAFE® intervenes:
Rin emergency braking situations, e.g. if BAS
is activated or intervenes powerfully in
X
Move the backrest or seat back slightly, but
only when the vehicle is stationary.
The belt pretensioning is reduced and the
locking mechanism releases.
G Risk of injury
When adjusting the seat, make sure that
nobody can become trapped.
Occupant safety
footwell or behind the seats when moving
the seat back. There is a risk that the seats
and/or the objects could be damaged.
More information about belt adjustment, a
convenience function integrated into PRESAFE®, can be found in the "Belt adjustment"
section (Y page 43).
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECKPRO luxury head restraints
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury
head restraints increase protection of the
driver’s and front-passenger’s head and neck.
In the event of a rear collision of a certain
severity, the NECK-PRO head restraints/
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints on the driver's and front-passenger seats are moved forwards and upwards. This provides better
head support.
Resetting triggered NECK-PRO head
restraints
Important safety guidelines
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury
head restraints checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, if your vehicle is involved in a
rear-end collision.
NECK-PRO head restraints
i Resetting the NECK-PRO head restraints
requires a lot of strength. If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-PRO head
restraints, have this work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
Head restraint covers prevent NECK-PRO
head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head
restraints from triggering properly. The NECKPRO head restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head
restraints can therefore not provide the intended protection. Do not use head restraint covers.
If the NECK-PRO head restraints/NECK-PRO
luxury head restraints have been triggered in
an accident, reset the NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
on the driver's and front-passenger seats
(Y page 41). Otherwise, the additional protection will not be available in the event of
another rear-end collision. NECK-PRO head
restraints/NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
that have been triggered are moved forwards
and can no longer be adjusted.
Tilt the top of the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion forwards in the direction of
arrow :.
X Push the NECK-PRO head restraint cushion
down in the direction of arrow ; as far as
it will go.
X Firmly push the NECK-PRO head restraint
cushion back in the direction of arrow =
until the cushion engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO head restraint.
X
NECK-PRO luxury head restraints
i If you have difficulty resetting the NECK-
PRO luxury head restraints, have this work
Z
Safety
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
41
Occupant safety
42
Safety
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes Benz Service Centre.
stances, this could cause severe or even fatal
injuries in the event of an accident.
Make sure that all occupants – in particular,
pregnant women – wear their seat belt correctly at all times.
RThe
Remove resetting tool : from the vehicle
document wallet.
X Slide resetting tool : into guide ;
between the NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint and the rear cover of the head
restraint.
X Push resetting tool : downwards until you
hear the head restraint deployment mechanism engage.
X Pull out resetting tool :.
X Firmly press the NECK-PRO luxury head
restraint cushion back = until it engages.
X Repeat this procedure for the second
NECK-PRO luxury head restraint.
X Replace resetting tool : into the vehicle
document wallet.
X
Seat belts
Important safety notes
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. This
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with parts of the vehicle interior.
G Risk of injury
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot perform its intended
protective function. Under certain circum-
seat belt must fit snugly on your body
and must not be twisted. Therefore, avoid
wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter coat.
The shoulder belt section must be routed
across the centre of your shoulder – on no
account across your neck or under your
arm – and pulled tight against your upper
body. The lap belt must always pass across
your lap as low down as possible, i.e. over
your hip joints – not across your abdomen.
If necessary, push down the belt strap
slightly and then retighten it in the roll-up
direction.
RDo not route the belt strap across sharp
edges or fragile objects, especially if these
are located on or in your clothing, e.g. spectacles, pens, keys, etc. The seat belt strap
could be damaged and tear in an accident,
and you or other vehicle occupants could
be injured.
ROnly one person should use each seat belt
at any one time. Children must never travel
sitting on the lap of other occupants. It
would not be possible to restrain the child
in the event of a sudden change in direction, braking or an accident. This could
result in severe or even fatal injuries to the
child and other occupants.
RPersons less than 1.50 m tall cannot wear
the seat belts correctly. For this reason,
secure persons less than 1.50 m tall in specially designed, suitable restraint systems.
RChildren less than 1.50 m tall or under 12
years of age cannot wear the seat belts
properly. Therefore, they should always be
secured in a suitable child restraint system
on a suitable vehicle seat. You can find
more information under "Children in the
vehicle" in the "Safety" section of the Owner's Manual. Follow the manufacturer's
Occupant safety
Fastening seat belts
Safety
installation instructions when fitting a child
restraint system.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt
if the seat belt is also being used by one of
the vehicle's occupants.
G Risk of injury
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection unless the backrest is almost
vertical. Under certain circumstances, this
could cause severe or even fatal injuries in the
event of an accident.
Before starting a journey, make sure that the
seat is properly adjusted and that the backrest is almost vertical.
G Risk of injury
A dirty or damaged seat belt or a seat belt that
has been subjected to a load in an accident
or which has been modified no longer offers
the intended level of protection. Under certain
circumstances, this could cause severe or
even fatal injuries in the event of an accident.
For this reason, check regularly that the seat
belts are not damaged or dirty.
Always have damaged seat belts or seat belts
that have been subjected to a load in an accident replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Consult a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat belts which have
been approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle.
43
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 84).
X Pull the seat belt smoothly through belt
sash guide :.
X Without twisting it, guide the shoulder section of the seat belt across the middle of
your shoulder and the lap section across
your hips.
X Engage belt tongue ; in buckle =.
Seat-belt adjustment: if necessary, the
driver's and front-passenger seat belts
automatically adjust to the upper body
(Y page 43).
X If necessary, adjust the seat belt to the
appropriate height (Y page 44).
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
For more information about releasing the seat
belt with release button ?, see "Releasing
seat belts" (Y page 44).
Seat belt adjustment
The seat-belt adjustment function adjusts the
driver's and front-passenger seat belt to the
upper body of the occupants.
Z
Safety
44
Occupant safety
The belt strap is tightened slightly when:
Releasing seat belts
Ryou
X
engage the belt tongue in the belt
buckle and you then turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock.
Rthe key is in position 2 in the ignition lock
and you then engage the belt tongue in the
buckle.
The seat-belt adjustment will apply a certain
tightening force if any slack is detected
between the occupant and the seat belt. Do
not hold on to the seat belt tightly while it is
adjusting. You can switch the seat-belt
adjustment on and off in the on-board computer (Y page 211).
Belt height adjustment
You can adjust the seat belt height on the
driver's seat and the front-passenger seat.
Press release button ? (Y page 43) and
guide belt tongue ; back towards belt
sash guide :.
Belt warning for driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder for all occupants
to fasten their seat belts. It may light up continuously or flash. In addition, there may be a
warning tone.
The 7 seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the warning tone ceases when the driver and
the front passenger have fastened their seat
belt. If the vehicle is stationary and a door is
opened, the 7 seat belt warning lamp
goes out and the warning tone ceases.
For certain countries only: regardless of
whether the driver or the front passenger
have fastened their seat belts, the 7 seat
belt warning lamp lights up for six seconds
after the engine is started. It then goes out if
the driver and the front passenger have fastened their seat belts.
i For more information on the 7 seat
Adjust the height so that the upper part of the
seat belt is routed across the centre of your
shoulder.
X To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards.
The belt sash guide engages in various positions.
X To lower: press and hold belt sash guide
release :.
X Slide the belt sash guide downwards.
X Release belt sash guide release : and
make sure that the belt sash guide has
engaged.
belt warning lamp, see "Indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belt" (Y page 239).
Rear seat belt status indicator
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator tells you if the rear passengers have
their seat belts fastened.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator indicates the rear seat on which the belt
is fastened.
Occupant safety
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator appears in the multifunction display for
around 30 seconds if:
The belt tensioners can only be activated
when:
Ryou
Rthe
i The status indicator for the rear-compartment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
The seat belts are fitted with belt tensioners.
! If the front-passenger seat is not occu-
pied, do not engage the seat belt tongue in
the buckle on the front-passenger seat.
Otherwise, the belt tensioner could be triggered in the event of an accident.
The belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in
an accident, pulling them close against the
body.
Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect seat
positions or incorrectly fastened seat belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull vehicle occupants
back towards the backrest.
If the seat belt is also fitted with a belt force
limiter and this is triggered, the force exerted
by the seat belt on the vehicle occupant is
reduced.
The front belt force limiters are synchronised
with the front airbags, which take on a part of
the deceleration force. Thus, the force exerted on the occupant is distributed over a
greater area.
Rthe
ignition is switched on.
restraint systems are operational; see
"SRS warning lamp" (Y page 35).
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
each of the three-point seat belts in the
front.
The belt tensioners on the seats in the rear
compartment are triggered independently of
the lock status of the seat belts.
The belt tensioners are triggered depending
on the type and severity of an accident:
Rin
the event of a head-on or rear-end collision if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of the impact
Rin the event of a side impact, on the side
opposite the impact if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a lateral direction
Rin certain situations if the vehicle overturns
and the system determines that it can provide additional protection
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that is
released generally does not constitute a
health hazard. The 6 SRS warning lamp
lights up.
G Risk of injury
If the seat belt tensioners have been triggered, they provide no additional protection
in the event of another accident. Therefore,
have belt tensioners which have been triggered replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Comply with safety regulations when disposing of belt tensioners. Any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre can provide details of these
regulations.
Z
Safety
drive off and reach a speed of approximately 10 km/h.
Rthe rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while the vehicle is in
motion.
Rsomeone gets in or out of the vehicle and
the vehicle drives off again.
You can also cancel the rear seat belt status
indicator immediately (Y page 215).
45
46
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
Safety
G Risk of injury
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. They could injure themselves on parts of the vehicle. They could also
be seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extreme heat or cold.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. Parts of the child restraint system could heat up and the child could burn
herself/himself on them.
If a child opens a door, the child or other persons could be injured as a result. They could
get out and injure themselves or be injured by
a passing vehicle.
Also observe the notes on HOLD. Relevant
information can be found in the index.
G Risk of injury
Unsecured or incorrectly positioned loads
increase the risk of injury for children and all
other occupants in the event of:
Ran
accident
braking manoeuvre
Ra sudden change of direction
Do not carry heavy or hard objects in the vehicle interior unless they are secured. You will
find further information under "Loading guidelines" in the index.
Ra
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
is appropriate to the size, age and weight of
the child and recommended for MercedesBenz vehicles. You should fit the restraint system to a suitable rear seat. Make sure that
the child is secured in a child restraint system
throughout the trip.
You can obtain information about the correct
child restraint system from any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems.
You can obtain information about this from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Child restraint systems
Important safety notes
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use the child restraint systems listed at
(Y page 54).
G Risk of injury
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
RChildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be secured
in special child restraint systems on a suitable vehicle seat. This is necessary
because the seat belts are not designed for
children.
RDo not secure children less than 1.50 m tall
or under twelve years of age on the frontpassenger seat. Exception: the child is
secured in a vehicle with automatic child
seat recognition on the front-passenger
seat and is secured in a child restraint system with automatic child seat recognition.
RIf you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
RChildren must never travel sitting on the lap
of another occupant. Due to the forces
which occur in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be thrown
against parts of the vehicle interior and be
seriously or even fatally injured.
G Risk of injury
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when fitting a child restraint
system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the correct use of the
child restraint system.
Child restraint systems should be fitted to the
rear seats. Children are generally better protected there.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion. Therefore, never place objects, e.g. a cushion,
under the child restraint system.
Only use child restraint systems with the original cover designed for them. Only replace
damaged covers with genuine Mercedes-Benz
covers.
We recommend the use of child restraint systems which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
Child seat on the front-passenger seat
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
G Risk of injury
If the front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Ra
child secured in a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat could be seriously and even fatally injured by the frontpassenger airbag deploying. This is especially a risk if the child is in the immediate
vicinity of the front-passenger airbag when
it deploys.
Rnever secure a child on the front-passenger
seat in a rearward-facing child restraint system. Only secure a rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
Ralways move the front-passenger seat to
the rearmost position if you secure a child
in a forward-facing child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat.
The front-passenger airbag is not disabled:
Ron
Warning notice on the front-passenger sun visor
47
Safety
Children in the vehicle
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition on the front-passenger seat
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
unless a child restraint system with automatic child seat recognition is fitted to the
front-passenger seat
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
unless the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp is lit
To make you aware of this danger, a corresponding warning sticker has been affixed on
Z
Children in the vehicle
Safety
48
the dashboard and on both sides of the sun
visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat
lights up. The front-passenger airbag is disabled.
G Risk of injury
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the front-passenger
airbag has not been disabled. If the frontpassenger airbag deploys, the child could be
seriously or even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo not use a rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
a rearward-facing child restraint system
on a suitable rear seat.
Rfit
or
Ronly
If your vehicle does not have automatic child
seat recognition2 on the front-passenger
seat, this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. The sticker is
visible when you open the front-passenger
door.
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat and
move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions/communicates correctly, never place
objects, e.g. a cushion, under the child
restraint system. The entire base of the child
restraint system must always rest on the seat
cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint
system cannot perform its intended protective function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
i If the front-passenger airbag is disabled
by the automatic child seat recognition, the
following remain enabled on the frontpassenger side:
The automatic child seat recognition sensor
system on the front-passenger seat detects
whether a special Mercedes-Benz child seat
with automatic child seat recognition has
been fitted there. In such cases, 4
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp :
2
Rthe
sidebag
pelvisbag
Rthe windowbag
Rthe belt tensioner
Rthe
Vehicles without automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: if you turn the key to position
2 in the ignition lock, the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp lights up briefly but has no function.
It does not indicate that there is automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat.
G Risk of injury
Do not place electronic devices on the frontpassenger seat, e.g.:
Rlaptops,
when switched on
phones
Rcards with transponders, e.g. ski passes or
access cards
Signals from electronic equipment can cause
interference in the automatic child seat recognition sensor system. This can lead to a
system malfunction. This may cause the
4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp to light up without there being a child
seat with automatic child seat recognition fitted, and the front-passenger front airbag will
not deploy during an accident. It is also possible that the 6 SRS warning lamp lights
up and/or the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
indicator lamp does not light up briefly when
you turn the key in the ignition lock to position
2.
Rmobile
ISOFIX child seat securing system for
the rear seats
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. Securing rings for two ISOFIX
child restraint systems are fitted on the left
and right of the rear seats.
G Risk of injury
A child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system does not provide
sufficient protection for children weighing
more than 22 kg. For this reason, do not
secure children weighing more than 22 kg in
a child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX
child seat securing system. If the child weighs
more than 22 kg, secure the child restraint
system using a three-point seat belt.
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. The
child could be seriously or even fatally injured.
For this reason, when fitting a child restraint
system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the correct use of the
child restraint system.
For reasons of safety, only use child restraint
systems with the ISOFIX child seat securing
system on the rear seats.
We recommend that you use the ISOFIX child
restraint systems that have been recommended for Mercedes-Benz.
An incorrectly fitted child restraint system
could come loose and seriously or even fatally
injure the child or other vehicle occupants.
When fitting the child restraint system, always
make sure that it is engaged correctly in the
securing rings on both sides.
G Risk of injury
Please note that if child restraint systems, or
their retaining systems, are damaged or subjected to a load in an accident, they may not
be able to provide their protective function.
This could result in serious or even fatal injuries to the secured child in the event of an
accident, heavy braking or a sudden change
in direction.
For this reason, have child restraint systems
and their anchorages which have been damaged or subjected to a load in an accident
checked immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G Risk of injury
The child restraint system cannot perform its
protective function if it is not correctly fitted
to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be
Z
49
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Children in the vehicle
50
When installing the ISOFIX child restraint system, fold protective caps 2 of securing rings
1 inwards.
Safety
X
Install the ISOFIX child restraint system.
Comply with the manufacturer's instructions when installing the ISOFIX child
restraint system.
Top Tether
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the rear seat. It helps reduce
the risk of injury even further.
The Top Tether anchorage points are located
in the rear compartment behind the head
restraints.
Move head restraint : upwards.
X Fold up cover ; of Top Tether anchorage
=.
X Route Top Tether belt A under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X
Hook Top Tether hook ? into Top Tether
anchorage =.
X Make sure that Top Tether belt A is not
twisted.
X Fold down cover ; of Top Tether anchorage =.
X Slide down head restraint : until it
engages (Y page 87). Make sure that you
do not interfere with the correct routing of
Top Tether belt A.
X Fit the ISOFIX child restraint system with
Top Tether. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
Make sure that Top Tether belt A is tight.
X
Children in the vehicle
51
Problems with child seat recognition
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The 4 PASSENGER A special Mercedes-Benz child seat with automatic child seat recAIRBAG OFF indicator ognition has been fitted to the front-passenger seat. The frontlamp on the centre con- passenger airbag has therefore been disabled as desired.
sole is lit.
G Risk of injury
There is no child seat fitted to the front-passenger seat. Automatic
child seat recognition is malfunctioning.
It is also possible that the 6 SRS warning lamp lights up and/
or the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp does not light
up briefly when you switch the ignition on.
X Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat,
e.g.
Rlaptop
Rmobile phone
Rcards with transponders, such as ski passes or access cards
If the 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator lamp is still on:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Safety
Problem
Children in the vehicle
52
Suitable positioning of the child restraint system
Safety
Weight categories
Seat positions
Group 0: up to
10 kg
Group 0+: up to
13 kg
Group I: 9 to 18 kg
Front-passenger
seat (the frontpassenger airbag
is not disabled)
X3
X
UF4, 5, 6
Front-passenger
seat (the frontpassenger airbag
is disabled)7)
U5, 6, 8
U5, 6, 8
U5, 6, 8
Rear seats
U6, 8
U6, 8
U6, 8
Weight categories
Seat positions
Group II: 15 to 25 kg
Group III: 22 to 36 kg
Front-passenger seat (the
front-passenger airbag is not
disabled)
UF9, 10, 11
UF9, 10, 11
Front-passenger seat (the
U10, 11, 13
front-passenger airbag is disabled)12)
U10, 11, 13
Rear seats
U11, 13
U11, 13
"Universal" category child restraint systems can be recognised by their orange approval label.
X: seat unsuitable for children in this weight category.
UF: suitable for forward-facing child seat securing systems in the Universal category approved for use in this
weight category.
5 Adjust the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position and the belt outlet height to the lowest position.
6 As recommended; see the following table "Recommended child restraint systems".
7 Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: a child restraint system of the
"Universal" category with automatic child seat recognition must be fitted. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
8 U: suitable for child seat securing systems in the Universal category approved for use in this weight category.
9 UF: suitable for forward-facing child seat securing systems in the "Universal" category approved for use in
this weight category.
10 Adjust the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position and the belt outlet height to the lowest position.
11 As recommended; see the following table "Recommended child restraint systems".
12 Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat: a child restraint system of the
"Universal" category with automatic child seat recognition must be fitted. The 4 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
13 U: suitable for child seat securing systems in the Universal category approved for use in this weight category.
3
4
53
Safety
Children in the vehicle
Approval label on the child restraint system (example)
Suitable seat positions for ISOFIX child restraint systems
Weight categories
Carry-cot
0: up to
10 kg
0+: up to 13 kg
Size category
F
G
E
E
D
C
Equipment
ISO/L1
ISO/L2
ISO/R1
ISO/R1
ISO/R2
ISO/R3
Rear seats
X14
X
IL15
IL
IL
IL
Weight category
I: 9 to 18 kg
Size category
D
C
B
B1
A
Equipment
ISO/R2
ISO/R3
ISO/F2
ISO/F2X
ISO/F3
Rear seats
IL16
IL
IUF17
IUF
IUF
14 X:
this position is unsuitable.
as recommended, see the following table of "Recommended ISOFIX child restraint systems".
16 IL: as recommended, see the following table of "Recommended ISOFIX child restraint systems".
17 IUF: suitable for forward-facing ISOFIX child restraint systems that belong to the "Universal" category and
are approved for use in this weight category.
15 IL:
Z
54
Children in the vehicle
Safety
Recommended child restraint systems
Weight catego- Manufacries
turer
Type
Approval
number
Order num- Automatic
ber
child seat
recognition
Group 0+: up to
13 kg
Britax
Römer
BABY
SAFE
PLUS
E1 03 301146 A 000 970 10 Yes
E1 04 301146 00
Group I: 9 to
18 kg
Britax
Römer
DUO
PLUS
E1 03 301133 A 000 970 11 Yes
E1 04 301133 00
A 000 970 16 No18
00
Category II/III:
15 to 36 kg
Britax
Römer
KID
E1 03 301148 A 000 970 12 Yes
E1 04 301148 00
A 000 970 17 No18
00
KIDFIX
E1 04 301198 A 000 970 18 Yes
00
A000 970 19 No18
00
Recommended ISOFIX child restraint systems
Weight categories
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0+: Group 0+: Group 0+:
up to
up to
up to
13 kg
13 kg
13 kg
Size category
E
F
G
C
D
E
Manufacturer
-
-
-
-
-
Britax
Römer
Type
-
-
-
-
-
BABY SAFE
ISOFIX
PLUS
Type
approval
number
-
-
-
-
-
E1 04
301146
Category
-
-
-
-
-
Universal
18 For
child restraint systems without automatic child seat recognition, move the front-passenger seat to the
rearmost position.
Children in the vehicle
55
Weight categories
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Group 0+: Group 0+: Group 0+:
up to
up to
up to
13 kg
13 kg
13 kg
Order
number
-
-
-
-
-
B6 6 86
8224
Automatic
child seat
recognition
-
-
-
-
-
No
Safety
Group 0:
up to
10 kg
Weight categories
Group I: 9 to Group I: 9 to Group I: 9 to Group I: 9 to Group I: 9 to
18 kg
18 kg
18 kg
18 kg
18 kg
Size category
A
B
B1
Manufacturer
-
-
Britax Römer -
-
Type
-
-
DUO PLUS
-
-
Type
approval
number
-
-
E1 03
301133
E1 04
301133
-
-
Category
-
-
Universal
-
-
Order num- ber
-
A 000 970 11 00
-
Automatic
child seat
recognition
-
Yes
-
-
Child-proof locks
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
G Risk of accident and injury
Activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors and the override switch for the rear
windows when children are travelling in the
C
-
D
vehicle. Otherwise, the children could open
doors or side windows while the vehicle is in
motion and injure themselves or others.
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
Z
Driving safety systems
56
Safety
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
er's door. If indicator lamp : is off, operation is possible using the switches in the
rear compartment.
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems overview
To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X
X
To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side windows
G Risk of accident and injury
Activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors and the override switch for the rear
windows when children are travelling in the
vehicle. Otherwise, the children could open
doors or side windows while the vehicle is in
motion and injure themselves or others.
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
RBAS (Brake Assist System)
RBAS PLUS (Brake Assist System Plus*)
RAdaptive brake lamps
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
REBD (Electronic Brake-force Distribution)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS)
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
The risk of an accident is significantly
increased by driving too fast. This is particularly the case when cornering as well as on
wet or slippery roads or when driving too close
to the vehicle in front.
The driving safety systems described in this
section can neither reduce this risk nor override the laws of physics.
For this reason, always adapt your driving
style to the prevailing road and weather conditions. Maintain sufficient distance from
other road users and objects on the road.
i In wintry driving conditions, always use
X
To activate/deactivate: press button ;.
If indicator lamp : is lit, operation of the
rear side windows is disabled. Operation is
only possible using the switches in the driv-
winter tyres (M+S tyres) and if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
Driving safety systems
Important safety guidelines
G Risk of accident
Do not depress the brake pedal several times
in quick succession (pumping). Pumping the
brake pedal reduces the braking effect. You
might otherwise not be able to stop the vehicle in time and could cause an accident.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and smoothly.
BAS (Brake Assist)
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h
upwards, regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even
when you only brake gently.
G Risk of accident
Braking
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist PLUS)
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel
a pulsing in the brake pedal.
X If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
G Risk of accident
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. This limits the steerability of the vehicle when braking and the braking distance
may increase.
If ABS is deactivated due to a malfunction,
then BAS and ESP are also deactivated. There
is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in
certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
If BAS has malfunctioned, the braking system
remains available with full brake boosting
effect. However, braking force is not automatically increased in emergency braking situations and the stopping distance may
increase.
BAS PLUS is only available in vehicles with
DISTRONIC PLUS.
BAS PLUS assists you in braking during hazardous situations at speeds above 30 km/h
and uses the radar sensor system to evaluate
the traffic situation.
G Risk of accident
BAS PLUS is only an aid to assist you when
driving. You are responsible for maintaining a
safe distance from other vehicles, for the vehicle's speed and for braking in good time.
Always pay attention to the traffic conditions.
Otherwise, you may recognise dangers too
late, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
BAS PLUS can detect obstacles that are in the
path of your vehicle for an extended period of
time. Should you approach a detected obstacle quickly, BAS PLUS calculates the braking
force necessary to avoid a rear-end collision.
Should you additionally apply the brakes, BAS
PLUS will automatically increase the braking
Z
Safety
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
57
Safety
58
Driving safety systems
force to a level suitable for the traffic conditions.
If BAS PLUS demands particularly high braking force, PRE-SAFE® is activated simultaneously.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will work normally again if:
Ryou
release the brake pedal.
obstacle is detected in front of your
vehicle.
Rthere is no longer any danger of a rear-end
collision.
BAS PLUS is then deactivated.
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h, BAS
PLUS may also detect stationary obstacles,
for example, stopped or parked vehicles.
Vehicles without COMAND and a navigation
system and vehicles for Australia: the radar
sensor system and on-board computer must
be switched off in the vicinity of radio telescope facilities (Y page 210).
For BAS PLUS to assist you when driving, the
radar sensor system must be switched on and
operational. You can check this by activating
DISTRONIC PLUS(Y page 154) or via the
"radar sensor" function in the on-board computer (Y page 210).
Rno
G Risk of accident
Only clearly identified obstacles will initiate
braking assistance by BAS PLUS.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be restricted if there is:
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rstrong radar reflections, for example in
multi-storey car parks
BAS PLUS does not react to people or animals, oncoming vehicles and crossing traffic,
or when cornering.
BAS PLUS may not detect narrow vehicles
such as motorcycles and vehicles driving on
a different line.
Following a collision or accident-related damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the
configuration and operation of the radar sensors checked at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
If BAS PLUS is not available due to a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the brake
system remains available with full brake
boosting effect and BAS.
Adaptive brake lamps
i Adaptive brake lamps are only available in
certain countries.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS
or BAS PLUS, the brake lamps flash rapidly.
In this way, traffic travelling behind you is
warned in an even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning switch button .
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Important safety notes
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilise the
vehicle. If necessary, the engine output is also
modified to keep the vehicle on the desired
course within physical limits. ESP® assists
the driver when pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP® can also stabilise the vehicle during braking.
Driving safety systems
G Risk of accident
If the ÷ warning lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes, proceed as follows:
not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
Ronly depress the accelerator pedal as far as
necessary when pulling away.
Radapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Otherwise, the vehicle could go into a skid.
Rdo
ESP® cannot reduce the risk of an accident if
you drive too fast. ESP® cannot override the
laws of physics.
! Switch the ignition off when:
Rthe parking brake is being tested using a
dynamometer
Rthe vehicle is being towed with the front/
rear axle raised
Application of the brakes by ESP® may otherwise destroy the brake system.
! Do not tow vehicles with 4MATIC with the
front or rear axle raised.
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
Traction control is part of ESP®.
Traction control brakes the drive wheels individually if they spin. This enables you to pull
away and accelerate on slippery surfaces, for
example if the road surface is slippery on one
side. On vehicles with 4MATIC, more drive
torque is also transferred to the wheel or
wheels with traction.
Traction control remains active if you deactivate ESP®.
G Risk of accident
Traction control cannot reduce the risk of an
accident if you drive too fast. Traction control
cannot override the laws of physics.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (except
AMG vehicles)
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
G Risk of accident
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels can spin. The spinning of
the wheels results in a cutting action, which
provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
X To deactivate:(Y page 204).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
G Risk of accident
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
Z
Safety
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ warning lamp
flashes in the instrument cluster.
59
60
Driving safety systems
Safety
If the ÷ warning lamp and å warning
lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
There is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
Rtraction
control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If SPORT handling mode is activated and one
or more wheels start to spin, the ÷ ESP®
warning lamp in the instrument cluster
flashes. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle to a
limited degree.
To activate:(Y page 204).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Deactivating/activating ESP® (AMG
vehicles)
Activating/deactivating SPORT handling
mode
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to activate SPORT handling
mode in the following situations:
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Otherwise, you should only use SPORT handling mode on designated race circuits.
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
The SPORT handling mode message
appears in the multifunction display.
X
To deactivate: briefly press button :.
The M SPORT handling mode warning
lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Rwhen
Rin
G Risk of accident
Deactivate SPORT handling mode and activate ESP® as soon as the situations described
above no longer apply. Otherwise, SPORT
handling mode will only be able to stabilise
the vehicle to a limited degree if the vehicle
starts to skid or a wheel starts to spin.
When SPORT handling mode is activated:
RESP®
only improves driving stability to a
limited degree.
Rthe engine's torque is restricted to a limited
degree and the drive wheels can spin. The
spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Activating/deactivating ESP®
ESP® is activated automatically when the
engine is started.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
G Risk of accident
Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilise the vehicle
if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel starts
to spin.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
Rthe engine's torque is no longer limited and
the drive wheels are able to spin. The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting
action, which provides better grip.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RPRE-SAFE® is no longer available and is
also not activated if you brake firmly with
the assistance of ESP.
RPRE-SAFE® Brake is no longer available and
is also not activated if you brake firmly with
the assistance of ESP®.
RESP® still provides support when you brake
firmly.
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster does not flash. In such
situations, ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of your vehicle skidding in certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
To activate: briefly press button :.
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out. The ÷ON
message appears in the multifunction display.
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution)
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
G Risk of accident
If EBD has malfunctioned, the braking system
remains available with full brake boosting
effect. However, the rear wheels can still lock,
e.g. under full braking. This could cause you
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident. You should therefore adapt your
driving style to the different handling characteristics.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
X
To deactivate: press button : until the
å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
The ÷OFF message appears in the multifunction display.
G Risk of accident
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning lamp
in the instrument cluster lights up continuously when the engine is running.
If the ÷ warning lamp and å warning
lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 165) and
hill start assist (Y page 131). For further
information, see Driving tips (Y page 149).
PRE-SAFE® Brake (vehicles with DISTRONIC PLUS)
PRE-SAFE® Brake can help you to minimise
the risk of a frontal collision with a vehicle
ahead or reduce the effects of such a collision.
Z
61
Safety
Driving safety systems
62
Driving safety systems
This function will issue a warning at speeds of
around 30 km/h or more if:
Safety
Rfor
a period of several seconds, the distance to the vehicle in front is too short for
the speed at which you are travelling. The
· distance warning lamp in the instrument cluster will light up.
Ryou are rapidly approaching the vehicle in
front. An intermittent warning tone will
then sound and the · distance warning
lamp will light up in the instrument cluster.
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated driving conditions may cause the
system to display an unnecessary warning.
G Risk of accident
Pay particular attention to the traffic conditions if the · distance warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up or an intermittent
warning tone sounds. If necessary, brake or
manoeuvre to avoid an obstacle.
If the driver and passengers have fastened
their seat belts, PRE-SAFE® Brake can also
can also perform the following at speeds of
above approximately 30 km/h:
Rbrake
the vehicle automatically from a
speed of up to approximately 200 km/h
Rtrigger preventative passenger protection
measures (PRE-SAFE®)
G Risk of accident
PRE-SAFE® Brake is only an aid to assist you
when driving. You are responsible for maintaining a safe distance from other vehicles,
the vehicle's speed and for braking in good
time. Always pay attention to the traffic conditions. Otherwise, you may recognise dangers too late, cause an accident and injure
yourself and others.
With the help of the radar sensor system,
PRE-SAFE® Brake can detect obstacles that
are in front of your vehicle for an extended
period of time. If you approach an obstacle
and PRE-SAFE® Brake detects a risk of a collision, the system will initially alert you both
visually and acoustically. If you do not brake
or steer, the vehicle will at first automatically
brake slightly. In the event of an increased
risk of a collision, PRE-SAFE® is activated
(Y page 40). If the risk of collision remains
and you do not brake, take evasive action or
accelerate significantly, the vehicle may perform automatic emergency braking.
G Risk of accident
Only clearly detected obstacles will trigger a
warning and initiate braking assistance by
PRE-SAFE® Brake.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rdirt
on the sensors or the sensors are covered
Rsnow or heavy rain
Rinterference by other radar sources
Rthe possibility of strong radar reflections,
for example in multi-storey car parks
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not react to persons,
animals, oncoming vehicles, crossing traffic
or when cornering.
PRE-SAFE® Brake may not detect narrow
vehicles such as motorcycles and vehicles
driving on a different line.
G Risk of accident
Depending on the current speed, PRE-SAFE®
Brake decelerates your vehicle by up to
4 m/s2 before performing possible emergency braking. This is equivalent to approximately 40 % of the maximum braking power
of the vehicle. You must additionally apply the
brakes yourself in order to prevent a collision
or minimise an impact. Automatic emergency
braking is not performed until immediately
prior to an accident in the event that you are
unable to avoid one by, for instance, taking
evasive action.
In order to maintain the appropriate distance
to the vehicle in front and thus prevent a collision, you must apply the brakes yourself.
Anti-theft systems
G Risk of accident
If, in a critical driving situation, you do not
receive a visual and acoustic warning:
RPRE-SAFE® Brake did not detect the risk of
a collision
RPRE-SAFE®
Brake is switched off
RPRE-SAFE®
Brake has failed
You must then brake to avoid a collision.
X
To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate PRE-SAFE® Brake in the on-board
computer (Y page 204).
After activation, the Ä symbol is displayed on the left in the instrument cluster.
The radar sensor system is switched off automatically in the vicinity of radio telescope
facilities (Y page 327).
Vehicles without COMAND and navigation,
and vehicles for Australia: near radio telescope installations, the radar sensor system
must be switched off with the on-board computer (Y page 210).
For PRE-SAFE® Brake to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be
switched on (Y page 210) and operational.
PRE-SAFE® Brake does not always detect
complex traffic situations properly. You can
terminate the braking action of PRE-SAFE®
Brake in a non-critical driving situation at any
time if:
Ran
acoustic and visual warning occurs.
Rthe vehicle brakes.
To end this, you can either depress the accelerator pedal further, activate kickdown or
release the brake pedal.
The braking action of PRE-SAFE® Brake is
ended automatically if:
Ryou
manoeuvre to avoid the obstacle.
drive slower than approximately
15 km/h.
Rthere is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle.
Rthere is no longer any danger of a collision.
Following a collision or collision-related damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the
configuration and operation of the radar sensors checked. Choose a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools for the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
Ryou
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate with the key: remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X To activate with KEYLESS-GO: switch the
ignition off and open the driver's door.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
i The immobiliser is always deactivated
when you start the engine.
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
A visual and audible alarm is triggered if the
alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
vehicle with the emergency key element
Rthe boot lid
Rthe bonnet
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that has triggered it, for
example.
Rthe
Z
Safety
At speeds up to approximately 70 km/h,
PRE-SAFE® Brake may also detect stationary
obstacles, for example stopped or parked
vehicles.
63
Anti-theft systems
64
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is primed after
approximately 30 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
Tow-away protection is deactivated automatically.
Safety
X
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate tow-away
protection manually if your vehicle:
To prime: lock the vehicle with the key or
KEYLESS-GO.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately 15 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle with the
key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
X
Ris
being transported
being loaded onto a ferry or car transporter, for example
Ris parked on a movable surface, e.g. in a
split-level garage
Ris
To stop the alarm using the key: insert
the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the % or & button on the key.
The alarm is switched off.
X
To stop the alarm using KEYLESS-GO:
grasp the outside door handle. The key
must be outside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X
Press the Start/Stop button on the dashboard. The key must be inside the vehicle.
The alarm is switched off.
Tow-away protection
An audible and visual alarm is triggered if your
vehicle's angle of inclination is altered while
tow-away protection is primed. This occurs if
the vehicle is jacked up on one side, for example.
Deactivating:
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or, on vehicles
with KEYLESS-GO, by touching the outside
door handle.
Tow-away protection remains deactivated
until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again.
Ra door is opened and closed again.
Rthe vehicle is locked again.
X
X
Interior motion sensor
If the interior motion sensor is primed, a visual and audible alarm is triggered if movement is detected in the vehicle interior while
the vehicle is locked. This occurs if someone
reaches into the vehicle interior, for example.
To activate:
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed.
Rthe sliding sunroof is closed.
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging on the rear-view mirror or on the grab
handles on the roof trim.
This will prevent false alarms.
X Make sure that all the doors and the tailgate are closed.
X Lock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESSGO.
X
To deactivate:
X
Unlock the vehicle with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
The interior motion sensor is deactivated
automatically.
X
Lock the vehicle with the key. On vehicles
with KEYLESS-GO, the locking buttons on
the door handle/boot lid can also be used.
The interior motion sensor remains deactivated until:
Rthe vehicle is unlocked again.
Ra door is opened and closed again.
Rthe vehicle is locked again.
i United Kingdom only: if the vehicle has
been locked with the key, the doors cannot
be opened from the inside (Y page 74).
Deactivate the interior motion sensor
before locking the vehicle with the key. The
doors can then be opened from the inside
after the vehicle has been locked from the
outside with the key. Observe the "Important safety notes" (Y page 73).
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the interior motion sensor if you lock your vehicle
and:
Rpeople
or animals remain in the vehicle.
side windows remain open.
Rthe sliding sunroof remains open.
Deactivating:
Rthe
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; flashes briefly.
Z
65
Safety
Anti-theft systems
66
67
68
68
73
75
78
80
Opening and closing
Vehicle equipment ..............................
Key .......................................................
Doors ....................................................
Boot ......................................................
Side windows ......................................
Sliding sunroof ....................................
68
Key
Vehicle equipment
Opening and closing
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Key
Key functions
Locking and unlocking centrally
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
If the vehicle has been locked with KEYLESSGO, the doors can be opened from inside the
vehicle.
G Risk of accident
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
Rthe
doors
boot lid
Rthe fuel filler flap
Rthe
G Risk of injury
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance, if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
: & To lock the vehicle
; F To unlock the boot lid
= % To unlock the vehicle
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
When it is dark, the surround lighting also
comes on if it is activated in the on-board
computer.
You can also set an audible signal to confirm
that the vehicle has been locked or unlocked.
The audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer
(Y page 209).
X To unlock centrally: press the % button.
Key
Rthe
vehicle is locked again.
Rthe anti-theft system is primed again.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
KEYLESS-GO
You can start, lock or unlock the vehicle using
KEYLESS-GO. To do this, you only need carry
the key with you. When you touch the surface
of the sensors on the vehicle's outside door
handles, KEYLESS-GO establishes a radio
connection between the vehicle and the key.
The distance from the door handle with which
you wish to lock or unlock the vehicle must
not be greater than 1 m.
When the engine is started and whilst you are
driving, KEYLESS-GO also checks whether a
valid key is in the vehicle by periodically
establishing radio contact.
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the setting of the locking
system in such a way that only the driver's
door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This
is useful if you frequently travel on your own.
X To change the setting: press and hold down
the % and & buttons simultaneously
for approximately six seconds until battery
check lamp (Y page 70) flashes twice.
The key now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X
The KEYLESS-GO function is changed as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: touch the
inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door.
X To unlock centrally: touch the inner surface of the door handle on the frontpassenger door or the rear door.
X To lock centrally: touch the outer sensor
surface on one of the door handles.
X
Restoring the factory settings
X
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner
surface of the door handle.
X To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface :.
X
If you pull on the handle of the boot lid, only
the boot of the vehicle is unlocked.
Press the % and & buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice.
Emergency key element
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door or the boot
Z
Opening and closing
If you do not open a door or the boot lid within
approximately 40 seconds of unlocking the
vehicle:
69
Key
Opening and closing
70
lid, the anti-theft alarm system will be triggered (Y page 63).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X To deactivate the alarm with the key:
press the % or & button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
or
X To deactivate the alarm with KEYLESSGO: press the Start/Stop button in the ignition lock. The key must be in the vehicle.
or
X Lock or unlock the vehicle using KEYLESSGO. The key must be outside the vehicle.
G Risk of poisoning
Batteries are toxic and contain caustic substances. For this reason, keep batteries out of
the reach of children.
If a battery has been swallowed, visit a doctor
immediately.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is against the law to dispose of them with the household rubbish. They must be
collected separately and
recycled in an environmentally responsible manner.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, or to a special collection point for old batteries.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key in the ignition lock.
Removing the emergency key element
Checking the battery
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time, remove
emergency key element ; from the key.
X
Battery of the key
Important safety notes
It is advisable to have batteries replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Press the & or % button.
The key battery is working properly if the
battery charge indicator lamp : lights up
briefly.
If battery charge indicator lamp : does not
light up briefly during the test, the key battery
is discharged.
X Replace the key battery (Y page 71).
Key
i When checking the key battery within the
signal area of the vehicle, pressing the
& or % button locks or unlocks the
vehicle, respectively.
Changing the battery
Insert the front tabs of the battery tray's
cover first and then press to close it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Opening and closing
You require a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 69).
X
71
Press emergency key element ; into the
opening in the key in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens. Do
not hold the cover closed while doing so.
Remove the cover of the battery tray.
Repeatedly tap the key against your palm
until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive
pole facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to
do so.
X Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free from lint, grease and all other forms of
contamination.
X
X
Z
72
Key
Problems with the key
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the key.
The key battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from a distance of approximately 50 cm and try to unlock or lock the
vehicle again.
Opening and closing
Problem
If this does not work:
X Check the key battery and replace it if necessary (Y page 71).
X Lock (Y page 75) or unlock (Y page 75) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
The key is faulty.
X Lock (Y page 75) or unlock (Y page 75) the vehicle using
the emergency key element.
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can no longer lock There is a fault with KEYLESS-GO.
or unlock the vehicle
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
using KEYLESS-GO.
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the %/& button.
X Have KEYLESS-GO checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control function of
the key. Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from
close range and press the %/& button.
You have lost a key.
X
Have the key cancelled at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
You have lost the emergency key element.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine cannot be
started using the key.
The on-board voltage is too low.
X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
lighting, and try to start the engine again.
If this does not work:
X Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 290).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 294).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine cannot be
A door is open. Therefore, the key cannot be detected as easily.
started using KEYLESS- X Close the door and try to start the vehicle again.
GO. The key is in the
vehicle.
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
X Start your vehicle with the key in the ignition lock.
Doors
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance, if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
If the vehicle has been locked with KEYLESSGO, the doors can be opened from inside the
vehicle.
G Risk of accident
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen a door from inside the vehicle at any
time, even if it has been locked
Rstart the vehicle using a key which has been
left in the vehicle
Rrelease the parking brake
They could thereby endanger themselves and
others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
Z
73
Opening and closing
Doors
Doors
74
Opening and closing
Unlocking and opening the doors
from the inside
For all countries except the United Kingdom: you can open a door from inside the
vehicle even if it has been locked.
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then
not possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle. Deactivate the interior motion sensor
(Y page 64) before you lock the vehicle with
the key. The doors can only be opened from
the inside after the vehicle has been locked
from the outside with the key.
You can only open the rear doors from inside
the vehicle if they are not secured by the
child-proof locks (Y page 55).
i You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally
from the inside if the vehicle has been
locked with the key or KEYLESS-GO.
X
X
To lock: press button ;.
To unlock: press button :.
Automatic locking feature
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels begin
to turn. Therefore, there is a risk of being
locked out when the vehicle is being pushed,
towed or tested on a dynamometer.
X
Pull door handle ;.
If the door is locked, locking knob : pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Locking and unlocking the vehicle
from the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. This feature may be useful if,
for example, you wish to unlock the frontpassenger door from the inside or lock the
vehicle before you pull away.
The central locking/unlocking button does
not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about five seconds until a tone sounds.
X
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 209).
Boot
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked centrally with the key or KEYLESS-GO:
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 69).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 69).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X
X
Turn the emergency key element clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element anti-clockwise.
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Locking the vehicle (emergency key
element)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked centrally with the key or KEYLESS-GO:
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door and the
boot lid.
X Press the locking button (Y page 74).
X Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs by hand, if necessary.
X Close the driver's door.
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Make sure that the doors and the boot lid
are locked.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
X
Boot
Important safety notes
Do not leave the key in the boot. You could
otherwise lock yourself out.
G Risk of poisoning
Exhaust fumes could enter the vehicle interior
if the engine is running and the boot lid is
open. This could poison you. Therefore, you
should make sure that the boot lid is always
closed when the engine is running.
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
The boot lid can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
Z
Opening and closing
Unlocking the driver's door (emergency key element)
75
Boot
76
Ropened and closed automatically from out-
side
Ropened automatically from inside
Runlocked with the emergency key element
Opening and closing
Opening/closing manually
Opening
You can only open the boot lid after unlocking
it first.
X Press the % button on the key.
Pull handle :.
X Raise the boot lid.
X
Closing
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when closing the boot lid.
Pull the boot lid down using recess :.
X Lock the vehicle if necessary with
the & button on the key or with KEYLESS-GO (Y page 69).
X
Opening/closing automatically from
outside
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
Only for the United Kingdom: if the vehicle
has been locked with the key, the double lock
function is activated as standard. It is then not
possible to open the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Therefore, do not leave any people behind in
the vehicle, particularly children, elderly people or people requiring special assistance, if
the vehicle has been locked with the key. As
a result, they may not be able to free themselves in the event of an emergency. They
could be seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or low
temperatures, for example. In this case, rescuing people from outside the vehicle is difficult.
Deactivate the interior motion sensor before
you lock the vehicle with the key. The doors
can then be opened from the inside after the
vehicle has been locked from the outside with
the key.
If the vehicle has been locked with KEYLESSGO, the doors can be opened from inside the
vehicle.
G Risk of injury
Monitor the boot lid opening and closing procedures to make sure that nobody can
become trapped. To stop the opening or closing procedure, press the closing button on the
boot lid again or pull the handle on the outside
of the boot lid.
Boot
77
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
You can open the boot lid automatically using
the key or the handle in the boot lid.
X Press and hold the F button on the key
until the boot lid opens.
or
X If the boot is unlocked, pull on the boot lid
handle and let it go again immediately.
Closing
You can close the boot lid automatically by
using the closing button19 or locking button20.
X
To open: pull remote operating switch for
boot lid : until the boot lid opens.
Unlocking the boot (emergency key
element)
! The boot lid swings upwards when
opened. Therefore, make sure that there is
sufficient clearance above the boot lid.
If the boot can no longer be unlocked with the
key or KEYLESS-GO:
X Take the emergency key element out of the
key (Y page 69).
X Insert the emergency key element into the
boot lid lock as far as the stop.
To close: press closing button : in the
boot lid.
X To close and lock simultaneously:
Press locking button ; in the boot lid.
X
i If you leave a KEYLESS-GO key in the
boot, the boot lid will not lock.
Opening automatically from inside
You can open the tailgate from the driver's
seat when the vehicle is stationary.
19 For
20 For
vehicles with the boot lid remote closing feature only.
vehicles with the boot lid remote closing feature and KEYLESS-GO only.
Z
Opening and closing
Opening
Side windows
78
Turn the emergency key element anticlockwise as far as it will go to position
1.
The boot is unlocked.
X Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Insert the emergency key element into the
key.
Opening and closing
X
Side windows
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
when a side window is opened. Do not touch
or lean against the side window during the
opening procedure. You could become trapped between the side window and the door
frame as the side window moves down. If
there is a risk of becoming trapped, release
the switch or pull the switch upwards to close
the side window again.
G Risk of injury
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could:
Rbe seriously or even fatally injured on parts
of the vehicle
seriously or even fatally injured by prolonged exposure to extremely high or
extremely low temperatures
If children open a door, they could:
Rbe
Rseriously or even fatally injure other people
Rget
out of the vehicle and injure themselves, or be seriously or even fatally
injured by a passing vehicle
Activate the child-proof locks/override feature if children are travelling in the vehicle.
They could otherwise open doors or side windows while the vehicle is in motion and
thereby injure themselves or others.
Opening and closing the side windows
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close a side window. If there is a risk
of becoming trapped, release the switch or
press it again to open the side window again.
G Risk of injury
Children may injure themselves if they open
or close the side windows.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
: Front left
; Front right
= Rear right
? Rear left
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
Side windows
i You can continue to operate the side windows after you switch off the engine. This
function remains active for five minutes or
until one of the front doors is opened.
G Risk of injury
When using the convenience closing feature,
make sure that nobody can become trapped.
Proceed as follows if there is a risk of entrapment:
With the key:
Rrelease
the & button.
Rpress
and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof open
again.
With KEYLESS-GO:
Rrelease the sensor surface on the door han-
dle.
Rpull
the door handle immediately and hold
it.
The side windows and the sliding sunroof
open.
Convenience opening feature
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, you can use the key to
simultaneously:
Ropen
the side windows
Ropen the sliding sunroof
Rswitch on the seat ventilation
i The convenience opening feature can
only be operated using the key. The key
must be close to the driver's door handle.
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Unlock the vehicle by pressing the %
button.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are in
the desired position.
X
Using the key
i The key must be close to the driver's door
handle.
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Lock the vehicle by pressing the & button.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows and the sliding sunroof are
fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
X
Using KEYLESS-GO
Convenience closing feature
General notes
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
Rclose
the side windows
the sliding sunroof
Z
Opening and closing
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To open: press the corresponding switch.
X To close: pull the corresponding switch.
i If you press the switch beyond the point
of resistance, an automatic opening/closing process is started in the corresponding
direction. You can stop automatic operation by pressing again.
X
79
Sliding sunroof
80
Touch sensor surface : on the door handle until the side windows and the sliding
sunroof are fully closed.
i Make sure you only touch sensor surface :.
X
Opening and closing
X
Make sure that all the side windows and the
sliding sunroof are closed.
Resetting the side windows
You must reset each side window if a side
window can no longer be closed fully.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed. (Y page 78)
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
that nobody can become trapped when closing the side windows.
If a side window is obstructed during closing
and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased
force.
If a side window is obstructed again during
closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the antientrapment feature.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Sliding sunroof
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 78).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the corresponding side window remains
closed after the button has been released,
the side window has been reset correctly.
If this is not the case, repeat the steps
above again.
Important safety notes
X
Problems with the side windows
Problem: a side window cannot be closed
because an object is obstructing the side
window.
X
X
Remove the object(s).
Close the side window.
Problem: a side window cannot be closed,
and you cannot see the cause.
G Risk of injury
Closing the side windows with increased force
or without the anti-entrapment feature could
lead to serious or even fatal injury. Make sure
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when closing the sliding sunroof. If there is a
risk of entrapment, release the switch and
push it briefly in any direction to stop the sliding sunroof.
G Risk of injury
Children could injure themselves if they operate the sliding sunroof.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. Always take the key with you when leaving
the vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for
a short time.
G Risk of injury
The glass in the panorama sunroof could
break in an accident. If you are not wearing a
seat belt, there is a risk that you could be
thrown through the opening in the event of the
vehicle overturning. Therefore, always wear a
seat belt to reduce the risk of injuries.
Sliding sunroof
if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
sliding sunroof. Otherwise, the seals could
be damaged.
i Resonance noises can occur in addition
to the usual airflow noises when the sliding
sunroof is open. They are caused by minor
pressure fluctuations in the vehicle interior.
Change the position of the sliding sunroof
or open a side window slightly to reduce or
eliminate these noises.
Operating the sliding sunroof
Opening and closing
closed the sliding sunroof, you can close the
cover by hand.
Rain closing feature
When the key is in position 0 in the ignition
lock or is removed, the sliding sunroof closes
automatically:
Rif it starts to rain
Rat extreme outside temperatures
Rafter six hours
Rif there is a malfunction in the power supply
The rear of the sliding sunroof is then raised
in order to ventilate the vehicle interior.
i If the sliding sunroof is obstructed when
being closed by the rain closing feature, it
opens again slightly. The rain closing feature is then deactivated.
The sliding sunroof does not close if:
Rit
is raised at the rear.
is blocked.
Rno rain is falling on the area of the windscreen being monitored by the rain sensor
(e.g. because the vehicle is under a bridge
or in a carport).
Rit
Resetting
Overhead control panel
: To raise
; To open
= To close/lower
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Push or pull the 3 switch in the corresponding direction.
i If you press the 3 switch beyond the
point of resistance, an automatic opening/
closing process is started in the corresponding direction. You can stop automatic
operation by pressing again.
The sun protection cover automatically opens
along with the sliding sunroof. Once you have
X
Reset the sliding sunroof if it does not open
smoothly.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Raise the sliding sunroof fully at the rear.
X Keep the 3 switch pressed for another
second.
X Make sure that the sliding sunroof can be
fully opened or closed again (Y page 81).
X If this is not the case, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Problems with the sliding sunroof
Problem: the sunroof cannot be closed
and you cannot see the cause.
Z
Opening and closing
! Only open the panorama sliding sunroof
81
Sliding sunroof
82
G Risk of injury
Opening and closing
You could be severely or even fatally injured
when closing the sliding sunroof with
increased closing force or if the anti-entrapment feature is deactivated. Make sure that
nobody can become trapped when closing the
sliding sunroof.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during
closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of
resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased
force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly:
X
Immediately after the sliding sunroof
blocks, pull the 3 switch in the overhead control panel down to the point of
resistance and hold it until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed without the
anti-entrapment feature.
83
84
84
85
90
92
95
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Vehicle equipment ..............................
Correct driver's seat position ............
Seats ....................................................
Steering wheel ....................................
Mirrors .................................................
Memory functions ...............................
84
Correct driver's seat position
Vehicle equipment
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Correct driver's seat position
Ryou
have set the seat cushion angle so
that your thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly (Y page 86).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by
the centre of the head restraint.
Observe the safety guidelines on
(Y page 90).
X Check whether steering wheel : is adjusted properly.
Adjust the steering wheel manually
(Y page 91)
Adjust the steering wheel electrically
(Y page 91)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
Ryou
Observe the safety guidelines on
(Y page 42).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 43).
The seat belt should:
Observe the safety guidelines on
(Y page 85).
X Check that seat = is adjusted properly
(Y page 86).
When adjusting the seat, make sure:
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's airbag as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly.
Ryou have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position.
Rfit
snugly across your body.
routed across the middle of your
shoulder.
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the
hip joints.
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 93)
in such a way that you have a good view of
road and traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with memory function: save the
seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
settings (Y page 95).
Rbe
Seats
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no key in the ignition lock. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could adjust the seats and
become trapped.
G Risk of accident
Only adjust the driver's seat when the vehicle
is stationary. You will otherwise be distracted
from the road and traffic conditions and you
could lose control of the vehicle as a result of
the seat moving. This could cause an accident.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when adjusting the seats.
Observe the notes on airbags.
Secure children as recommended; see the
"Children in the vehicle" section.
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rdo
not spill any liquids on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not to be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
! When you move the seats, make sure that
there are no objects in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise, you could
damage the seats and the objects.
G Risk of injury
i The head restraints in the front seats are
Make sure that the back of your head is supported at eye level by the central area of the
head restraint. If your head is not supported
correctly by the head restraint, you could suffer a severe neck injury in the event of an
accident. Never drive if the head restraints are
not engaged and set correctly.
i Related topics:
G Risk of injury
fitted with the NECK-PRO system
(Y page 41). For this reason, it is not possible to remove the head restraints from
the front seats.
Please contact a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for more information.
RThrough-loading feature, rear bench seat
Occupants should only travel sitting on seats
which have the head restraints fitted. On a
seat which is occupied, move the head
restraint into the upright position. This
reduces the risk of injury to the passenger in
the event of an accident.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Seats
85
86
Seats
Adjusting the seat electrically
Adjusting the head restraints
Adjusting the head restraints manually
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the head restraint height
: Head restraint height
; Seat cushion angle
= Seat height
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
A Backrest angle
i Vehicles with memory function: if PRE-
SAFE® has been triggered, the frontpassenger seat will be moved to a better
position if it was previously in an unfavourable position.
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the angle of the head restraints
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 95).
i Vehicles with the through-loading feature
and memory function: if you fold down a
rear seat backrest, the respective front
seat is moved forwards slightly if necessary.
i Vehicles with memory function: when the
seat is moved forwards or backwards, the
headrest is moved up or down automatically.
X
Push or pull the lower edge of the head
restraint in the direction of the arrow.
Adjusting the head restraints electrically
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment
(Y page 86) up or down in the direction of
the arrow.
Seats
Adjusting the luxury head restraints
G Risk of injury
When folding back the head restraint side bolsters, do not put your hands between the side
bolster and the cushion holder. There is a
danger of becoming trapped.
87
Removing and fitting the rear seat head
restraints
G Risk of injury
Occupants should only travel sitting on seats
which have the head restraints installed. This
reduces the risk of injury to the passengers in
the rear in the event of an accident.
sunblind is retracted when removing the
rear head restraints. Otherwise, you could
damage the roller sunblind.
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: push or pull right and/or lefthand side bolster : into the desired position.
X To adjust the angle of the head
restraint: push or pull the head restraint in
the direction of arrow ;.
X
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
angle
Adjust the head restraint so that it is as close
as possible to your head.
To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
Adjusting the multicontour seat
You can adjust the contour of the front seats
individually so as to provide optimum support
for your back and sides.
X
Pull or push the top of the head restraint
until it is in the desired position.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
! Make sure that the rear window roller
Seats
88
A To adjust the contour of the backrest to
increase/decrease support
B To adjust the height/depth of the back-
rest contour
Dynamic function
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
You can choose between two different levels.
Level 1 (one indicator lamp)
Standard setting:
slightly increased
lateral support and
slow build-up of air
pressure in the side
bolsters of the seat
backrest.
Level 2 (two indicator lamps)
Sport setting:
increased lateral
support and fast
build-up of pressure
in the side bolsters
of the seat backrest.
: To adjust the thigh cushion
; To adjust the backrest contour in the lum-
bar region
= To adjust the backrest contour in the
upper back region
? To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
X
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
Adjusting the active multicontour
seat
The active multicontour seat automatically
adapts the sides of the backrest to your current driving style.
To switch on: press button ; once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ;
light up.
X To switch off: press button ; repeatedly
until all indicator lamps in button ; go out.
X
Massage function (PULSE)
: To adjust the seat cushion length
; To switch the dynamic function on or off
= To adjust the side bolsters of the seat
backrest
? To switch the massage function on or off
The massage function helps you to prevent
muscle tension on long journeys. You can
choose between two levels.
X To switch on: press button ? once or
twice until the desired level is set.
One or two indicator lamps in button ?
light up. The air cushions in the lumbar
region vibrate for approximately 20
minutes.
Seats
You can adjust the contour of the driver's seat
so as to provide optimum support for your
back.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Activating/deactivating
G Risk of injury
Repeatedly setting the seat heating to level
3 may result in excessive seat temperatures.
The health of passengers that have limited
temperature sensitivity or a limited ability to
react to excessively high temperatures may
be affected or they may even suffer burn-like
injuries. Therefore, do not use seat heating
level 3 repeatedly.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
X
Move adjustment lever : in the direction
of the arrow until the desired backrest contour is achieved.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
Driver's and front-passenger seat
: To raise the backrest contour
; To soften the backrest contour
= To lower the backrest contour
? To harden the backrest contour
Rear-compartment seats
The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after about eight
minutes (driver's seat and front-passenger
seat) or five minutes (rear seats).
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting lumbar support
89
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
90
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately ten
minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired ventilation level is set.
Problems with the seat heating
The seat ventilation has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
The seat heating has switched off prematurely or cannot be switched on. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window heating or interior lighting.
X
i You can open the side windows and the
sliding sunroof with the key (Y page 79).
The seat ventilation of the driver's seat
automatically switches to the highest level.
X
To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
Problems with the seat ventilation
X
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Steering wheel
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Activating/deactivating
The three blue indicator lamps in the buttons
indicate the ventilation level you have selected.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
ventilation may switch off.
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
The electrically adjustable steering wheel can
still be adjusted when there is no key in the
ignition lock. Therefore, do not leave children
unsupervised in the vehicle, as they could
become trapped if the steering wheel is adjusted.
G Risk of accident
Only adjust the steering wheel when the vehicle is stationary and do not pull away until the
steering wheel adjustment mechanism is
locked in position. You might otherwise drive
without the steering wheel adjustment mechanism being locked in position. As a result,
you could be distracted from road and traffic
conditions by an unintentional movement of
the steering wheel and thereby cause an accident.
Steering wheel
However, the steerability of the vehicle is not
affected.
91
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the steering wheel manually
: To adjust the steering wheel height
; To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
: Release lever
i Related topics:
REASY-ENTRY/EXIT
feature
(Y page 92)
Rstoring settings (Y page 95)
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Steering wheel heating
Switching on/off
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X To switch on/off: turn the lever in the
direction of arrow : or ;.
Indicator lamp = lights up or goes out.
X
i The steering wheel heating does not
switch off automatically.
Z
Mirrors
92
Problems with the steering wheel heating
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
If the steering wheel heating indicator lamp
on the lower left lever of the steering column
is flashing, the steering wheel heating has
switched off automatically. The vehicle's
electrical system voltage is too low because
too many electrical consumers are switched
on.
X
Switch off electrical consumers which you
do not need, such as the rear window heating or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the
steering wheel heating will switch back on
automatically.
i The steering wheel only moves upwards if
it has not already reached the upper end
stop.
If you insert the key into the ignition lock with
the driver's door closed, the steering wheel is
automatically moved to the previously set
position.
The last position of the steering wheel is
stored after each manual setting or when you
store the setting with the memory function
(Y page 95).
You can activate and deactivate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature in the on-board computer (Y page 211).
i If the crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature
is triggered in an accident, the steering column will move upwards when the driver's
door is opened. This occurs irrespective of
the position of the key in the ignition lock.
This makes it easier to exit the vehicle and
rescue the occupants.
The crash-responsive EASY-EXIT feature is
only operational after an accident if the
EASY-EXIT/ENTRY feature is activated in
the on-board computer.
EASY-ENTRY/EXIT system
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
when you activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature.
If there is a risk of someone becoming trapped, stop the adjustment procedure. To halt
the procedure:
Rmove the switch for steering wheel adjustment in the opposite direction to that in
which the steering wheel is moving.
Rpress one of the memory function position
buttons.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. They could open the driver's door and
thereby unintentionally activate the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature and become trapped.
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
Rear-view mirror (manual anti-dazzle)
The EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature makes getting
in and out of your vehicle easier.
The steering wheel swings upwards when
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door and KEYLESS-GO is
in position 1
Ropen the driver's door and the key is in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock
Ropen
X
Anti-dazzle mode: flick anti-dazzle
switch : forwards or back.
Mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
electrically
G Risk of accident
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects are actually closer than they
appear. You could misjudge the distance from
vehicles driving behind and cause an accident, e.g. when changing lane. For this reason, make sure of the actual distance from the
vehicle driving behind by glancing over your
shoulder.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
The exterior mirrors are automatically heated
if the rear window heating is switched on and
the outside temperature is low.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while the vehicle is
in motion, as they may otherwise vibrate.
Resetting the exterior mirrors
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, to
the right or to the left until the exterior mirror is set to a position that provides you
with a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
If the battery has been disconnected or completely discharged, the exterior mirrors must
be reset. The exterior mirrors will otherwise
not fold in when you select the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the on-board
computer (Y page 211).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button :.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
automatically
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 211):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside.
Rthe exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle and
then open the driver's or front-passenger
door.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Exterior mirrors
93
94
Mirrors
i The mirrors do not fold out if they have
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
been folded in manually.
Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
Exterior mirror out of position
Setting and storing the parking position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X Vehicles without electrically folding
exterior mirrors: move the exterior mirror
into the correct position manually.
X Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors: press the mirror-folding button (Y page 93) repeatedly until you hear
the mirror engage in position.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 93).
You can position the front-passenger side
exterior mirror in such a way that you can see
the rear wheel on that side as soon as you
engage reverse gear. You can store this position.
Automatic anti-dazzle mirrors
G Risk of accident
If the incident light from headlamps cannot
strike the sensor in the rear-view mirror, for
instance, when the rear window roller sunblind is extended, the mirror's automatic antidazzle function will not operate.
Incident light could then blind you. This may
distract you from the traffic conditions and,
as a result, you may cause an accident. In this
case, adjust the rear-view mirror manually.
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antidazzle mode if the ignition is switched on and
incident light from headlamps strikes the sensor in the rear-view mirror.
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged or the interior lighting
is switched on.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
that the key is in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror to a position which allows
you to see the rear wheel and the kerb.
The parking position is stored.
X
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
i You can also store the parking position
using memory button M ?.
X
With the key in position 2 in the ignition lock and with the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side activated,
use adjustment button = to set the
Memory functions
If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
Calling up a stored parking position setting
X
With the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock and the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side activated, engage reverse
gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Rdriver's
side: steering wheel position
side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Rdriver's
G Risk of injury
The memory function can still be used when
the key has been removed. For this reason,
children should never be left unsupervised in
the vehicle. They could otherwise become
trapped when adjusting the seat or the steering wheel.
G Risk of accident
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side when the vehicle is stationary. Otherwise, you could be distracted from the traffic
conditions by the steering wheel and seat
moving of their own accord, and as a result
cause an accident.
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of
10 km/h
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory functions
Storing settings
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition
of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Ractive multicontour seat: seat cushion
length, seat backrest side bolsters, contour
of the backrest, dynamic function level setting
Adjust the seat (Y page 86).
On the driver's side, adjust the steering
wheel (Y page 91) and the exterior mirrors
(Y page 93).
X Press memory button M and one of the
storage position buttons 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position. A tone sounds when the settings have been completed.
X
X
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
exterior mirror such that the rear
wheel and kerb are visible.
X Press memory button M ? and one of
the arrows on adjustment button =
within three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the
exterior mirror does not move.
95
Memory functions
96
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press the corresponding storage position
button 1, 2 or 3.
The seat, steering wheel and exterior mirror
are set in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
soon as you release the storage position
button.
97
Lights and windscreen wipers
Vehicle equipment .............................. 98
Exterior lighting .................................. 98
Interior lighting ................................. 103
Changing bulbs ................................. 104
Windscreen wipers ........................... 106
98
Exterior lighting
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Light switch
Operation
Lights and windscreen wipers
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Exterior lighting
Important safety notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
Notes on driving abroad
Convert to symmetrical dipped beam
when driving abroad: switch the headlamps
to symmetrical dipped beam in countries in
which traffic drives on the opposite side of the
road to the country where the vehicle is registered. This prevents oncoming traffic from
being dazzled. Symmetrical lights do not illuminate as large an area of the edge of the
carriageway.
Convert the headlamps as close to the border
as possible before driving in these countries
(Y page 207).
Convert to asymmetrical dipped beam
after returning: convert the headlamps back
to asymmetrical dipped beam as soon as possible after crossing the border when returning
(Y page 207).
Vehicles with Intelligent Light System: if
the headlamps are converted to symmetrical
dipped beam, not all light functions are available. "Motorway mode" and the "extended
range foglamps" are deactivated.
1W Left-hand parking lamps
2X Right-hand parking lamps
3T Side lamps, licence plate and instru-
ment lighting
4c Automatic headlamp mode/daytime
driving lights
5L Dipped-beam/main-beam headlamps
BR Rear foglamp
The turn signals, main-beam headlamps and
the headlamp flasher are operated using the
combination switch (Y page 99).
! Switch off the side lamps and parking
lamp when you leave the vehicle. This prevents the battery from discharging.
The exterior lighting (except the side lamps/
parking lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Rremove
the key from the ignition lock
the driver's door with the key in position 0
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X Turn the light switch to c.
Ropen
Exterior lighting
Dipped-beam headlamps
With the engine running: depending on the
brightness of the ambient light, the daytime
driving lights21 or the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on or off automatically.
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
To switch on the dipped-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The L indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up.
X
You can activate or deactivate the daytime
driving lights function using the on-board
computer (Y page 207).
X Daytime driving lights: activate the daytime driving lights function using the onboard computer.
X Turn the light switch to c.
When the engine is on: depending on the
ambient light conditions, the daytime driving lights or the dipped-beam headlamps
are switched on.
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the L indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
Automatic headlamps
G Risk of accident
If the light switch is set to c, the dippedbeam headlamps will not come on automatically if it is foggy. This could endanger you and
others. Therefore, turn the light switch to
L in fog.
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
X
To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to c.
Key in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
21 Only
Rear foglamp
To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2 or start
the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or c.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear foglamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
X
i If you switch the engine off (key in posi-
tion 1 in the ignition lock) and then restart
it, the previous rear foglamp settings are
restored.
Combination switch
Turn signals
: Main-beam headlamps
; Turn signal, right
if daytime driving lights have been activated via the on-board computer.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
Daytime driving lights
99
Exterior lighting
100
= Headlamp flasher
The system may be impaired or deactivated:
? Turn signal, left
Rif
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Main-beam headlamps
To switch on the main-beam headlamps: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to L or c.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of
arrow :.
In the c position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the engine is running.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the main-beam headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the main-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The K indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
G Risk of accident
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. The driver is
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting
to the prevailing light, vision and traffic conditions.
there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray
Rif the area of the windscreen around the
optical sensor is dirty, misted up or covered
up, e.g. by a sticker
The system may not recognise the following
road users:
Rroad users that have no lighting, e.g. pedes-
trians
users that have poor lighting, e.g.
cyclists
Rroad users whose lighting is not clearly visible, e.g. road users behind a crash barrier
Ron rare occasions: road users that have
lights that may be recognised too late or not
at all
The automatic main-beam headlamps will not
be deactivated, or they may be activated
despite road users travelling in front of or
approaching the vehicle.
Thus, you could cause an accident and injure
yourself and others. Always observe traffic
conditions and, if necessary, dip the lights
manually.
Rroad
You can use this function to set the headlamps to change between dipped beam and
main beam automatically. The system recognises vehicles with their lights on, either
approaching from the opposite direction or
travelling in front of your vehicle, and consequently switches the headlamps from main
beam to dipped beam.
The system automatically adapts the dippedbeam headlamp range depending on the distance to the other vehicle. Once the system
no longer detects any other vehicles, it reactivates the main-beam headlamps.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windscreen near the overhead control
panel.
Exterior lighting
101
the instrument cluster goes out. The _
indicator lamp in the instrument cluster
stays on.
X To deactivate: move the combination
switch back to its normal position.
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Headlamp flasher
To switch on: turn the key in the ignition
lock to position 1 or 2 or start the engine.
X Pull the combination switch briefly in the
direction of arrow =.
Hazard warning lamps
To activate: activate the Adaptive Highbeam Assist function using the on-board
computer (Y page 208).
X Turn the light switch to c.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :
(Y page 99).
The _ indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the light sensor
switches the dipped-beam headlamps on
when it is dark.
If you are driving at speeds above
45 km/h:
the headlamp range is set automatically
depending on the distance between the
vehicle and other road users.
If you are driving at speeds above
55 km/h and no other road users are recognised:
the main-beam headlamps are switched on
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster also lights up.
If you are driving at speeds below
45 km/h or other road users are recognised or the roads are adequately lit:
the main-beam headlamps are switched off
automatically. The K indicator lamp in
X
The hazard warning lamps automatically
switch on if:
Ran
airbag is deployed.
vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of more than 70 km/h and comes to
a standstill.
X To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on
a turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning
lamps: press button :.
Rthe
The hazard warning lamp switches off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
102
Exterior lighting
over 10 km/h again after full brake application.
Cornering light function
i The hazard warning lamps still operate if
the ignition is switched off.
Lights and windscreen wipers
Headlamp cleaning system
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with washer fluid" function is operated ten times while the lights are on and the
engine is running (Y page 106). When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
Intelligent Light System
Active light function
The cornering light function improves the illumination of the road over a wide angle in the
direction you are turning, enabling better visibility in tight bends, for example. It can only
be activated when the dipped-beam headlamps are switched on.
Active:
Rif
The active light function is a system that
moves the headlamps according to the steering movements of the front wheels. In this
way, relevant areas remain illuminated while
driving. This allows you to recognise pedestrians, cyclists and animals.
Active: when the lights are switched on.
you are driving at speeds below
40 km/h, the cornering light function is
activated either by the turn signal or by the
steering wheel being turned.
Rif you are driving at speeds between
40 km/h and 70 km/h, the cornering light
function is activated by the steering wheel
being turned.
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
40 km/h or switch off the indicator lamp or
turn the steering wheel to the straight-ahead
position.
The cornering light function may remain lit for
a short time, but is automatically switched off
after no more than three minutes.
Interior lighting
Motorway mode
103
Headlamps misted up inside
The headlamps may mist up on the inside if
there is high atmospheric humidity.
X Drive with the headlamps switched on.
Depending on the duration of the journey
and the weather conditions (humidity and
temperature), the headlamps may demist.
Motorway mode increases the range of the
beam.
Active:
Rif
you are driving at speeds above
110 km/h and do not make any large steering movements for 1000 m
Rif you are driving at speeds above
130 km/h
Not active: if you are driving at speeds below
80 km/h following activation.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Extended range foglamps
Front overhead control panel
: u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
; | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
= p Switches the right-hand front read-
ing lamp on/off
? c Switches the front interior lighting
The extended range foglamps reduce the
glare experienced by the driver and improve
the illumination of the edge of the carriageway.
Active: if you are driving at speeds below
70 km/h and you switch on the rear foglamp
Not active: if you are driving at speeds above
100 km/h or you switch off the rear foglamp
following activation
on/off
A p Switches the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
If they do not demist:
X Have the headlamps checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Changing bulbs
104
Manual interior lighting control
To switch the front interior lighting on/
off: press the c button.
X To switch the rear interior lighting on/
off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
Lights and windscreen wipers
X
Rear-compartment overhead control panel
: p Switches the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
; p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
Interior lighting control
Important notes
In order to prevent the vehicle's battery from
discharging, the interior lighting functions are
automatically deactivated after some time
except for when the key is in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Automatic interior lighting control
X
To switch on/off: press the | button.
When the automatic interior lighting control is activated, the button is flush with the
overhead control panel.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the key from the ignition lock
The interior light is activated for a short while
when the key is removed from the ignition
lock. You can activate this delayed switch-off
using the on-board computer (Y page 209).
Ropen
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
Changing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
G Risk of injury
Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could
get an electric shock and be seriously or even
fatally injured if you touch the electric contacts on xenon bulbs. Therefore, never
remove the cover from xenon bulbs.
Do not change xenon bulbs yourself, but have
them replaced at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
LED bulbs
In addition to xenon bulbs, you also cannot
replace LED bulbs. Have LED bulbs replaced
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
G Risk of injury
Bulbs and lights can become very hot. For this
reason, allow them to cool down before
changing them. Otherwise, you could burn
yourself when you touch them.
Keep bulbs out of the reach of children. Otherwise, they could damage them, for example,
and injure themselves.
Never use a bulb which has been dropped.
Such a bulb may explode and injure you.
Halogen bulbs are pressurised and could
explode when you change them, especially if
they are very hot. You should therefore wear
eye protection and gloves when you are
changing them.
If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not touch the glass tube of new bulbs with
your bare hands. Even minor contamination
can burn into the glass surface and reduce
the service life of the bulbs. Always use a lintfree cloth or only touch the base of the bulb
when fitting.
Only use bulbs of the correct type.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Overview: changing bulbs/bulb types
You can change the following bulbs. The bulb
type can be found in the legend.
Tail lamp
: Reversing lamp: W 16 W
There are bulbs other than the xenon and LED
bulbs that you cannot replace. Replace only
the bulbs listed (Y page 105). Have the bulbs
that you cannot replace yourself changed at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
105
Lights and windscreen wipers
Changing bulbs
Windscreen wipers
106
Changing the rear bulbs
Reversing lamp
Windscreen wipers
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Lights and windscreen wipers
G Risk of accident
The windscreen will not longer be wiped properly if the wiper blades are worn. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident. Replace
the wiper blades twice a year, ideally in spring
and autumn.
! Do not operate the windscreen wipers
Lamp cluster
Switch off the lights.
Open the boot.
X Reach into the top of the side trim panel
and pull down until the lamp cluster is easily accessible.
X Press connector grid ; and pull out connector ;.
X Use a suitable tool to loosen and remove
four nuts :.
X Remove the complete lamp cluster.
X Turn bulb holder = anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Pull out the bulb.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder =.
X Insert bulb holder = into the lamp and turn
it clockwise.
X Insert the lamp cluster again.
X Tighten four nuts :.
X Push in connector ; until it engages.
X Insert the side trim panel.
X
X
when the windscreen is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dirt
that has collected on the windscreen can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windscreen is dry.
! If the windscreen wipers leave smears on
the windscreen after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, this may
be due to wax or other residue. Clean the
windscreen with washer fluid after an automatic car wash.
Combination switch
1 $ Windscreen wipers off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low22
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high23
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/ î To wipe the
windscreen using washer fluid
22 Rain
23 Rain
sensor set to low sensitivity.
sensor set to high sensitivity.
Windscreen wipers
107
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
to optical influences and the windscreen
becoming dirty in dry weather conditions,
the windscreen wipers may be activated
inadvertently. This could damage the windscreen wiper blades or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
In the Ä or Å position, the appropriate
wiping frequency is set automatically according to the intensity of the rain. In the Å
position, the rain sensor is more sensitive
than in the Ä position, causing the windscreen wiper to wipe more frequently.
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
X
Remove the wiper blade from the retainer
on the wiper arm in the direction of the
arrow.
Fitting the wiper blades
X Slide the new wiper blade into the retainer
on the wiper arm in the opposite direction
to the arrow.
Make sure that the wiper blade slides fully
into the retainer on the wiper arm.
X Turn the wiper blade parallel to the wiper
arm.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
G Risk of accident
The wiper arms could start moving and cause
an injury if you leave the windscreen wipers
switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock before
replacing the wiper blades.
! To avoid damaging the windscreen wiper
blades, make sure that you touch only the
wiper arm of the windscreen wiper.
Replacing the wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
X Remove the key from the ignition lock or
turn the key to position 0 (KEYLESS-GO).
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen until it engages.
X Set the wiper blade at right angles to the
wiper arm.
Problems with the windscreen wipers
The windscreen wipers are obstructed
Leaves or snow, for example, may be
obstructing the windscreen wiper movement.
The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the
key from the ignition lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
The windscreen wipers are inoperative
The windscreen wiper drive is malfunctioning.
X Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windscreen wipers checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Lights and windscreen wipers
! Intermittent wiping with rain sensor: due
108
Windscreen wipers
The spray nozzles are misaligned
Lights and windscreen wipers
The windscreen washer fluid from the spray
nozzles no longer hits the centre of the windscreen. The spray nozzles are misaligned.
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist workshop.
109
110
110
113
123
Climate control
Vehicle equipment ............................
Overview of climate control systems ...................................................
Operating the climate control system .....................................................
Adjusting the air vents .....................
110
Overview of climate control systems
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
of air supplied to the vehicle interior. For
this reason, you should always observe the
interval for replacing the filter, which is
specified in the Service Booklet. As it
depends on environmental conditions, e.g.
heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
Overview of climate control systems
Climate control
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. Otherwise, the windows
could mist up. This may obstruct your view of
the traffic situation and, as a result, you may
cause an accident.
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate control/THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control controls the temperature and the humidity of the vehicle interior
and filters out undesirable substances from
the air.
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate control/THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control is only operational
when the engine is running24. Optimum operation is only achieved if you drive with the side
windows and sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof closed.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 79). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter can filter out most
particles of dust and completely filters out
pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount
24 THERMOTRONIC
luxury 3-zone automatic climate control: the residual heat function can only be switched
on/off if the ignition is switched off.
Overview of climate control systems
111
Function
i Notes/tips
: Sets the temperature, left
Set the temperature to 22 †.
; Demists the windscreen
Only use the demisting function briefly until the windscreen is clear again.
= Switches the ZONE function
on/off
Use the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for the front-passenger side
as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
? Switches cooling with air dehu- Activate climate control using the à or ¿ butmidification on/off
tons.
A Switches the rear window
heating on/off
B Sets the temperature, right
Set the temperature to 22 †.
C Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
Only use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g. if there
are unpleasant outside odours or when in a tunnel.
The windows could otherwise mist up, as in air-recirculation mode, no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle.
D Sets the air distribution
E Increases the airflow
F Reduces the airflow
Z
Climate control
Control panel for THERMATIC automatic climate control (2-zone)
112
Overview of climate control systems
Function
i Notes/tips
G Switches climate control on/
off
Activate climate control primarily using the Ã
or ¿ buttons.
H Sets climate control to automatic
Activate climate control using the à or ¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the à and ¿ buttons light up.
Climate control
Control panel for THERMOTRONIC automatic climate control (3-zone)
Function
i Notes/tips
Front control panel
: Sets the temperature, left
Set the temperature to 22 †.
; Demists the windscreen
Only use the demisting function briefly until the windscreen is clear again.
= Switches the residual heat
function on/off
Use the residual heat function if you want to heat or
ventilate the vehicle interior when the ignition is
switched off. The residual heat function can only be
activated or deactivated with the ignition switched
off.
? Switches cooling with air dehu- Activate climate control using the à or ¿ butmidification on/off
tons.
A Switches the rear window
heating on/off
B Sets the temperature, right
Set the temperature to 22 †.
Operating the climate control system
Function
113
i Notes/tips
C Switches the ZONE function
on/off
Use the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for the front-passenger side
and the rear compartment as well. The indicator lamp
in the á button goes out.
D Switches climate control on/
off
Activate climate control primarily using the Ã
or ¿ buttons.
E Sets the air distribution
F Increases the airflow
H Sets the climate mode
In automatic mode, you can also use the ñ button
to set a climate mode (FOCUS/MEDIUM/DIFFUSE).
The MEDIUM level is recommended.
I Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
Only use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g. if there
are unpleasant outside odours or when in a tunnel.
The windows could otherwise mist up, as in air-recirculation mode, no fresh air is drawn into the vehicle.
J Sets climate control to automatic
Activate climate control using the à or ¿ buttons. You can also use the ñ button to set a climate mode (FOCUS/MEDIUM/DIFFUSE). The
MEDIUM level is recommended.
Rear control panel
K Increases the airflow
L Reduces the airflow
M Display
N Reduces the temperature
Set the temperature to 22 †.
O Increases the temperature
Set the temperature to 22 †.
Operating the climate control system
Switching climate control on/off
i Activate climate control primarily using
the à button (Y page 114).
Important information
i When climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. Only select this setting briefly;
otherwise, the windows may mist up.
Z
Climate control
G Reduces the airflow
Operating the climate control system
114
Activating/deactivating
Activating/deactivating
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again.
X To deactivate: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
To switch on: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
Climate control
X
X
Problems with the cooling with air
dehumidification function
When you press the ¿ button, the indicator lamp in the button flashes three times or
remains off. You can no longer switch on the
cooling with air dehumidification function.
X
Switching cooling with air dehumidification on/off
Important information
The cooling with air dehumidification function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.
G Risk of accident
If the "cooling with air dehumidification" function is deactivated, the air inside the vehicle
will not be cooled (during warm weather) or
dehumidified. The windows could mist up
more quickly. This may prevent you from
observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when THERMOTRONIC is in cooling mode. This is normal and not a sign that
there is a malfunction.
i The cooling with air dehumidification
function uses refrigerant R134a. This coolant does not contain chlorofluorocarbons,
and therefore does not damage the ozone
layer.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Setting climate control to automatic
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
Automatic mode will achieve optimal operation if cooling with air dehumidification is also
activated. If desired, cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
Adjusts the climate control settings
This function is only available with
THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control.
The climate mode setting is especially effective at high temperatures.
You can select the following climate mode
settings in automatic mode:
FOCUS High airflow; slightly cooler setting
MEDIUM Medium airflow; standard setting
DIFFUSE Low airflow; slightly warmer air
with less of a draught
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the à button.
X Press the ñ button repeatedly until the
desired climate mode appears in the display.
X
Setting the temperature
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate
control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn controls : or
B clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 111).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X
THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control
or B clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 112).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the front
control panel: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
X Turn control : clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 112).
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
The temperature setting on the driver's
side is adopted for the rear compartment
and the front-passenger side.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the rear compartment using the rear
control panel: press the r or s
button on the rear control panel.
Only change the temperature setting in
small increments. Start at 22 †.
i If you leave the vehicle parked for longer
than 30 minutes, the temperature setting
for the rear compartment then switches
back to 22 †.
Setting the air distribution
Climate zones of THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone
automatic climate control
You can select different temperature settings
for the driver's and front-passenger sides as
well as for the rear compartment.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce the temperature in
the front compartment: turn controls :
P Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents
O Directs the airflow through the footwell air vents
S Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the footwell air vents
¯ Directs the airflow through the demister vents
b Directs the airflow through the centre
and side air vents as well as the demister vents
Z
115
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
Operating the climate control system
116
a Directs the airflow through the footwell and demister vents
_ Directs the airflow through the demister, centre and side air vents as well as
the footwell air vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed when the controls on the side air
vents are turned downwards.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the _ button repeatedly until the
desired symbol appears in the display.
Climate control
X
is not adopted for the other climate control
zones.
X To deactivate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic
climate control: the temperature setting on
the driver's side is adopted for the frontpassenger side or the rear compartment.
Demisting the windscreen
Setting the airflow
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase: press the K button.
X To decrease: press the I button.
X
i You can use THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-
zone automatic climate control to set the
airflow in the rear compartment separately.
Switching the ZONE function on/off
X
To activate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
THERMATIC 2-zone automatic climate control: the temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic
climate control: the temperature setting on
the driver's side is not adopted for the
front-passenger side or the rear compartment.
When the buttons or controls for temperature, airflow or air distribution are activated,
the temperature setting on the driver's side
25 Depending
on the outside temperature.
You can use this function to defrost the windscreen or to demist the inside of the windscreen and the side windows.
i You should only select the demisting
function until the windscreen is clear again.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To switch on: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
X
Rcooling
with air dehumidification on
airflow25
Rhigh temperature25
Rair distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Rhigh
X
or
To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again. The cooling with air dehumidification function remains on. Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
X
Turn controls : or B clockwise or anticlockwise (Y page 111), (Y page 112).
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window heating may switch off.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
Press the K or I button.
Problems with the rear window heating
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X
or
X
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the ¿ cooling with air dehumidification function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the demisting function (Y page 116).
X
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
Windows misted up on the outside
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Press the _ button repeatedly until the
P or O symbol appears in the display.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
X
X
Rear window heating
Activating/deactivating
G Risk of accident
Clear all windows of ice or snow before setting
off. Otherwise, impaired visibility could
endanger you and others.
The rear window heating has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the window is clear, as it only
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
The rear window heating has switched off
prematurely or cannot be activated.
X Switch off any consumers that are not
required, e.g. reading lamps or interior
lighting.
When the battery is sufficiently charged,
the rear window heating is activated again
automatically.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
The operation of the air-recirculation mode is
the same for all control panels.
G Risk of accident
Only switch over to air-recirculation mode
briefly at low outside temperatures. Otherwise, the windows could mist up, thus impairing visibility and endangering yourself and
others. This may prevent you from observing
the traffic conditions, thereby causing an
accident.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To switch on: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up.
X
Z
117
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
Operating the climate control system
118
i Air-recirculation mode is automatically
activated at high levels of pollution26 or at
high outside temperatures. When air-recirculation mode is activated automatically,
the indicator lamp in the g button is not
lit.
Outside air is added after about 30
minutes.
X
To deactivate: press the g button.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode switches off auto-
Climate control
matically:
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately
5†
Rafter approximately five minutes if cooling with air dehumidification is deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
5†
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
between the side window and the door frame
as the side windows are opened and closed.
Make sure that all objects and body parts are
clear of the side windows when they are being
opened or closed. You or the objects could be
drawn in or become trapped between the side
window and the door frame as the window
moves. If there is a risk of entrapment, operate the W switch to move the side window
in the opposite direction.
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof is opened and closed. If there is a risk of
entrapment, operate the 3 switch to move
26 Only
the sliding sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof
in the opposite direction.
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof are closed.
The indicator lamp in the g button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X
Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the g button until the side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof are opened. The side windows and the sliding sunroof/panorama
sliding sunroof move back to their original
position.
The indicator lamp in the g button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
i If you open the side windows or the sliding
sunroof/panorama sliding sunroof manually after closing with the convenience
closing feature, they will remain in this position when opened using the convenience
opening feature.
Activating/deactivating the residual
heat function
The residual heat function is only available
with THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the stationary vehicle for up to 30 minutes after the
engine has been switched off. The heating
time depends on the temperature that has
been set.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the residual heat function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
with THERMOTRONIC luxury 3-zone automatic climate control.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it.
X To switch on: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button lights
up.
X
X
To deactivate: press the Ì button.
The indicator lamp in the Ì button goes
out.
i Residual heat is deactivated automatically:
Rafter
about 30 minutes
the ignition is switched on
Rif the battery voltage drops
Rif the coolant temperature is too low
Rwhen
Auxiliary heating
Important safety notes
G Risk of poisoning
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
G Risk of fire
When operating the auxiliary heating, parts of
the vehicle may become very hot, and highly
inflammable material such as fuels could be
ignited. Operating the auxiliary heating is thus
prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle is being refuelled. You must therefore
switch off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
The auxiliary heating heats the air in the vehicle interior to the set temperature without
using the heat of the running engine. The auxiliary heating is operated directly using the
vehicle's fuel. For this reason, the tank content must be at least at reserve fuel level to
ensure that the auxiliary heating functions.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation automatically adjusts to changes in temperature and
weather conditions. For this reason, the auxiliary heating could switch from ventilation
mode to heating mode or from heating mode
to ventilation mode.
The auxiliary heating switches off automatically after 50 minutes. This time limit can be
altered. To do this, visit a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
You cannot use the auxiliary ventilation to
cool the vehicle interior to a temperature
lower than the outside temperature.
Before switching on
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the temperature.
X
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated even when the climate control is being
controlled manually. Optimum comfort can
be attained when the system is set to automatic mode. Set the temperature to 22 †.
The auxiliary heating/ventilation can be activated or deactivated using the remote control
or the button on the centre console.
The on-board computer can be used to specify up to three departure times, one of which
may be preselected (Y page 210).
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
i Switch on the auxiliary heating regularly,
e.g. for about ten minutes every month.
Z
119
Climate control
Operating the climate control system
120
Operating the climate control system
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the centre console
button
The remote control has a maximum range of
approximately 300 metres. This range is
reduced by:
Rsources
of radio interference
objects between the remote control
and the vehicle
Rthe remote control being in an unfavourable position in relation to the vehicle
Rtransmitting from an enclosed space
Rsolid
Climate control
i The optimum range can be achieved if you
The colours of the indicator lamps on the button have the following meanings:
Blue Auxiliary ventilation switched on
Red
Auxiliary heating switched on
Yellow Departure time preselected
(Y page 210)
hold the remote control vertically, pointing
upwards when you press one of the buttons.
i A battery symbol appears in the display
when the batteries in the remote control
are low. Replace the remote control batteries (Y page 121).
Switching on auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : lights up.
Switching off auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press button :.
The red or blue indicator lamp in button : goes out.
Switching the auxiliary heating/ventilation on/off using the remote control
Your vehicle comes with one remote control.
You may use two additional remote controls
for your vehicle. For further information, consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Auxiliary heating remote control
: Display
; . To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
= ^ To switch off the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
? u To switch on the auxiliary heating/
ventilation
A , To check the status/set the depar-
ture time
Switching on auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the u button.
ON is shown in the remote control display.
Operating the climate control system
Checking the status of the auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the , or . button.
The following messages can appear in the
display:
Display
Setting a departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the time to be changed appears in the
display.
X Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The Î symbol in the remote control display flashes.
X Press the , or . button to set the
desired departure time.
Meaning
i The longer you press the , or .
The auxiliary heating/
ventilation is switched
off.
X
The auxiliary ventilation
is switched on. The number in the display shows
the remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
ventilation.
The auxiliary heating is
switched on. The number
in the display shows the
remaining time (in
minutes) for the auxiliary
heating.
A departure time has
been activated. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary ventilation is currently selected. The
departure time appears
in the display.
A departure time has
been activated. The auxiliary heating is currently
selected. The departure
time appears in the display.
button, the faster the time changes.
Press the u and ^ buttons simultaneously.
The new departure time is stored.
Activating a set departure time
X Press the , or . button repeatedly
until the desired departure time appears in
the display.
X Press the u button.
The Í symbol and the departure time
appear in the display.
Deactivating a set departure time
X Press the , or . button.
The status of the auxiliary heating is shown
in the display.
X Press the . button.
The first departure time stored appears in
the display.
X Press the ^ button.
The display message OFF appears in the
display.
Replacing the remote control battery
One 6 V pin battery, type 2CR11108 is
required.
Z
Climate control
Switching off auxiliary heating/ventilation
X Press the ^ button.
OFF is shown in the remote control display.
121
Operating the climate control system
122
Prise apart the side arms of battery
cover ; and pull off battery cover ;.
X Remove old battery :.
X Insert the new battery. Observe the polarity
signs on the back of the remote control
when doing so.
X Slide battery cover ; back onto the
remote control.
X Use the remote control to check the vehicle's auxiliary heating functions.
Climate control
X
Adjusting the air vents
123
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
FAIL
The starter battery is not charged sufficiently or the system is
faulty.
X Charge the starter battery.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
$
The signal transmission between the transmitter and the vehicle
is faulty.
X Change your position in relation to the vehicle, moving closer if
necessary.
X Make another attempt to switch the auxiliary heating on or off
using the remote control.
FAIL
©
FAIL
There is not enough fuel in the fuel tank, or the auxiliary heating
is faulty.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
X Make another attempt to switch on the auxiliary heating using
the remote control.
X Have the auxiliary heating checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Important safety notes
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
G Risk of injury
Rkeep
Adjusting the air vents
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could cause burns or frostbite to
bare skin in the immediate vicinity of the
vents. Keep bare skin away from these air
outlets. If necessary, direct the airflow away
to a different area of the vehicle interior.
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of blockages, such as
ice, snow or leaves
Rnever cover the vents or air inlet and outlet
grilles in the vehicle interior
i For virtually draught-free ventilation,
adjust the sliders of the air vents to the
centre position.
Z
Climate control
Problems with auxiliary heating/ventilation
Adjusting the air vents
124
Setting the centre air vents
flow depends on the airflow and air distribution settings.
! Close the air vent when heating the vehi-
cle.
At high outside temperatures, open the air
vent and activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive items stored in the glove
compartment could be damaged.
: Centre air vent, left
Climate control
; Centre air vent, right
= Centre vent thumbwheel, right
? Centre vent thumbwheel, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheels =
and ? up or down.
Setting the side air vents
: Air vent thumbwheel
; Air vent
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel :
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
Setting the rear-compartment air
vents
Setting the centre vents in the rear compartment
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel = up or
down.
i Side window demister vent : is never
completely shut, even if side air vent ; is
shut.
Setting the air vents in the glove compartment
When automatic climate control is activated,
the glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance to cool its contents. The level of air-
: Rear-compartment air vent thumbwheel
; Rear-compartment air vent, right
Adjusting the air vents
125
= Rear control panel for THERMOTRONIC
luxury 3-zone automatic climate control
? Rear-compartment air vent, left
To open/close: turn thumbwheel : up or
down.
Climate control
X
Z
126
Vehicle equipment ............................
Running-in notes ...............................
Driving ...............................................
Automatic transmission ...................
Refuelling ...........................................
Parking ...............................................
Driving tips ........................................
Driving systems ................................
128
128
128
135
142
147
149
152
Driving and parking
127
128
Driving
Vehicle equipment
Driving and parking
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Running-in notes
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
New brake pads/linings only have optimal
braking performance after several hundred
kilometres. Until then, compensate for this by
applying greater force to the brake pedal. This
also applies when brake pads/linings or
brake discs have been changed.
The first 1,500 km
The more you look after the engine when it is
new, the more satisfied you will be with its
performance in the future.
RTherefore,
drive at varying speeds and
engine speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid overstraining the vehicle during this
period, e.g. driving at full throttle.
RChange gear in good time, at the latest
when the rev counter needle is 2/3 of the
way to the red area in the rev counter display.
RDo not manually shift to a lower gear to
brake the vehicle.
Rif possible, do not depress the accelerator
pedal past the point of resistance (kickdown).
Ronly select shift ranges 3, 2 or 1 when driving slowly, e.g. in mountainous terrain.
After 1,500 km, you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
Additional running-in notes for AMG vehicles:
Rdo not drive at speeds above 140 km/h for
the first 1,500 km.
allow the engine to reach a maximum
engine speed of 4,500 rpm briefly.
Ronly
i You should also observe these notes on
running in if the engine or parts of the drive
train on your vehicle have been replaced.
AMG vehicles with rear axle locking
differential
Your vehicle is fitted with a self-locking differential on the rear axle. Change the oil after
a running-in period of 3,000 km to improve
protection of the rear axle differential. This oil
change extends the service life of the differential. Have the oil change carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a MercedesBenz Service Centre for this purpose.
Driving
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
Do not place any objects in the driver's footwell. If you use a floormat or carpet in the
driver's footwell, make sure that it is correctly
secured and that there is sufficient clearance
for the pedals.
Do not place several floormats on top of one
another.
Loose objects or the floormats could otherwise get caught between the pedals if you
accelerate or brake suddenly. You will then
not be able to brake, declutch or accelerate
as intended. This could lead to accidents and
injury.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
Driving
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only set the automatic transmission to the
respective drive positions when the vehicle
is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. Otherwise, you could damage the
drive train.
! AMG vehicles: at low engine oil tempera-
tures (below +20 †), the maximum engine
speed is restricted in order to protect the
engine. To protect the engine and maintain
smooth engine operation, avoid driving at
full throttle when the engine is cold.
cle. Then, the ignition is not switched on.
The engine cannot be started.
KEYLESS-GO
General notes
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO are equipped with
a key featuring an integrated KEYLESS-GO
function and a detachable Start/Stop button.
The Start/Stop button must be inserted into
the ignition lock and the key must be in the
vehicle.
Pressing the Start/Stop button several times
in succession corresponds to the different
key positions in the ignition lock. This is only
the case if you are not depressing the brake
pedal.
If you depress the brake pedal and press the
Start/Stop button, the engine starts immediately.
Key positions
Key
Position 0: if Start/Stop button : has not
yet been pressed, this corresponds to the
key being removed from the ignition.
X Position 1: press Start/Stop button :.
You can now activate the windscreen wipers, for example.
X
g To remove the key
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 Starting the engine
i The key can be turned in the ignition lock
even if it is not the correct key for the vehi-
i If you then open the driver's door when in
this position, the power supply is deactivated.
X
Position 2 (ignition): press Start/Stop button : twice.
i If you press Start/Stop button : once
when in this position and the driver's door
Z
Driving and parking
the vehicle could skid. This could cause you
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident.
129
Driving
130
Driving and parking
is open, the power supply is deactivated
again.
Removing the Start/Stop button
You can remove the Start/Stop button from
the ignition lock and start the vehicle as normal using the key.
i You do not have to remove the Start/Stop
button from the ignition lock when you
leave the vehicle.
Automatic transmission
X
Shift the transmission to position P.
The transmission position display in the
multifunction display shows P.
i You can also start the engine when the
transmission is in position N.
Starting procedure with the key
i To start the engine using the key instead
of KEYLESS-GO, pull the Start/Stop button
out of the ignition lock.
To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock
(Y page 129) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 129).
The % preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the % preglow indicator lamp
goes out, turn the key to position 3
(Y page 129) and release it as soon as the
engine is running.
X
X
Remove Start/Stop button : from ignition
lock ;.
i When you insert Start/Stop button :
into ignition lock ;, the system needs
approximately two seconds recognition
time before you can use Start/Stop button :.
i You can start the engine without preglow
if the engine is warm.
i You can also use the touch-start function.
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G Risk of poisoning
Never leave the engine running in enclosed
spaces. The exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide. Inhaling exhaust fumes constitutes a health hazard and could lead to loss
of consciousness or even death.
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
To do this, turn the key to position 3
(Y page 129) and release it immediately.
The engine then starts automatically.
Using KEYLESS-GO to start the engine
G Risk of injury
Your vehicle can be started using a valid KEYLESS-GO key. For this reason, children should
never be left unsupervised in the vehicle.
Always take the key with you when leaving the
vehicle, even if you are only leaving it for a
short time.
i The Start/Stop button can be used to
start the vehicle manually without inserting
the key into the ignition lock. The key must
be in the vehicle and the Start/Stop button
must be inserted in the ignition lock. This
mode for starting the engine operates independently of the ECO start/stop automatic
engine start function.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X To start a petrol engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 129) once.
The engine starts.
X To start a diesel engine: press the Start/
Stop button (Y page 129) once.
Preglow is activated and the engine starts.
X
It holds the vehicle for a short time after you
have removed your foot from the brake pedal.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to
roll.
G Risk of accident
Never leave the vehicle when it is held by hill
start assist. After approximately one second,
hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
X
brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around
one second.
Pulling away
Automatic transmission
i It is only possible to shift the transmission
from position P to the desired position if
you depress the brake pedal. Only then is
the parking lock released.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 148).
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
X
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 209).
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Take your foot off the brake pedal.
i Once you have taken your foot off the
X
Pull away.
Hill start assist will not function if:
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Rthe transmission is in position N.
Rthe parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
ECO start/stop function
General notes
The ECO start/stop function is only available
for the CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY and
CLS 63 AMG models.
AMG vehicles: the ECO start/stop function
is only available in the C drive program.
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically when the vehicle
stops moving.
The engine starts automatically when you pull
away again. The ECO start/stop function
thereby helps you to reduce the fuel consumption and emissions of your vehicle.
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
forwards or in reverse on an uphill gradient.
Z
131
Driving and parking
Driving
Driving and parking
132
Driving
active. If you open the door, unfasten your
seat belt or remove your foot from the brake
pedal, the engine will automatically start. The
vehicle may begin moving. You could suffer
serious or even fatal injury or cause an accident resulting in injury or death.
Never leave the vehicle while the ECO symbol
in the multifunction display is shown in green
or yellow. Always secure the vehicle against
rolling away before leaving it.
: ECO symbol for CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
! Always switch the ignition off and take the
key with you when leaving the vehicle.
Automatic engine switch-off
: ECO symbol for CLS 63 AMG
; ECO start/stop display message for
CLS 63 AMG
The ECO start/stop function is activated each
time the engine is switched on. If all conditions for automatic engine switch-off are fulfilled (Y page 132), ECO symbol : is shown
in green in the multifunction display.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows Stop/
Start active message ;.
If not all conditions are fulfilled, ECO symbol : is shown in yellow.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows Stop/
Start inactive message ;.
If the ECO start/stop function is deactivated
(Y page 133), ECO symbol : is not shown.
AMG vehicles: the AMG menu in the multifunction display additionally shows Stop/
Start deactivated message ;.
G Risk of accident and injury
If the engine is switched off and the ECO symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display, the engine has been switched off automatically. All of the vehicle's systems remain
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is
braked to a standstill and the brake remains
depressed with the transmission in position
D or N.
i You can still activate HOLD when the vehi-
cle is stationary, even if the engine has
been switched off automatically. It is then
not necessary to continue applying the
brakes during the automatic stop phase.
When you depress the accelerator pedal,
the engine starts automatically and the
braking effect of the HOLD function is deactivated. Depress the accelerator pedal
carefully, as the engine must be started
first.
The engine is only switched off if:
Rthe outside temperature is within the range
which is suitable for the system.
engine is at normal operating temperature.
Rthe set temperature for the vehicle interior
has been reached.
Rthe battery is sufficiently charged.
Rthe system detects that the windscreen is
not misted up when the air-conditioning
system is switched on.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe front door is closed and the seat belt is
fastened.
Rthe
Automatic engine start
The engine is started automatically if you:
Rrelease
the brake pedal when HOLD is not
activated and the transmission is in position D or N
Rshift the transmission to position R
Rdepress the accelerator pedal
Rswitch off the ECO start/stop function by
pressing the ECO button (except for AMG
vehicles)
Rchange to drive program S, S+ or M (AMG
vehicles)
Runfasten your seat belt or open the driver's
door
The engine is also started automatically if:
Rthe
vehicle starts to roll.
brake system requires this.
Rthe system detects moisture on the windscreen when the air-conditioning system is
switched on.
Rthe temperature in the vehicle interior deviates from the set range.
Rthe battery's charge status is too low.
Rthe
Switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on (except for AMG vehicles)
: To deactivate/activate the ECO start/
stop function
; Indicator lamp
X
X
To activate: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up and the ECO
symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display.
If not all conditions are fulfilled, the ECO
symbol is shown in yellow in the multifunction display. If this is the case, the ECO
start/stop function is not available.
If indicator lamp ; is off, the ECO start/stop
function has been deactivated manually or as
the result of a malfunction. The engine will
then not be switched off automatically when
the vehicle stops.
i The ECO start/stop function is activated
each time the engine is switched on.
Switching the ECO start/stop function
off/on (AMG vehicles)
Deactivating
X Change to drive program S, S+ or M.
The ECO symbol goes out and the Stop/
Start deactivated message is shown in
the multifunction display.
Activating
X Change to drive program C.
If all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 132) are fulfilled, the
ECO symbol is shown in green in the multifunction display. In addition, the Stop/
Start active message is shown in the
multifunction display.
If not all conditions for automatic engine
switch-off (Y page 132) are fulfilled, the
Stop/Start inactive message appears
and the ECO symbol is shown in yellow.
i Every time you restart the engine, the
automatic transmission switches to the
automatic drive program C.
To deactivate: press button :.
Indicator lamp ; and the ECO symbol in
the multifunction display go out.
Z
133
Driving and parking
Driving
134
Driving
Driving and parking
Problems with the engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The engine does not
start.
The HOLD function or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
X Deactivate the HOLD function (Y page 165) or DISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 154).
X Try to start the engine again.
The engine does not
start. The starter motor
can be heard.
RThere
is a malfunction in the engine electronics.
is a malfunction in the fuel supply.
X Before attempting to start the engine again, turn the key in the
ignition back to position 0 or press the Start/Stop button
repeatedly until all indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go
out.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 130). Avoid excessively
long and frequent attempts to start the engine as this will drain
the battery.
RThere
If the engine does not start after several attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The engine does not
The fuel tank is empty.
start. The starter motor X Refuel the vehicle.
can be heard. The
reserve fuel warning
lamp is lit and the fuel
gauge display shows 0.
The engine does not
start. You cannot hear
the starter motor.
The on-board voltage is too low because the starter battery is too
weak or discharged.
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 294).
If the engine does not start despite attempts to jump-start it:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
The starter motor was exposed to a thermal load that was too high.
X Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicles with a petrol
engine:
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the engine electronics or a mechanical
component of the engine management system.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter and damage it.
The coolant temperaThe coolant level is too low. The coolant is too hot and the engine
ture display is showing is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
more than 120 †. The X Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant
coolant warning lamp
to cool down.
may also be lit and a
X Check the coolant level (Y page 268). Observe the warning
warning tone may
notes as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
sound.
If the coolant level is correct, the radiator fan may be faulty. The
coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X At coolant temperatures under 120 †, drive on to the nearest
qualified specialist workshop e.g. to a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop/start driving.
Automatic transmission
Important safety notes
to lose control of your vehicle and cause an
accident.
G Risk of accident
The movement of the pedals must not be
impaired in any way. Do not keep any objects
in the driver's footwell. Make sure that floormats or carpets are correctly secured and
that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals.
Do not place several floormats on top of one
another.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid. This could cause you
Z
135
Driving and parking
Automatic transmission
136
Automatic transmission
Selector lever
Driving and parking
Overview of transmission positions
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
P Park position with parking lock
R Reverse gear
N Neutral
D Drive
Transmission position and drive program display
P
R
N
D
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
i The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns
to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the
transmission position display
(Y page 136) in the multifunction display.
Engaging park position P
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
i The automatic transmission shifts auto-
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
DIRECT SELECT lever
Overview of transmission positions
The DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
matically into park position P if you open
the driver's door when the vehicle is stationary or driving at very low speed, and the
transmission is in position D or R.
i If you depress the brake pedal and push
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down, the
parking lock is disengaged and the transmission shifts to neutral N.
If you want to shift from park position P
directly to R or D, depress the brake and
push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
past the first point of resistance.
! If the engine speed is too high, do not shift
the automatic transmission directly from
D to R, from R to D or directly to P. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be
damaged.
Automatic transmission
137
Engaging reverse gear R
! Only shift the automatic transmission to
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
Neutral N with ECO start/stop function
activated
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is
braked to a standstill when in neutral N and
the brake is still depressed.
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function: (Y page 131).
Shifting to neutral N
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
Transmission position D with ECO
start/stop function activated
The ECO start/stop function switches the
engine off automatically if the vehicle is
braked to a standstill when in transmission
position D and the brake is still depressed.
For further information on the ECO start/stop
function (Y page 131).
: Transmission position
i The arrows in the transmission position
display show how and into which transmission positions you can change using the
DIRECT SELECT lever.
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. Ideally, you should select transmission position D and drive program E or
S. Do not restrict the shift range.
Transmission positions
B
Shifting to transmission position D
X
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
Park position
Prevents the vehicle from rolling
away when stopped. Do not shift
the transmission into position
P (Y page 147) unless the vehicle
is stationary.
The automatic transmission shifts
to P automatically if you:
Rremove
the key
off the engine when in R
or D and open one of the front
doors
Transmission position display
Rswitch
The current transmission position is shown in
the multifunction display.
C
Reverse gear
Only shift the transmission to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Driving and parking
R when the vehicle is stationary.
X
138
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
A
Neutral
Do not shift the transmission to N
while driving. Otherwise, the automatic transmission could be damaged.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only shift the transmission to position N if the vehicle is in danger of
skidding, e.g. on icy roads.
If you switch off the engine using
the key or the Start/Stop button,
the automatic transmission shifts
to neutral N automatically.
! Rolling in neutral N can lead to
damage to the transmission.
7
Drive
The automatic transmission
changes gear automatically. All
forward gears are available.
AMG vehicles
When shifting down, the double-clutch function is active regardless of the currently selected drive program. The double-clutch function
reduces load change reactions and is conducive to a sporty driving style. The sound generated by the double-clutch function depends
on the drive program selected.
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The automatic transmission shifts back up.
X
Program selector button
Changing gears
The automatic transmission shifts to the individual gears automatically when it is in transmission position D. This automatic gearshifting behaviour is determined by:
General notes
The program selector button allows you to
choose between different driving characteristics.
Ra
shift range restriction, if selected
selected drive program (Y page 138)
Rthe position of the accelerator pedal
Rthe road speed
Rthe
Driving tips
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how the automatic transmission shifts gear:
Rlittle
throttle: early upshifts
Rmore throttle: late upshifts
Program selector button (example)
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
Automatic transmission
drive program" (Y page 139).
X
Press program selector button : repeatedly until the letter for the desired gearshift
program appears in the multifunction display.
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program C each time the
engine is started.
i RS cannot be selected during normal driving. For further information on RACE START
(Y page 166).
i The automatic transmission switches to
automatic drive program E each time the
engine is started.
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
AMG vehicles
: Left-hand steering wheel gearshift paddle
; Right-hand steering wheel gearshift padProgram selector with manual drive program
C Controlled
Efficiency
Comfortable, economical
driving
S Sport
Sporty driving style
S+ SportPlus
Extremely sporty driving
style
M Manual
Manual gearshifting
RS RACE
START
Optimal vehicle acceleration from a standstill
i For further information on "Drive program" (Y page 139).
X
Turn program selector : until the desired
drive program appears in the multifunction
display in the speedometer.
The drive program indicator on program
selector : lights up in red.
dle
You can restrict or derestrict the shift range
by using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
You can change gear yourself by using the
steering wheel gearshift paddle in the manual
drive program.
i You can only change gear with the steer-
ing wheel gearshift paddles when the transmission is in position D.
Automatic drive program
Drive program E (drive program C on AMG
vehicles) is characterised by the following:
Rcomfort-oriented engine and automatic
transmission settings
Roptimal fuel consumption resulting from
the automatic transmission shifting up
sooner
Rthe vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears, unless the
accelerator pedal is depressed fully
Z
Driving and parking
i Further information on the "Automatic
139
140
Automatic transmission
Driving and parking
Rincreased sensitivity. This improves driving
stability on slippery road surfaces, for
example.
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
sooner. This results in the vehicle being
driven at lower engine speeds and the
wheels being less likely to spin.
Drive program S (drive programs S and S+ on
AMG vehicles) is characterised by the following:
engine and automatic transmission
settings
Rthe vehicle pulling away in first gear
Rthe automatic transmission shifting up
later
Ras a result of the later automatic transmission shift points, the fuel consumption may
be higher
5
Ron
steep mountain roads
mountainous terrain
Rin arduous conditions
Rin
4
Rsporty
Shift ranges
steering wheel gearshift paddles, you
can restrict or derestrict the shift range
using the steering wheel gearshift paddles.
When the automatic transmission is in position D, it is possible to restrict or derestrict
the shift range (Y page 140).
The shift range selected is shown in the multifunction display. The automatic transmission shifts only as far as the selected gear.
Driving situations
=
You can use the engine's braking
effect.
To use the braking effect of the
engine on extremely steep downhill
gradients and on long downhill
stretches
Restricting the shift range
X
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The automatic transmission shifts down
one gear and restricts the shift range to the
relevant gear.
i If the engine exceeds the maximum
engine speed when shifting down, the automatic transmission protects against engine
damage by not shifting down.
Introduction
i On AMG vehicles and vehicles with
To use the braking effect of the
engine on downhill gradients and
for driving:
i If the maximum engine speed for the shift
range is reached and you continue to accelerate, the automatic transmission shifts up
in order to prevent the engine from overrevving, even if the shift range is restricted.
Derestricting the shift range
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle.
The shift range is derestricted.
Clearing the shift range restriction
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle until the number for the gear disappears from the multifunction display.
or
X
Shift the transmission to position D.
The automatic transmission shifts from the
current shift range directly to D.
Automatic transmission
Selecting the ideal shift range
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle and hold it in position.
The automatic transmission shifts to the
gear which allows optimum acceleration
and deceleration. To do this, the automatic
transmission shifts down one or more
gears.
area of the rev counter. Otherwise, there is
a risk of engine damage.
X
Downshifting
X
Manual drive program
Switching on the manual drive program
AMG vehicles and vehicles with a DIRECT
SELECT lever: you can select manual drive
program M using the program selector or the
program selector button. In manual drive program M, you can change gear yourself using
the steering wheel gearshift paddles if the
transmission is in position D.
X Press the program selector button
(Y page 138) repeatedly until M appears in
the multifunction display.
X
AMG vehicles: turn the program selector
(Y page 139) until M appears in the multifunction display.
The indicator M on the program selector
lights up in red.
Shift up a gear if the colour in the multifunction display in the speedometer
changes to red and UP appears in the rev
counter.
Pull the left-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 139).
The automatic transmission shifts down to
the next gear.
i If you slow down or stop without shifting
down, the automatic transmission automatically shifts down.
i For maximum acceleration, pull the left-
hand steering wheel gearshift paddle until
the transmission selects the optimum gear
for the current speed.
Kickdown
i Vehicles with an AMG engine: it is not
possible to use kickdown in manual drive
program M.
You can also use kickdown for maximum
acceleration in manual drive program M.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Shift back up once the desired speed is
reached.
X
Upshifting
X
Pull the right-hand steering wheel gearshift
paddle (Y page 139).
The automatic transmission shifts up to the
next gear.
Vehicles with AMG engines
! In manual gearshift program M, the auto-
matic transmission does not shift up automatically even when the engine limiting
speed for the current gear is reached.
When the engine limiting speed is reached,
the fuel supply is cut to prevent the engine
from overrevving. You must make sure that
the engine speed does not reach the red
Switching off the manual drive program
Standard vehicles with the DIRECT
SELECT lever: press the program selector
button (Y page 138) until E or S is shown
in the multifunction display.
X AMG vehicles: turn the program selector
(Y page 139) until C, S or S+ appears in the
multifunction display.
X
Z
Driving and parking
X
141
142
Refuelling
Problems with the transmission
Driving and parking
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The transmission has
The transmission is losing oil.
problems shifting gear. X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, immediately.
The acceleration ability The transmission is in emergency mode.
is deteriorating.
It is only possible to shift into second gear and reverse gear.
The transmission no
X Stop the vehicle.
longer changes gear.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off the engine.
X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
If D is selected, the transmission shifts into second gear; if R is
selected, the transmission shifts into reverse gear.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, immediately.
Refuelling
Important safety notes
G Risk of explosion
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
G Risk of injury
Do not come into contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
G Risk of fire
Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a diesel engine. Do not mix diesel with petrol. This
would result in damage to the fuel system and
engine, which could lead to a vehicle fire.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even a small
quantity of the wrong fuel will damage the
fuel system and engine.
! Do not switch on the ignition if you acci-
dentally refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the fuel will enter the fuel lines. Notify
a qualified specialist workshop and have
the fuel tank and fuel lines drained completely.
Petrol (EN 228)
Fuel grade
! Only refuel using unleaded premium-
grade petrol with at least
95 RON/85 MON, which conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent
specification.
! Do not use the following:
RE85
(petrol with 85 % ethanol)
(100 % ethanol)
RM15 (petrol with 15 % methanol)
RE100
Refuelling
(petrol with 85 % methanol)
(100 % methanol)
Rdiesel
Do not mix these fuels with petrol and do
not use any special additives. Otherwise,
this can lead to damage to the engine. This
does not include additives for the removal
and prevention of residue build-up on the
inlet valves.
RM100
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. The fuel lines and/or the diesel injection system could otherwise be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
i If the recommended fuel is not available,
but only as a temporary measure, you may
also use regular unleaded petrol,
91 RON/82.5 MON. This may reduce
engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle.
In some countries, the fuel grade available
may not be adequate and could cause residue to build up around the inlet valves. In
such cases, and in consultation with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, the petrol
may be mixed with the additive recommended by Mercedes-Benz (part no.
A000989254510). You must observe the
notes and mixing ratios specified on the
container.
For further information on "Fuel", see
(Y page 319).
AMG vehicles
! Only refuel using super-grade unleaded
petrol with at least 98 RON/88 MON,
which conforms to European standard EN
228 or equivalent.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
i If the recommended fuel is not available
and only as a temporary measure, you may
also use premium-grade unleaded petrol,
95 RON/85 MON. This may reduce engine
performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle.
! In emergencies, and only when the rec-
ommended fuel is not available, you may
also use standard unleaded petrol,
91 RON/82.5 MON.
However, using this fuel results in considerably higher petrol consumption and significantly reduced engine performance.
Avoid driving at full throttle.
If no fuel other than regular petrol with
91 RON/82.5 MON or a lower grade is permanently available, you should have the
vehicle adapted to run on this fuel by the
local after-sales service centre.
CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
! Only refuel using unleaded, sulphur-free
premium-grade petrol with at least
95 RON/85 MON, which conforms to European standard EN 228 or an equivalent
specification.
You can otherwise impair engine output or
damage the engine.
i In some countries, the available petrol
may not be sufficiently low in sulphur. This
fuel can temporarily produce unpleasant
odours, especially on short journeys. As
soon as sulphur-free fuel (sulphur content
< 10 ppm) is used for refuelling, the odours
are reduced.
Diesel (EN 590, DIN 51628)
Fuel grade
! Only refuel with diesel that conforms to
European standard EN 590 or German
standard DIN 51628 or equivalent. You can
otherwise impair engine output or damage
the engine.
! Vehicles with diesel particle filters: in
countries outside the EU, only use low sulphur Euro diesel with a sulphur content of
Z
Driving and parking
RM85
143
144
Refuelling
under 50 ppm. Otherwise, the emission
control system could be damaged.
Driving and parking
! Vehicles without a diesel particle fil-
ter: the engine oil should be changed more
frequently in countries in which diesel with
a higher sulphur content is available. More
information about intervals for changing
the engine oil can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Using fuel that does not conform to Euro-
pean standard EN 590 or German standard
DIN 51628 can lead to increased wear,
engine damage and damage to the exhaust
system.
Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
oil
Rbio-diesel
Rvegetable oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not mix these fuels with diesel fuels and
do not use any special additives. Otherwise, this can lead to damage to the engine.
This excludes flow improver, see "Low outside temperatures".
Rheating
! Use a filter when adding fuel from a fuel
can. Otherwise, the fuel lines and/or the
diesel injection system could be blocked by
particles from the fuel can.
For further information on "Fuel", see
(Y page 319).
Low outside temperatures
Diesel fuel with improved cold flow qualities
is available during the winter months. In
Europe, various climate-dependent low-temperature classes are defined in EN 590. Refuelling with diesel fuel which complies with the
climatic specifications of standard EN 590
can help to prevent operating problems. At
exceptionally low temperatures, it is possible
that the flow properties of the fuel may be
inadequate. This also applies to fuel that has
not been adapted to suit the climatic conditions, e.g. diesel fuel from warmer regions.
i Further information about country-spe-
cific fuel properties can be obtained from
oil companies, e.g. at filling stations.
Flow improver
Flow improvers can be added to improve the
cold resistance of diesel fuel. The effectiveness of a flow improver is not guaranteed with
every fuel.
Correct dosage and thorough mixing are decisive factors in ensuring improvement in lowtemperature resistance. Under certain circumstances, an excessive dosage may
actually decrease low-temperature resistance and should therefore be avoided. Follow
the manufacturer's dosing instructions.
Mix the additive with the diesel in good time,
before the flow properties of the diesel
become inadequate. Malfunctions can otherwise only be rectified by heating the entire
fuel system, e.g. by parking the vehicle in a
heated garage.
Observe the information provided by the manufacturer when using a flow improver. Only
use flow improvers that have been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain
further information from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Refuelling
Fuel filler flap
The fuel filler flap is unlocked or locked automatically when you open or close the vehicle
with the key or using KEYLESS-GO.
The fuel filler flap is located to the rear on the
right. The position of the fuel filler cap is displayed in the instrument cluster 8. The
arrow next to the filling pump indicates the
side of the vehicle.
Refuelling
145
Fuel filler flap emergency release
The edges on the inside of the vehicle body
can be sharp. You could injure yourself when
using the fuel filler flap emergency release.
Avoid contact with the edges on the inside of
the vehicle body.
: To open the fuel filler flap
; To insert the fuel filler cap
= Tyre pressure table
? Fuel type
The emergency release is located in the boot
behind the side trim on the right-hand side,
when viewed in the direction of travel.
X Open the boot lid.
X Slide down the luggage net.
X Open the side trim.
Opening
Press the fuel filler flap in the direction of
arrow :.
The fuel filler flap opens slightly.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X Turn the fuel filler cap anti-clockwise and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of filler flap ;.
X Completely insert the fuel pump nozzle into
the filler neck and refuel.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
X
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
Detach the emergency release from
retainer :.
X Pull the emergency release in the direction
of arrow ;.
The fuel filler flap is unlocked.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X
Closing
Replace the fuel filler cap and turn it clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly engages.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
i Close the fuel filler flap before locking the
vehicle. A locking pin otherwise prevents
the fuel filler flap from closing after the
vehicle has been locked.
Z
Driving and parking
G Risk of injury
146
Refuelling
Problems with the fuel and fuel tank
Driving and parking
Problem
Fuel is leaking from the
vehicle.
The fuel filler flap cannot be opened.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is defective.
X Turn the key to position 0(Y page 129) in the ignition lock
immediately and remove it.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The fuel filler flap is not unlocked.
or
The key batteries are discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 69).
X Open the boot lid.
X Manually unlock the fuel filler flap using the emergency release
(Y page 145).
Parking
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The fuel filler flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is jammed.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The engine will not
start.
The fuel tank of a vehicle with a diesel engine has been run completely dry.
X Refuel the vehicle with at least 5 litres of diesel.
X Turn the ignition on for at least 10 seconds (Y page 129).
X Start the engine continuously for up to 10 seconds until it runs
smoothly.
or
X Start the engine via the touch-start function. To do this, turn the
key to position 3(Y page 129) in the ignition lock and then
release it immediately.
If the engine does not start:
X Turn the ignition on again for approximately 10 seconds
(Y page 129).
X Start the engine again continuously for up to 10 seconds until
it runs smoothly.
or
X Start the engine again via the touch-start function.
If the engine does not start after three attempts:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Parking
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
Only remove the key from the ignition lock
when the vehicle is stationary, as you cannot
steer the vehicle when the key is removed.
Never leave children unsupervised in the vehicle. They could release the parking brake. This
could lead to a serious or fatal accident.
G Risk of fire
land or harvested grain fields. The hot exhaust
system could otherwise ignite the flammable
material and set the vehicle on fire.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe
parking brake must be applied.
transmission must be in position P and
the key must be removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron steep uphill or downhill gradients, turn
the front wheels towards the kerb.
Rthe
Under no circumstances should the exhaust
system come into contact with flammable
materials such as dry grass or petrol, for
example. Do not park the vehicle on dry grassZ
Driving and parking
Problem
147
Parking
148
If you shift the automatic transmission to
N before switching off the engine, the automatic transmission remains in N even when
a door is opened.
Switching off the engine
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G Risk of accident
If the engine is not running, there is no power
assistance for the steering and brakes. Steering and braking then requires significantly
greater effort.
As a result, you might lose control of the vehicle, cause an accident and injure yourself and
others.
Therefore, do not switch off the engine while
you are driving.
Vehicles with automatic transmission
X
X
Apply the parking brake firmly.
Standard vehicles: shift the transmission
to P.
Using KEYLESS-GO
Press the Start/Stop button (Y page 129).
The engine stops and all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster go out.
i When the driver's door is closed, this corresponds to key position 1. When the driver's door is open, this corresponds to key
position 0, "key removed".
X
i If you use the Start/Stop button to switch
off the engine, the automatic transmission
shifts to N automatically. If you then open
the driver's or front-passenger door, the
automatic transmission shifts to P.
i The engine can be turned off while the
vehicle is in motion by pressing and holding
the Start/Stop button for three seconds.
This function operates independently from
the ECO start/stop automatic engine
switch-off function.
Parking brake
Selector lever in AMG vehicles with P button
X
AMG vehicles: press P button :.
Using the key
X
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
i If you switch the engine off with the transmission in position R or D, the automatic
transmission shifts to N automatically.
If you then open the driver's door or the
front-passenger door or remove the key
from the ignition, the automatic transmission shifts to P.
Driving tips
Parking up the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than four weeks, the battery may be damaged
by exhaustive discharge.
X Disconnect the battery (Y page 292) or
connect it to a trickle charger.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
If you leave the vehicle parked up for longer
than six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a result of lack of use.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
Driving tips
General driving tips
Rolling with the engine switched off
G Risk of accident
Never switch the engine off while the vehicle
is in motion.
There is no power assistance for the steering
and the service brake when the engine is not
running.
You will require considerably more effort to
steer and brake, and you could therefore lose
control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
Engine oil
! Vehicles with a diesel particle filter:
If the vehicle is mostly driven for short distances, it is possible that malfunctions may
occur during the automatic cleaning of the
diesel particle filter. This can lead to engine
damage. Therefore, if you frequently drive
short distances, make sure to drive on
motorways or country roads for 20 minutes
at least every 500 km.
Brakes
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G Risk of accident
Make sure that other road users are not
endangered by your braking.
Downhill gradients
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must select
shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time.
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control, SPEEDTRONIC or DISTRONIC PLUS.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
the speed. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
Z
Driving and parking
To apply: depress parking brake ; firmly.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if the engine is running.
X To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
X Pull release handle :.
The J indicator lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
149
150
Driving tips
Heavy and light loads
Driving and parking
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed. This improves the grip of the
brakes.
Wet road surface
If driving in heavy rain for a prolonged period
of time without braking, there may be a
delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first time. This may also occur after
the vehicle has been washed.
You have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the
vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm
up the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salt
treated roads
G Risk of accident
The layer of salt on the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings may cause a delay in the
braking effect, resulting in a significantly longer braking distance, which could lead to an
accident.
To avoid this danger, you should:
Roccasionally
brake carefully, without putting other road users at risk, when you are
driving on salted roads. This helps to
remove any salt that may have started to
build up on the brake discs and the brake
pads/linings.
Rmaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead and drive with particular care.
Rcarefully apply the brakes at the end of a
trip and immediately after commencing a
new trip, so that salt residues are removed
from the brake discs.
New brake pads/linings
G Risk of accident
New brake pads/linings only reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Before this optimum braking effect is reached, you should compensate
for the reduced braking effect by applying
greater pressure when braking. This also
applies after the brake discs or the brake
pads/linings have been replaced.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
High-performance brake system for
AMG vehicles
The AMG brake systems are designed for
heavy loads. This may lead to noise when
braking. This will depend on:
Rspeed
Rbraking
force
Renvironmental conditions, such as temper-
ature and humidity
The wear of individual components of the
brake system, such as the brake pads/linings
Driving tips
Tyre traction
G Risk of accident
Whereas the vehicle can be fully controlled at
a certain speed on dry roads, you must reduce
your speed on wet or icy roads to achieve the
same road safety. You could otherwise cause
an accident.
Pay particular attention to the road conditions
at temperatures around freezing point.
If ice has formed on the road surface (e.g.
from fog), a thin film of water rapidly forms on
the ice when you brake, considerably reducing tyre traction. Drive with particular care in
such weather conditions.
Driving on wet roads
Aquaplaning
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
drive at low speeds
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, do not drive in tyre ruts, and
brake carefully.
Rthe
Driving on flooded roads
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe maximum permitted still water depth is
25 cm.
should drive no faster than at walking
pace.
Ryou
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. You could otherwise damage the engine, the electronics or the transmission.
Winter driving
General notes
G Risk of poisoning
If the vehicle becomes trapped in snow,
ensure that snow is kept away from the
exhaust pipe and from around the vehicle as
long as the engine is running. Otherwise, poisonous carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the
vehicle, resulting in loss of consciousness and
even death.
To assure sufficient fresh air ventilation, open
a window slightly on the side of the vehicle
not facing the wind.
At the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section .
Slippery road surfaces
G Risk of accident
Do not shift down for additional engine braking on a slippery road surface. This could
Z
Driving and parking
or brake discs, depends on the individual driving style and operating conditions.
For this reason, it is impossible to state a
mileage that will be valid under all circumstances. An aggressive driving style will lead
to high wear. You can obtain further information about this from your Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
151
Driving systems
152
Driving and parking
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X
X
Shift the transmission to position N.
Try to bring the vehicle under control by
using corrective steering.
i For more information on driving with
snow chains, see (Y page 304).
Driving systems
Cruise control
Important safety notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. It brakes automatically in order
to avoid exceeding the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must select shift range
1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine,
which relieves the load on the brake system
and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
Cruise control is only an aid designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the vehicle's
speed and for braking in good time.
G Risk of accident
Do not use cruise control:
Rin road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed (e.g.
heavy traffic or winding roads). You could
otherwise cause an accident.
Ron slippery roads. Braking or accelerating
could cause the drive wheels to lose traction and the vehicle could then skid.
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
Cruise control lever
You can operate cruise control and variable
SPEEDTRONIC with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control is
selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
G Risk of accident
Cruise control cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when cruise control is activated.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
= To store the current speed or call up the
last stored speed
? To store the current speed or a lower
speed
Driving systems
iable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate cruise control
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for five seconds. In the multifunction display,
the segments between the stored speed and
the maximum speed light up.
Selecting cruise control
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ? to the pressure point.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
wise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
X
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
X
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically applying the brakes.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the last stored speed
G Risk of accident
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can other-
Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Z
Driving and parking
A To switch between cruise control and var-
153
Driving systems
154
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
Driving and parking
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Brake.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
depress the parking brake.
are driving at less than 30 km/h.
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®.
Ryou shift the transmission to position N
while driving.
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear
a warning tone. You will see the Cruise
control off message in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
Ryou
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
DISTRONIC PLUS
Important safety notes
DISTRONIC PLUS regulates the speed and
automatically helps you maintain the distance to the vehicle detected in front. It
brakes automatically in order to avoid
exceeding the set speed.
On long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden, you must select
shift range 1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing
so, you will make use of the braking effect of
the engine, which relieves the load on the
brake system and prevents the brakes from
overheating and wearing too quickly.
If a slower-moving vehicle is detected in front,
DISTRONIC PLUS causes your vehicle to
brake and maintain a preset distance to the
vehicle in front.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
G Risk of accident
DISTRONIC PLUS is only an aid designed to
assist driving. The driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other
vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for braking
in good time.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not react in particular
to:
Rpedestrians
Rstationary obstacles on the road, e.g. stop-
ped or parked vehicles
and crossing traffic
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect narrow vehicles driving in front, e.g. motorcycles, or vehicles driving on a different line. Therefore,
always pay attention to traffic conditions even
when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Roncoming
G Risk of accident
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions. If DISTRONIC does not
recognise or no longer recognises the vehicle
in front, do not activate DISTRONIC or, if it is
already active, deactivate it. This is especially
the case:
Rbefore
Ron
corners
filter lanes
Driving systems
traffic
Rin complex driving situations or where lanes
are diverted, e.g. at roadworks on a motorway
DISTRONIC PLUS otherwise maintains the
current speed set by you or accelerates up to
the set speed.
DISTRONIC PLUS cannot take account of
weather conditions. Deactivate, or do not
activate, DISTRONIC PLUS:
Rif
the roads are slippery, snow-covered or
icy. The wheels could lose their grip when
braking or accelerating. The vehicle could
start to skid.
Rif the sensors are dirty or there is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow, rain or fog. Distance control may be impaired.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated.
Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers
in time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
! You must deactivate the radar sensor system in certain countries and near radio
telescope facilities. You will find further
information under "Radar sensor system"
in the index.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 327).
If you want DISTRONIC PLUS to assist you,
the radar sensor system must be activated
(Y page 210) and operational.
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control in the speed range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h. If a vehicle is driving
in front of you, DISTRONIC operates in the
speed range between 0 km/h and
200 km/h.
Do not use DISTRONIC PLUS while driving on
roads with steep gradients.
G Risk of accident
DISTRONIC PLUS brakes your vehicle up to a
maximum of 4 m/s2 depending on its speed.
This corresponds to approximately 40% of
your vehicle's maximum braking power. You
must also apply the brakes yourself if this
braking power is not sufficient.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a risk of collision
with a vehicle in front, an intermittent warning
tone sounds. In addition, the · distance
warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up. Brake to avoid a collision.
Cruise control lever
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: DISTRONIC PLUS
is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; To set the specified minimum distance
= LIM indicator lamp
? To store the current speed or call up the
last stored speed
A To store the current speed or a lower
speed
Z
Driving and parking
Rwhen changing to a lane with faster moving
155
Driving systems
156
B To switch between DISTRONIC PLUS and
variable SPEEDTRONIC
Driving and parking
C To deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
Selecting DISTRONIC PLUS
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp = is off.
If it is off, DISTRONIC PLUS is already selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow B.
LIM indicator lamp = in the cruise control
lever goes out. DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Switching on DISTRONIC PLUS, storing
the current speed and maintaining it
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
The vehicle can be braked when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated. For this reason, deactivate
DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle is to be set in
motion by other means (e.g. in a car wash or
by towing).
In order to activate DISTRONIC PLUS, the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
engine must be started, and you have
been driving for up to two minutes.
Rthe parking brake must not be applied.
Ryour vehicle must not be secured by the
electric parking brake.
RESP® must be activated.
Rthe transmission must be in position D.
Rthe bonnet must be closed.
Rthe driver's door must be closed when you
shift from P to D or your seat belt must be
fastened.
Rthe front-passenger door and rear doors
must be closed.
Rthe vehicle must not skid.
Activating while driving
When driving at speeds below 30 km/h, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS if the vehicle in front has been detected and is shown
in the multifunction display. If the vehicle in
front is not shown in the multifunction display
and is no longer being detected, for example
because it has changed lanes, DISTRONIC
PLUS is deactivated and a tone sounds.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ? or press it up : or down A to the
pressure point.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
up : or down A until the desired speed
is set.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Your vehicle adapts its speed to that of the
vehicle in front, but only up to the desired
stored speed.
i If you do not fully release the accelerator
pedal, the DISTRONIC PLUS suspended
message appears in the multifunction display. The set distance to a slower-moving
vehicle in front will then not be maintained.
You will be driving at the speed you determine by the position of the accelerator
pedal.
Activating when driving towards a stationary vehicle
If the vehicle in front of you is stationary, you
can only activate DISTRONIC PLUS once your
vehicle is stationary as well.
X Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
i DISTRONIC PLUS can only be activated at
under 30 km/h if a vehicle in front has been
detected. Therefore, the DISTRONIC PLUS
distance display in the instrument cluster
should be activated.
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed
up : or down A until the desired speed
is set.
i You can use the cruise control lever to set
the stored speed and the control on the
cruise control lever to set the specified
minimum distance (Y page 159).
Pulling away
X If the vehicle in front pulls away: remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
or
X
Accelerate briefly.
Your vehicle pulls away and adapts its
speed to that of the vehicle in front.
Driving
If there is no vehicle in front, DISTRONIC
PLUS operates in the same way as cruise
control.
If a slower-moving vehicle is detected in front,
DISTRONIC PLUS causes your vehicle to
brake and maintain a preset distance to the
vehicle in front.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a faster-moving
vehicle in front, it increases the driving speed,
but only up to the desired speed you have
stored.
G Risk of accident
If you depress the brake, DISTRONIC PLUS is
deactivated unless your vehicle is stationary.
DISTRONIC PLUS then no longer brakes your
vehicle. In such cases, control the distance
from vehicles travelling in front with the brake
alone. You could otherwise cause an accident
and thereby injure yourself and others. The
driver remains fully responsible for the vehicle's distance from other vehicles, the speed
being driven and for braking in good time.
Changing lanes
If you wish to change to the passing lane (in
left-hand-drive vehicles, the passing lane is
the left-hand lane), DISTRONIC PLUS supports you if:
Ryou
are driving faster than 60 km/h
PLUS is maintaining the distance to a vehicle in front
Ryou switch on the appropriate turn signals
RDISTRONIC PLUS does not detect a danger
of collision
If these conditions are met, your vehicle is
accelerated. Acceleration will be interrupted
if changing lanes takes too long or if the distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in
front becomes too small.
RDISTRONIC
G Risk of accident
DISTRONIC PLUS and Active Blind Spot Assist
are only an aid designed to assist driving.
They do not relieve you of the responsibility
of paying attention. The driver remains fully
responsible for the vehicle's distance from
other vehicles, the vehicle's speed and for
braking in good time. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Vehicles with COMAND APS/
Audio 50 APS
i The following functions are not operational in all countries.
DISTRONIC PLUS uses additional information
from your navigation system so that it can
react appropriately to certain traffic situations. This is the case if, while following a
vehicle, DISTRONIC PLUS is active and you:
Rapproach
or drive through a roundabout
a T junction
Rturn off at a motorway exit
Even if the vehicle in front leaves the detection range, DISTRONIC PLUS temporarily
maintains the current driving speed and does
Rapproach
Z
157
Driving and parking
Driving systems
158
Driving systems
Driving and parking
not accelerate. This is based on the current
map data in the navigation system.
Roundabout (example)
The current speed is maintained:
Rapproximately
10 seconds before the
roundabout/T junction and for approximately 1.5 seconds when driving on the
roundabout
Rapproximately 12 seconds before reaching
a motorway exit and approximately 4 seconds after the motorway exit
Afterwards, the vehicle accelerates back to
the set speed you specified.
Stopping
G Risk of accident
Never get out of the vehicle when DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated.
DISTRONIC PLUS must also never be operated, activated or deactivated by a passenger
or from outside the vehicle.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
The DISTRONIC PLUS braking effect is cancelled and the vehicle can start moving if:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS is deactivated using the
cruise control lever.
Ryou accelerate.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe
electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you wish to leave the vehicle or park it,
deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS and secure the
vehicle against rolling away.
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects that the vehicle
in front is stopping, it brakes your vehicle until
it is stationary.
Once your vehicle is stationary, it remains
stationary and you do not need to depress the
brake.
i Depending on the specified minimum dis-
tance, your vehicle will come to a standstill
at a sufficient distance behind the vehicle
in front. The specified minimum distance is
set using the control on the cruise control
lever.
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Ra system fault occurs.
Rthe power supply is not sufficient.
Setting a speed
Press the cruise control lever to the pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down A for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored. DISTRONIC PLUS
is activated and adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the new speed stored.
X
Driving systems
159
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down A for a lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
Storing the current speed or calling up
the stored speed
G Risk of accident
Only call up a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and if it is suitable for the current
traffic and driving situation. You can otherwise endanger yourself or others by unintentionally triggering sudden acceleration or
braking.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. The first
time it is activated, the current speed is
stored. Otherwise, it sets the vehicle cruise
speed to the previously stored value.
X
To increase: turn control ; in direction
=.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a greater
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X To decrease: turn control ; in direction :.
DISTRONIC PLUS then maintains a shorter
distance between your vehicle and the
vehicle in front.
X
i Make sure that you maintain the mini-
mum distance to the vehicle in front as
required by law. Adjust the distance to the
vehicle in front if necessary.
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the speedometer
Setting the specified minimum distance
You can set the specified minimum distance
for DISTRONIC PLUS by varying the time span
between one and two seconds. With this function, you can set the minimum distance that
DISTRONIC PLUS keeps to the vehicle in
front, dependent on vehicle speed. You can
see this distance in the multifunction display
(Y page 160).
When DISTRONIC PLUS is activated, one or
two segments ; in the set speed range light
up.
i For design reasons, the speed displayed
in the speedometer may differ slightly from
the speed set for DISTRONIC PLUS.
Z
Driving and parking
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
160
Driving systems
Driving and parking
If DISTRONIC PLUS detects a vehicle in front,
segments ; between speed of the vehicle in
front : and stored speed = light up.
DISTRONIC PLUS displays in the multifunction display
You will see the stored speed for about five
seconds when you activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
After this time, you will see the following in
the multifunction display while DISTRONIC
PLUS is activated:
General notes
In the Assistance menu (Y page 203) of the
on-board computer, you can select the distance display and activate or deactivate the
PRE-SAFE® Brake.
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 203).
When DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you
will see the following in the multifunction display:
: DISTRONIC PLUS activated
; Own vehicle
= Specified minimum distance to the vehi-
cle in front; adjustable
? Vehicle in front, if detected
Deactivating DISTRONIC PLUS
: Symbol for activated PRE-SAFE® Brake
; Vehicle in front, if detected
= Distance indicator: current distance to
the vehicle in front
? Specified minimum distance to the vehicle in front; adjustable
A Own vehicle
Display when DISTRONIC PLUS is activated
X Select the Distance display function
using the on-board computer
(Y page 203).
There are several ways to deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards :.
or
X
Brake, unless the vehicle is stationary.
Driving systems
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow =.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected. LIM
indicator lamp ; in the cruise control lever
lights up.
When you deactivate DISTRONIC PLUS, the
DISTRONIC PLUS off message is shown in
the multifunction display for approximately
five seconds.
General notes
The following contains descriptions of certain
road and traffic conditions in which you must
be particularly attentive. In such situations,
brake if necessary. DISTRONIC PLUS is then
deactivated.
Cornering, going into and coming out of a
bend
i The last speed stored remains stored until
you switch off the engine.
i DISTRONIC PLUS is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. If you accelerate to overtake, DISTRONIC PLUS
adjusts the vehicle's speed to the last
speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
DISTRONIC PLUS is automatically deactivated if:
Ryou
apply the parking brake.
Ryou are driving slower than 25 km/h and
there is no vehicle in front, or if the vehicle
in front is no longer detected.
RESP® intervenes or if you deactivate ESP®.
Rthe transmission is in the P, R or N position.
Rthe vehicle is near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 327).
Ryou switch off the radar sensor system
(Y page 210).
Ryou pull the cruise control lever towards
you in order to pull away and the frontpassenger door or one of the rear doors is
open.
Rthe vehicle has skidded.
If DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated, you will
hear a warning tone. The DISTRONIC PLUS
off message is shown in the multifunction
display for approximately five seconds.
The ability of DISTRONIC PLUS to detect vehicles when cornering is limited. Your vehicle
may brake unexpectedly or late.
Vehicles travelling on a different line
DISTRONIC PLUS may not detect vehicles
travelling on a different line. The distance to
the vehicle in front will be too short.
Z
Driving and parking
Tips for driving with DISTRONIC PLUS
or
X
161
162
Driving systems
Other vehicles changing lane
detected vehicle turns a corner and reveals
an obstacle or stationary vehicle, DISTRONIC
PLUS will not brake for these.
Driving and parking
Crossing vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS has not detected the vehicle cutting in yet. The distance to this vehicle
will be too short.
Narrow vehicles
DISTRONIC PLUS may detect vehicles that
are crossing your lane by mistake. Activating
DISTRONIC PLUS at traffic lights with crossing traffic, for example, could cause your vehicle to pull away unintentionally.
SPEEDTRONIC
Important safety notes
DISTRONIC PLUS has not yet detected the
vehicle in front on the edge of the carriageway, because of its narrow width. The distance to the vehicle in front will be too short.
Obstructions and stationary vehicles
SPEEDTRONIC brakes automatically so that
you do not exceed the set speed. On long and
steep downhill gradients, especially if the
vehicle is laden, you must select shift range
1, 2 or 3 in good time. By doing so, you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine,
which relieves the load on the brake system
and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly. If you need additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. never cause
the brakes to rub by applying constant slight
pedal pressure. This causes the brake system
to overheat, increases the braking distance
and can lead to the brakes failing completely.
DISTRONIC PLUS does not brake for obstacles or stationary vehicles. If, for example, the
Driving systems
163
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This could
cause the drive wheels to lose their grip and
the vehicle could skid.
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
areas
Rpermanent for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. when driving with winter tyres
fitted (Y page 164)
: To store the current speed or a higher
speed
; LIM indicator lamp
G Risk of accident
= To store the current speed or call up the
Speedtronic is only an aid designed to assist
driving. You are responsible for the vehicle's
speed and for braking in good time.
? To store the current speed or a lower
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC
General notes
With the cruise control lever, you can operate
cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off: cruise control or
DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
RLIM indicator lamp on: variable SPEEDTRONIC is selected.
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
last stored speed
speed
A To switch between cruise control or DIS-
TRONIC PLUS and variable SPEEDTRONIC
B To deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC
Selecting variable SPEEDTRONIC
X Check whether LIM indicator lamp ; is on.
If it is on, variable SPEEDTRONIC is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
selected.
G Risk of accident
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the limit speed stored.
Only use variable SPEEDTRONIC if you will not
have to accelerate suddenly to a speed above
that stored as the limit speed. You could otherwise cause an accident.
You can only exceed the limit speed stored if
you deactivate variable SPEEDTRONIC:
Rusing
the cruise control lever
depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown)
Rby
Z
Driving and parking
G Risk of accident
Driving systems
164
Driving and parking
It is not possible to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC by braking.
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
up : or down ? to the pressure point.
The current speed is stored and shown in
the multifunction display.
The segments in the multifunction display
light up from the start of the scale up to the
stored speed.
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
G Risk of accident
Only select a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and whether it is suitable for the
current driving and traffic situation. Otherwise, sudden braking could endanger you or
others.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you =.
Making adjustments in 10 km/h increments
X Briefly press the cruise control lever
beyond the pressure point, up : for a
higher speed or down ? for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed
beyond the pressure point until the desired
speed is set. Press the cruise control lever
up : for a higher speed or down ? for a
lower speed.
Making adjustments in 1 km/h increments
X Briefly press the cruise control lever to the
pressure point, up : for a higher speed or
down ? for a lower speed.
or
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed to the
pressure point until the desired speed is
set. Press the cruise control lever up : for
a higher speed or down ? for a lower
speed.
Deactivating variable SPEEDTRONIC
There are several ways to deactivate variable
SPEEDTRONIC:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards B.
or
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow A.
LIM indicator lamp ; in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable SPEEDTRONIC is
deactivated.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is selected.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated automatically when you depress the accelerator
pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown),
but only if your current speed does not differ
by more than 20 km/h from the stored speed.
You will hear a warning tone if this is the case.
G Risk of accident
It is not possible to deactivate variable Speedtronic by braking.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h (e.g. for driving on winter tyres)
and the maximum speed (Y page 209).
Shortly before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multifunction display.
Permanent SPEEDTRONIC remains active,
even if variable SPEEDTRONIC is deactivated.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
HOLD function
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen manoeuvring on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
The braking effect is cancelled and the HOLD
function deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
Activation conditions
You can activate the HOLD function if:
Rthe
vehicle is stationary.
Rthe engine is running or it has been automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt
is fastened.
Rthe parking brake is not applied.
Rthe bonnet is closed.
Rthe transmission is in position D, R or N.
RDISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
Activating the HOLD function
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X
X
Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until HOLD display : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
G Risk of accident
The vehicle's brakes are applied when the
HOLD function is activated. For this reason,
deactivate the HOLD function if the vehicle is
to be set in motion by other means (e.g. in a
car wash or by towing).
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou
accelerate and the transmission is in
position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P.
Ryou apply the brakes again with a certain
amount of pressure until HOLD disappears
from the multifunction display.
Ryou activate DISTRONIC PLUS.
G Risk of accident
Never get out of the vehicle when the HOLD
function is activated.
The HOLD function must never be operated
or deactivated by a passenger or from outside
the vehicle.
The HOLD function does not replace the parking brake and must not be used for parking.
Z
165
Driving and parking
Driving systems
166
Driving systems
The braking effect of the HOLD function is
cancelled and the vehicle could roll away if:
Driving and parking
Rthe
HOLD function is deactivated by
depressing the accelerator pedal or the
brake pedal.
Rthere is a malfunction in the system or an
interruption in the power supply, e.g. battery failure.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses are tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected.
If you leave the vehicle or park it, deactivate
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
When the HOLD function is activated, the
transmission is shifted automatically to position P if:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe engine is switched off, unless it is automatically switched off by the ECO start/
stop function.
Rthe bonnet is opened.
Ra system fault occurs.
Rthe power supply is not sufficient.
RACE START
Important safety notes
i RACE START is only available in AMG vehicles.
RACE START enables optimal acceleration
from a standing start with suitable high-grip
road surface conditions.
G Risk of accident
RACE START is only available when SPORT
handling mode is activated. SPORT handling
mode will only be able to stabilise the vehicle
to a limited degree if the vehicle starts to skid
or a wheel starts to spin. The vehicle is therefore harder to control at the threshold range.
You could lose control of the vehicle and
cause an accident.
RACE START should only be used on closed
off circuits. Always adapt your driving style to
suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
Conditions for activation
RACE START can be activated when:
Rthe
doors are closed.
Rthe engine is running and it has reached an
operating temperature of approximately
80 †. This is the case when the engine oil
temperature in the multifunction display
stops flashing.
RSPORT handling mode is activated
(Y page 60)
Rthe steering wheel is in the straight-ahead
position.
Rthe vehicle is stationary and the brake
pedal is depressed (left foot).
Rthe transmission is in position D.
Activating RACE START
Depress the brake pedal with your left foot,
and keep it depressed.
X Turn the drive program selector switch
clockwise (Y page 138), until the RS lamp
lights up.
The RACE START Confirm: Paddle UP
Cancel: Paddle DOWN message appears
in the multifunction display.
i If the conditions for activation are no longer fulfilled, RACE START is cancelled. The
RACE START cancelled message appears
in the multifunction display.
X
Driving systems
To cancel: pull the left steering wheel shift
paddle (Y page 139).
AIRMATIC
or
Vehicle level
To confirm: pull the right steering wheel
shift paddle (Y page 139).
The RACE START available Depress
accelerator message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not depress the accelerator
pedal fully within two seconds, RACE
START is cancelled. The RACE START not
possible See Owner's Manual message
appears in the multifunction display.
Important safety notes
Your vehicle regulates its height automatically. All-round self-levelling ensures the best
possible suspension and constant ground
clearance, even with a laden vehicle. When
you drive fast, the vehicle is lowered automatically to improve driving safety and to
reduce fuel consumption.
The following vehicle levels are possible:
X
Depress the accelerator pedal fully.
The engine speed rises to approximately
4000 rpm.
The RACE START Release brake to
start message appears in the multifunction display.
i If you do not release the brake pedal
within seven seconds, RACE START is cancelled. The RACE START cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Take your foot off the brake, but keep the
accelerator pedal depressed.
The vehicle pulls away at maximum acceleration.
The RACE START active message appears
in the multifunction display.
RACE START is deactivated when the vehicle
reaches a speed of approximately 50 km/h.
Drive program S+ is activated. SPORT handling mode remains activated.
RACE START is deactivated immediately if
you release the accelerator pedal during
RACE START or if any of the activation conditions are no longer fulfilled. The RACE START
not possible See Owner's Manual message appears in the multifunction display.
i If RACE START is used repeatedly in a
short period of time, it is only available
again after having driven the vehicle a certain distance.
Rnormal
Rraised: the vehicle is raised by about 25 mm
when compared with the normal level.
the vehicle is lowered by about
10 mm when compared with the normal
level.
The "Normal" and "Raised" vehicle levels can
be set manually.
The "Lowered” vehicle level is set automatically:
Rlowered:
Rat
speeds above 140 km/h
you have selected "Comfort tuning"
(Y page 168) and then lock the vehicle
within 60 seconds of the engine being
switched off
Rif you have selected "Sports tuning"
(Y page 168)
Rif
G Risk of injury
If you have selected "Comfort tuning", the
vehicle will be lowered if you lock it within 60
seconds of the engine being switched off.
Make sure, therefore, that nobody is in the
vicinity of the wheel housing or under the
vehicle when you lock the vehicle. Otherwise,
limbs could become trapped.
! The vehicle is lowered by about 15 mm if:
Ryou
have selected "Comfort tuning"
switch off the engine and
Ryou lock the vehicle within approximately
60 seconds
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
X
167
Driving systems
168
Driving and parking
Make sure when parking that you position
your vehicle so that it does not make contact with the kerb as the vehicle is lowered.
Your vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Setting the vehicle level
Select the "Normal" setting for normal road
surfaces and "Raised" for driving with snow
chains or on particularly poor road surfaces.
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel housing or under the vehicle while lowering the vehicle when it is stationary. Otherwise, limbs could become trapped.
Setting the normal level
X Start the engine.
If indicator lamp ; is lit:
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to normal level.
Suspension tuning
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection, i.e. sports or comfort
Your selection remains stored even if you
remove the key from the ignition lock.
Rthe
Setting raised level
X Start the engine.
If indicator lamp ; is not lit:
X
Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. The vehicle
height is adjusted to raised level.
The Vehicle rising message appears in
the display.
The "Raised Level" setting is cancelled if you:
Rdrive
at a speed over approximately
120 km/h
Rdrive for approximately three minutes at a
speed over 80 km/h
The "Raised Level" remains saved when you
are not driving within these speed ranges.
Sports tuning
The firmer suspension tuning in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode when employing a sporty
driving style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp ; lights up. You have selected "Sports tuning".
The AIRMATIC SPORT message appears in
the multifunction display.
Comfort tuning
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
driving style, but also when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. motorways.
X Press button :.
Indicator lamp = lights up. You have selected "Comfort tuning".
The AIRMATIC COMFORT message appears
in the multifunction display.
AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension
General notes
i AMG RIDE CONTROL sports suspension
is available for the CLS 63 AMG model.
Vehicle level
The vehicle automatically sets the vehicle
level at the rear axle. Rear axle level control
ensures the best possible suspension and
that the ground clearance remains constant
even when the vehicle is loaded. This
improves driving safety and fuel consumption.
Sport mode
The firmer suspension tuning in Sport mode
ensures even better contact with the road.
Select this mode when employing a sporty
driving style, e.g. on winding country roads.
X Press button : once.
Indicator lamp ? lights up. You have selected Sport mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT message
appears in the multifunction display.
Sport + mode
The very firm setting of the suspension tuning
in Sport + mode ensures the best possible
contact with the road. Select this mode only
when driving on race circuits.
If indicator lamps = and ? are off:
X
Suspension tuning
General notes
The electronically controlled damping system
works continuously. This improves driving
safety and ride comfort.
The damping is tuned individually to each
wheel and depends on:
Ryour
driving style, e.g. sporty
road surface condition, e.g. bumps
Ryour individual selection of Sport, Sport +
or Comfort
If you select Sport or Sport + mode and
restart the engine, the suspension setting
reverts to Comfort mode.
Rthe
Press button : twice.
Indicator lamps = and ? light up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
If indicator lamp ? lights up:
X
Press button : once.
The second indicator lamp = lights up. You
have selected Sport + mode.
The AMG Ride Control SPORT + message
appears in the multifunction display.
Comfort mode
In comfort mode, the driving characteristics
of your vehicle are more comfortable. Select
this mode if you prefer a more comfortable
Z
169
Driving and parking
Driving systems
Driving systems
Driving and parking
170
driving style, but also when driving fast on
straight roads, e.g. motorways.
X Press button : repeatedly until indicator
lamps = and ? go out.
You have selected Comfort mode.
The AMG Ride Control COMFORT message appears in the multifunction display.
Storing and calling up settings
Once the suspension tuning and drive program have been selected, you can store and
call up your settings using AMG button ;.
X
To store: press AMG button ; until you
hear a tone.
X
To call up: press AMG button ;.
The stored suspension tuning and drive
program are selected.
X
To display: briefly press AMG button ;.
Your selection appears in the multifunction
display.
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the parking brake
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
PARKTRONIC monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
Rshift
: Sensors in the front bumper, left-hand
side (example)
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident
PARKTRONIC is only an aid and may not
detect all obstacles. This system does not
relieve you of the need to pay attention.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Range of the sensors
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush; otherwise they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 274).
G Risk of injury
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
Side view
Driving systems
171
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
Top view
Front sensors
Centre
approx. 100 cm
Corners
approx. 60 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
approx. 120 cm
Corners
approx. 80 cm
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and
objects which absorb ultrasonic sources.
Ultrasonic sources, such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill, could cause PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
engine is running.
Minimum distance
Centre
approx. 20 cm
Corners
approx. 15 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
Z
Driving and parking
Warning displays
Driving and parking
172
Driving systems
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately two seconds.
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately two seconds. This indicates that you have now
reached the minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated. Active Park Assist is then also
deactivated.
Driving systems
173
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
two seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately 20 seconds,
and the indicator lamp
in the PARKTRONIC
button lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 274).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
imately 20 seconds.
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. Ultrasound is used to
measure the road on both sides of the vehicle.
A suitable parking space is indicated by the
parking symbol. Active steering intervention
can assist you during parking. You may also
use PARKTRONIC (Y page 170). When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active Parking Assist
is also unavailable.
G Risk of accident
Active Parking Assist is merely an aid and may
sometimes recommend parking spaces that
are not suitable for parking. For example,
these might be spaces where parking is prohibited, driveways, unsuitable surfaces, etc.
Active Parking Assist measures the parking
space as you drive past it. Any later changes
to the parking space are not taken into
account. For instance, this may be the case
when the vehicle parked in front of or behind
the space changes its position or when an
obstacle is moved into the parking space.
Active Parking Assist does not relieve you of
the responsibility of paying attention. If you
rely solely on Active Parking Assist, you could
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring.
G Risk of accident
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
Driving and parking
174
Driving systems
procedure is calculated, e. g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles. In some circumstances, Active Parking Assist may therefore guide you into the
parking space too early. This may lead to a
collision. For this reason, you should avoid
using Active Parking Assist in such situations.
G Risk of accident
The front of the vehicle will veer out in the
direction of the oncoming traffic during the
parking operation. In some cases the vehicle
will also take you onto sections of the oncoming lane during the parking procedure.
You are responsible for safety at all times and
must pay attention to any road users
approaching or passing. Stop the vehicle if
necessary or cancel the Active Parking Assist
parking procedure.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, e.g.
not on the pavement
Parking tips:
Rthat
Ron
narrow roads, drive as closely as possible past the parking space.
Rparking spaces that are littered, overgrown
or partially occupied by trailer drawbars
might be identified incorrectly or not at all.
Rsnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
Rpay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 171) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
Ryou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active Parking
Assist will then be cancelled.
Rwhen
transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
Rnever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains or an emergency spare wheel are
fitted.
Rmake sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Rthe way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. In some cases, Active Parking
Assist may guide you too far into a parking
space, or not far enough into it. In some
cases, it may also lead you across or onto
the kerb. If necessary, you should abort the
parking procedure with Active Parking
Assist.
Ryou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should
a gear be changed too early to achieve a
sensible parking position, the parking procedure will be aborted.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at
a sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tyres.
Detecting parking spaces
Active Parking Assist is switched on automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle. When
driving at speeds below 35 km/h, you will see
the parking symbol as a status indicator in the
instrument cluster. Active Parking Assist only
displays parking spaces on the frontpassenger side as standard. Parking spaces
on the driver's side are displayed as soon as
Driving systems
Detected parking space (example)
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are at least 1.5 m wide
Rthat are at least 1.3 m longer than your
vehicle
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 15 m away from it.
Rthat
Parking
G Risk of accident
PARKTRONIC and Active Parking Assist are
merely parking aids and may not detect all
obstacles. They do not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could, otherwise, endanger
yourself and others.
Stop the vehicle when the parking space
symbol shows the desired parking space in
the instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X To park using Active Parking Assist: press
the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X
G Risk of accident
When parking, you need to make sure that no
obstacles are located in the vicinity of the
vehicle during the entire operation. Active
Parking Assist does not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention. It merely
aids you by intervening actively in the steering.
To stop the vehicle or avoid an accident you
need to apply the brakes yourself.
Let go of the multifunction steering wheel.
Back up the vehicle, being ready to brake
at all times. When reversing, do not exceed
a speed of approximately 10 km/h; otherwise, Active Parking Assist will be deactivated.
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
the best parking results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
X
X
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
The Park Assist active Select D
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
Z
Driving and parking
the turn signal on the driver's side is activated. If you wish to park in a space on the driver's side, the indicator on the driver's side
must remain on. This must remain switched
on until you acknowledge the use of Active
Parking Assist by pressing the a button
on the multifunction steering wheel.
When a parking space has been detected, an
arrow towards the right or the left also
appears.
175
Driving systems
176
Shift the transmission to position D while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist active Accelerate
and brake Observe surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best parking results
by waiting for the steering procedure to
complete before moving forwards.
Driving and parking
X
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
The Park Assist active Select R
Observe surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Further transmission changes may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist switched off message appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is now deactivated.
PARKTRONIC is still available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 171).
Cancelling Active Parking Assist
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
X Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be cancelled at
once. The Park Assist cancelled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X Press the PARKTRONIC button on the
centre console (Y page 172).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately cancelled.
The Park Assist cancelled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is cancelled automatically if:
Rthe
transmission is shifted too early.
using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible.
Ryou are driving faster than 10 km/h.
Ra wheel spins, ESP® intervenes or fails. The
ä warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking space
symbol disappears and the multifunction display shows the Park Assist cancelled
message.
When Active Parking Assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
Rparking
Reversing camera
Important safety notes
The reversing camera is an optical parking
aid. It shows the area behind your vehicle in
the COMAND APS display.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that no persons or animals are in
the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
The reversing camera is located in the handle
strip of the boot lid.
: Reversing camera
Driving systems
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear-view mirror.
G Risk of accident
The reversing camera is only an aid and may
display obstacles in a distorted or incorrect
manner, or may not even display them at all.
The reversing camera does not relieve you of
the responsibility to pay attention. The camera cannot show objects:
Rvery near to the rear bumper
Rbelow the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the boot lid
handle
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. This applies to the areas
behind, in front of and next to the vehicle. You
could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
G Risk of accident
Under the following circumstances, the
reversing camera will not function, or function
in a limited manner:
others or damage objects and your vehicle
while you are parking.
Activating the reversing camera
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Reversing camera"
function is selected in COMAND APS (see
the separate operating instructions for
COMAND APS).
X Engage reverse gear.
The area behind the vehicle is shown in the
COMAND APS display.
X
ATTENTION ASSIST
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys such as on motorways
and trunk roads. It is active in the 80 km/h
to 180 km/h range.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
Rif
G Risk of accident
Rin
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid and may
detect your tiredness or lapses in concentration too late or not at all. It is not a substitute
for a well rested and attentive driver.
Fatigue may cause you to recognise hazardous situations too late, misjudge a situation
or react slower. For this reason, make sure
you feel rested before you begin driving and
during your journey. Always take breaks in
good time and regularly, especially during
long journeys. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in time, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
the boot lid is open
heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif the area is lit by fluorescent light (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage in
winter
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
event, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
Do not use the reversing camera in these
types of situation. You could otherwise injure
Z
Driving and parking
View through the camera
177
Driving systems
Driving and parking
178
If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a button to confirm the message.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
X
Ryour
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break and ATTENTION ASSIST
still detects typical indicators of fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration, you will be
warned again after 15 minutes at the earliest.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset when you continue your journey and it starts assessing your
tiredness again if:
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rdriving conditions, e.g. time, driving time
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 80 km/h or faster than 180 km/h
Rif you are currently using COMAND APS or
making a telephone call with it
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
X
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 204).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, it will not warn
you until at least 20 minutes after your journey has begun. You then hear an intermittent
warning tone twice and the Attention
Assist: Drowsiness detected message
appears in the multifunction display.
Ryou
switch off the engine.
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break.
Ryou
Speed Limit Assist
Important safety notes
i Speed Limit Assist is not operational in all
countries.
Speed Limit Assist, in conjunction with your
navigation system, shows you speed limits it
has detected in the multifunction display. The
display appears when traffic signs indicating
a speed limit or end of a speed limit zone are
detected. If Speed Limit Assist does not
detect any traffic signs, it adopts the speed
limit in the digital map and shows it in the
display.
Speed Limit Assist detects signs with a camera at the top of the windscreen.
Driving systems
179
: Speed Limit Assist camera
G Risk of accident
Speed Limit Assist is only an aid and may
detect speed limit signs incorrectly or not at
all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from the sun or from
oncoming traffic.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rthe traffic signs are covered, for instance
by dirt, snow or trees.
Rthe traffic signs are poorly illuminated.
Rthere are ambiguous traffic signs, for
instance near roadworks or on multi-lane
roads.
Traffic signs always have priority over the
Speed Limit Assist display. Speed Limit Assist
cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It is
not a substitute for attentive driving.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
: Traffic sign indicating a speed limit or the
end of a speed limit
; Speed Limit Assist is available and the
warning function is switched on in the onboard computer
= Units used in the traffic sign displayed
Briefly showing detected traffic signs in
the multifunction display
If you have activated the Speed Limit Assist
warning function, traffic signs indicating a
speed limit or the end of a speed limit : are
shown in the multifunction display for approximately five seconds as soon as they are
detected. Any other information in the multifunction display is hidden for this period.
X Activate the Speed Limit Assist warning
function using the on-board computer
(Y page 203).
Symbol ; appears.
Permanently showing detected traffic
signs in the multifunction display
If Speed Limit Assist is selected in the onboard computer, road sign indicating the
speed limit or end of a speed limit zone :
appears in the multifunction display as soon
as it is detected.
Traffic sign indicating a speed limit : is generally displayed until:
Ra traffic sign indicating the end of the speed
limit is detected.
make a turn.
Ryou leave or enter a city or town.
Ryou
Z
Driving and parking
Information in the multifunction display
180
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Rthe
road type changes (e.g. motorway,
country road).
Ryou have travelled a certain minimum distance without the traffic sign being repeated or detected again.
X Display Speed Limit Assist using the onboard computer (Y page 203).
i You can also activate Speed Limit Assist
on COMAND APS. The maximum permissible speed is then displayed in COMAND
APS; see the COMAND APS operating
instructions.
Night View Assist Plus
Important safety notes
In addition to the illumination provided by the
normal headlamps, Night View Assist Plus
uses infrared light to illuminate the road. A
camera at the top of the windscreen picks up
the infrared light and displays a black and
white image in the COMAND APS display. The
image displayed in COMAND APS corresponds to a road lit up by main-beam headlamps. This enables you to see the road's
course and any obstacles in good time. If
pedestrian recognition is activated, pedestrians recognised by the system are highlighted in the Night View Assist Plus display.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Ron bends, on uphill gradients or downhill
gradients.
Light from the headlamps of oncoming vehicles does not affect the Night View Assist Plus
display in the multifunction display. This is
also the case if you cannot switch on the
main-beam headlamps because of oncoming
traffic.
G Risk of accident
Night View Assist Plus does not detect
objects in the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. Look through the windscreen when
manoeuvring. Make sure that there are no
people or animals in the area in which you are
manoeuvring.
i Infrared light is not visible to the human
eye and therefore does not dazzle. Night
View Assist Plus can therefore remain
switched on even if there is oncoming traffic.
G Risk of accident
Night View Assist Plus is only an aid designed
to assist driving and does not relieve you of
the responsibility to pay attention. Continue
to look through the windscreen instead of
relying on the Night View Assist Plus display.
You are responsible for safety and must drive
in accordance with traffic conditions. You
could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
: Night View Assist Plus camera
Driving systems
have the full visual range while stationary
and cannot check whether Night View
Assist Plus is working.
Pedestrian recognition
Night View Assist Plus recognises pedestrians using typical characteristics, e.g. a silhouette in the shape of a person.
Pedestrian recognition is then switched on
automatically if:
RNight
You can only activate Night View Assist Plus
if:
Rthe
key is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
is dark.
Rthe light switch is in the c or L position.
Rreverse gear has not been engaged.
X Make sure COMAND APS is switched on.
X Press button :.
The Night View Assist Plus display appears
in the COMAND APS display.
Rit
View Assist Plus is activated.
Ryou are driving faster than about 10
km/h.
surroundings are dark, e.g. when driving outside built-up areas without street
lighting.
If pedestrian recognition is active, symbol ? appears. If a pedestrian is now recognised, they are framed = and thereby highlighted. If the pedestrian recognition system
has brought a pedestrian to your attention,
look through the windscreen to evaluate the
situation. The actual distance to objects and
pedestrians cannot be gauged accurately by
looking at a screen.
It may be the case that objects are highlighted
as well as pedestrians.
Rthe
G Risk of accident
Pedestrian recognition may be impaired or
inoperative, if:
Rpedestrians
: Night View Assist Plus display
; Pedestrian recognised
= Framing
? Symbol for active pedestrian recognition
You can read about how to adjust the brightness of the COMAND APS display in the
COMAND APS operating instructions.
i The infrared headlamps only switch on
are partially or completely
obscured by objects, e.g. by parked vehicles.
Rthe silhouette in the Night View Assist Plus
display is incomplete or interrupted, e.g. by
powerful light reflections.
Rpedestrians do not contrast with the surroundings.
Rpedestrians are not in an upright position,
e.g. sitting, squatting or lying.
i Animals are not recognised by pedestrian
recognition.
when the vehicle is driving at speeds of at
least 10 km/h. This means that you do not
Z
Driving and parking
Activating Night View Assist Plus
181
182
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Misted up or dirty windscreen
If the windscreen in front of the camera is
misted up or dirty on the inside or outside, the
Night View Assist Plus display is affected.
X To demist: check the automatic air conditioning settings (Y page 117) and fold down
the camera cover (Y page 274).
X To demist the inside of the windscreen: fold down the camera cover
(Y page 274) and clean the windscreen
(Y page 273).
Driving systems
183
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The picture quality of
Night View Assist Plus
has deteriorated.
The windscreen wipers are smearing the windscreen.
X Replace the wiper blades (Y page 107).
The windscreen is smeared after cleaning the vehicle in a car wash.
X Clean the windscreen (Y page 273).
Windscreen chip damage in the camera's field of vision.
X Replace the windscreen.
The windscreen is misted up on the inside.
X Demist the windscreen (Y page 117).
The windscreen is iced up.
X De-ice the windscreen (Y page 116).
There is dirt on the inside of the windscreen.
X Clean the inside of the windscreen (Y page 273).
Lane Tracking package
General notes
The Lane Tracking package consists of Blind
Spot Assist (Y page 183) and Lane Keeping
Assist (Y page 185).
Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. Blind Spot Assist provides assistance
at speeds higher than 30 km/h. A warning
lamp in the exterior mirrors draws your attention to detected vehicles in the monitored
area. If you then switch on the corresponding
turn signal to change lane, you will also
receive an optical and acoustic collision warning. For this purpose, Blind Spot Assist uses
sensors in the rear bumper.
G Risk of accident
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid designed to
assist driving. It may fail to detect some vehicles and is no substitute for attentive driving.
Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road and traffic conditions. It may fail to detect narrow
vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles, or
only detect them too late.
Monitoring may be affected by dirty sensors,
strong spray or poor visibility caused by snow,
rain or mist, for example. In this case, vehicles
are detected late or not at all.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 327).
For Blind Spot Assist to assist you when driving, the radar sensor system must be
switched on (Y page 210) and operational.
Z
Driving and parking
Problems with Night View Assist Plus
184
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Monitoring range of the sensors
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to
three metres behind your vehicle and directly
next to your vehicle as shown in the diagram.
G Risk of accident
Blind Spot Assist monitors certain areas in the
immediate vicinity of your vehicle. Vehicles
that approach and drive past at high speeds
are not detected. There is no display and no
warning.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation in
different lanes. This may be the case if vehicles are driving at the edge of their lane that
is furthest away from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
If the lanes are narrow, the system may be
unable to distinguish the neighbouring lane
from the one beyond it. For this reason, vehicles in the farther lane may be indicated,
especially if the vehicles are driving in a staggered formation in different lanes. In particular, this may be the case if the vehicles are
driving at the edge of their lane nearest your
vehicle.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles for a
prolonged time.
The two sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the sides of the rear bumper.
Make sure that the bumper is free from dirt,
ice or slush around the sensors. For example,
the radar sensors must not be covered by
cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a
severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise not
work properly.
Indicator and warning display
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
If Blind Spot Assist is switched on, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow up to a speed of 30 km/h. At speeds
above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp goes out
and Blind Spot Assist is operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up in red. This warning is
always emitted when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
Driving systems
warns you before you leave your lane unintentionally.
G Risk of accident
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
30 km/h, and the indicator lamps in the exterior mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the turn
signal, a double warning tone sounds. Red
warning lamp : flashes. If the turn signal
remains on, detected vehicles are indicated
by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There
are no further warning tones.
Switching on Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 210) and Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 204) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : light up red in the exterior mirrors for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Lane Keeping Assist
Important safety notes
Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of a camera at
the top of the windscreen. Lane Keeping
Assist detects lane markings on the road and
: Lane Keeping Assist camera
If you select km on the on-board computer in
the Display unit Speed-/odometer:
function (Y page 205), Lane Keeping Assist
is activated starting at a speed of 60 km/h.
If the miles display unit is selected, the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
G Risk of accident
Lane Keeping Assist does not keep your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and may detect
the lane markings on the road incorrectly or
not at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Z
Driving and parking
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. In this event, Blind Spot
Assist is no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
185
186
Driving systems
Driving and parking
Rthe
lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect road and
traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
A warning can be given when a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you
by means of intermittent vibration in the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
No warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou switch on the turn signals. In this event,
the warnings are suppressed for a certain
period of time.
Activating Lane Keeping Assist
X
Activate Lane Keeping Assist using the onboard computer (Y page 205).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is
displayed in green. Lane Keeping Assist is
ready for use.
Active Driving Assistance package
General notes
The Active Driving Assistance package consists of DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 154), Active
Blind Spot Assist (Y page 186) and Active
Lane Keeping Assist (Y page 189).
Active Blind Spot Assist
Important safety notes
Active Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor
system to monitor the side areas of your vehicle. In addition, it uses the radar sensor system to monitor the front area as well. Active
Blind Spot Assist provides assistance at
speeds higher than about 30 km/h. A warning lamp in the exterior mirror calls your
attention to a vehicle or certain obstacles
detected in the area monitored. If you then
switch on the corresponding turn signal to
change lane, you will also receive an optical
and acoustic collision warning. If a risk of lateral collision is detected, corrective braking
may help you avoid a collision.
Driving systems
187
G Risk of accident
is poor visibility, e.g. due to snow,
rain, fog or spray.
Rthe rear and/or front sensors are dirty.
Active Blind Spot Assist may not detect narrow vehicles, such as motorcycles or bicycles,
or only detect them too late. It cannot detect
vehicles which are overtaken at a small distance and then enter the blind spot area.
Active Blind Spot Assist cannot detect road
and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for
attentive driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed, braking in good time, and
steering correctly. Always adapt your driving
style to suit the prevailing road and weather
conditions. Always pay attention to traffic
conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise,
you may fail to recognise dangers in time,
cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
Driving and parking
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid and may
detect vehicles/obstacles incorrectly or not
at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rthere
The radar sensor system is automatically
deactivated near radio telescope facilities
(Y page 327).
For Active Blind Spot Assist to assist you
when driving, the radar sensor system must
be activated (Y page 210) and operational.
Monitoring range
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up
to three metres behind your vehicle and
directly next to your vehicle as shown in the
diagram. For this purpose, Active Blind Spot
Assist uses sensors in the rear bumper.
G Risk of accident
Active Blind Spot Assist monitors certain
areas in the immediate vicinity of your vehicle.
Vehicles that approach and drive past at high
speeds are not detected. No visual nor audible warnings are emitted and the system does
not brake the vehicle to correct your course.
If the lanes are very wide, it may not be possible to monitor the complete width of the
neighbouring lane. For this reason, vehicles in
the next lane may not be detected, especially
if they are driving in a staggered formation.
This may be the case if vehicles are driving at
the edge of their lane that is furthest away
from your vehicle.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
If the lanes are narrow, the system may be
unable to distinguish the neighbouring lane
from the one beyond it. For this reason, vehicles in the farther lane may be indicated,
especially if the vehicles are driving in a staggered formation in different lanes. In particular, this may be the case if the vehicles are
driving at the edge of their lane nearest your
vehicle. Due to the nature of the system,
warnings may be issued in error when driving
Z
Driving and parking
188
Driving systems
close to crash barriers or similar solid lane
borders.
Two Active Blind Spot Assist sensors are integrated into the front and rear bumpers
respectively. An additional sensor is located
behind the cover in the radiator grille. Make
sure that the bumpers are free from dirt, ice
or slush around the sensors. The rear radar
sensors must not be covered, for example by
cycle racks or overhanging loads. Following a
severe impact or in the event of damage to
the bumpers, have the function of the radar
sensors checked at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Active Blind Spot Assist may otherwise fail to work correctly.
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. Active Blind Spot Assist is
then no longer active.
The brightness of the indicator/warning
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Indicator and warning display
Optical and acoustic collision warning
When you switch on the appropriate turn signals to change lanes, and a vehicle is detected in the side monitoring range of Active
Blind Spot Assist, you receive an optical and
acoustic collision warning. You then hear a
double warning tone, and red warning
lamp : flashes. If the turn signal remains on,
detected vehicles are indicated by the flashing of red warning lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
: Yellow indicator lamp/red warning lamp
Course-correcting brake application
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of
lateral collision in the monitoring range,
under certain circumstances, it will brake the
vehicle briefly on one side. This is designed to
help you avoid a collision.
This function is available in the range between
30 km/h and 200 km/h.
When a course-correcting brake application
occurs, red warning lamp : flashes in the
exterior mirror and the following is shown in
the multifunction display, for example:
When Active Blind Spot Assist is activated,
indicator lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights
up in yellow at speeds of up to 30 km/h. At
speeds above 30 km/h, the indicator lamp
goes out and Active Blind Spot Assist is
operational.
If a vehicle is detected within the monitoring
range of Blind Spot Assist at speeds above
30 km/h, warning lamp : on the corresponding side lights up red. This warning is
always emitted when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs if the difference in
speed is less than 12 km/h.
G Risk of accident
Active Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds
below 30 km/h. The indicator lamps in the
exterior mirrors are yellow. Vehicles in the
monitoring range are then not indicated.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Driving systems
189
RESP®
is deactivated.
loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed.
G Risk of accident
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Automatic braking by the
system may not always be sufficient to avoid
a collision. In such cases, you need to steer,
brake or accelerate yourself.
In very rare cases, the system may detect a
risk of collision where there is none and brake
in error near crash barriers or similar road
boundaries. Active Blind Spot Assist cannot
detect all traffic situations and road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lateral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. You can, for example,
countersteer gently or depress the accelerator pedal at any time to cancel inappropriate
braking action.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
Activating Active Blind Spot Assist
X Make sure that the radar sensor system
(Y page 210) and Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 204) are activated in the on-board
computer.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
Warning lamps : light up red in the exterior mirrors for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Important safety notes
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area
in front of your vehicle by means of a camera
at the top of the windscreen. Active Lane
Keeping Assist detects lane markings on the
road and warns you before you leave your
lane unintentionally. If you do not react to the
warning, a lane-correcting application of the
brakes can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
Either a very slight course-correcting brake
application, or none at all, may occur if:
Rthere
are vehicles and/or obstacles, e.g.
crash barriers, in the immediate vicinity of
your vehicle.
Ra vehicle approaches you too closely at the
side.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds.
Ryou brake or accelerate decisively.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP® or PRE-SAFE® Brake.
: Active Lane Keeping Assist camera
If you select km on the on-board computer in
the Display unit Speed-/odometer:
(Y page 205) function, Active Lane Keeping
Assist is activated starting at a speed of
60 km/h. If the miles display unit is selected,
the assistance range begins at 40 mph.
Z
Driving and parking
Ra
190
Driving systems
Driving and parking
G Risk of accident
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid and
may detect the lane markings on the road
incorrectly or not at all.
The system may be impaired or may not function if:
Rseveral or no lane markings for a single lane
are present.
is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient illumination of the road, or due to
snow, rain, fog or spray.
Rthere is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
the sun, or reflection from other vehicles.
Rthe windscreen is dirty, misted up or covered, for instance by a sticker, in the vicinity
of the camera.
Rthe lane markings are worn away, dark or
covered up, e.g. by dirt or snow.
Rthe distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
Rthe lane markings on the road are unclear,
e.g. near roadworks.
Rthe lane markings change quickly, e.g.
lanes branch off, cross one another or
merge.
Rthe road is narrow and winding.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect
road and traffic conditions. It is not a substitute for attentive driving. You are responsible
for the vehicle's speed, braking in good time,
and steering correctly. Always adapt your
driving style to suit the prevailing road and
weather conditions. Always pay attention to
traffic conditions and your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to recognise dangers in
time, cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
Rthere
Warning vibration in the steering wheel
A warning can be given when a front wheel
passes over a lane marking. It will warn you
by means of intermittent vibration in the
steering wheel for up to 1.5 seconds.
In order that you are warned only when necessary and in good time if you cross the lane
marking, the system recognises certain conditions and warns you accordingly.
The warning vibration occurs earlier if:
Ryou
approach the outer lane marking on a
bend.
Rthe road has very wide lanes, e.g. a motorway.
Rthe system recognises solid lane markings.
The warning vibration occurs later if:
Rthe
road has narrow lanes.
cut the corner on a bend.
No warning vibration occurs if:
Ryou
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP®.
Ryou switch on the turn signals. In this event,
the warnings are suppressed for a certain
period of time.
Lane-correcting brake application
If you leave your lane under certain circumstances, the vehicle will brake briefly on one
side. This is designed to help you bring the
vehicle back into the original lane.
This function is available in the range between
60 km/h and 200 km/h.
A lane-correcting brake application can only
be made after driving over a solid, recognisable lane marking. Before this, a warning
must be emitted by means of intermittent
vibration in the steering wheel. In addition, a
lane with lane markings on both sides must
be recognised. The brake application also
slightly reduces driving speed.
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs,
the following message appears in the multifunction display:
Driving systems
Ryou
191
switch on the turn signals.
i A further lane-correcting brake applica-
tion can only occur after your vehicle has
returned to the original lane.
G Risk of accident
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not keep
your vehicle in its lane. It is only an aid
designed to assist driving. It is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Corrective braking may
not always be sufficient to return your vehicle
to its original lane. In such cases, you must
steer the vehicle yourself to ensure that it
does not leave the lane.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot detect the
current traffic situation or other road users.
Ensure at all times that there is sufficient lateral distance between you and other road
users or obstacles. In rare cases, broken lines
or certain structures on the road surface may
be detected by the system as solid lane markings. You can, for example, countersteer gently at any time to cancel inappropriate braking
action, e.g. if you intentionally drive across a
solid lane marking.
Active Lane Keeping Assist cannot take
weather conditions into account.
You are responsible for the vehicle's speed,
correct steering and for braking in good time.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
prevailing road and weather conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions and
your surroundings. Otherwise, you may fail to
recognise dangers in time, cause an accident
and injure yourself and others.
No lane-correcting brake application occurs
if:
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Ryou have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration.
RESP® is deactivated.
Rthe transmission is not in position D.
Ra loss of tyre pressure or a defective tyre
has been detected and displayed.
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
road and traffic conditions. An inappropriate
brake application may be interrupted at any
time if you:
Rsteer
slightly in the opposite direction
a turn signal
Rclearly brake or accelerate
A lane-correcting brake application is interrupted automatically if:
Ruse
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP®, PRE-SAFE® Brake or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
Rlane markings can no longer be recognised.
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
X
Activate Active Lane Keeping Assist using
the on-board computer (Y page 205).
Symbol : appears in the multifunction
display.
If you drive at speeds above 60 km/h and
lane markings are detected, symbol : is displayed in green. Active Lane Keeping Assist
is ready for use.
Ryou
clearly and actively steer, brake, or
accelerate.
Ryou cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Z
Driving and parking
Ra driving safety system intervenes, such as
192
Vehicle equipment ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Displays and operation ....................
Menus and submenus ......................
Display messages .............................
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................
194
194
194
197
215
238
On-board computer and displays
193
On-board computer and displays
194
Displays and operation
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Important safety notes
You will find an illustration of the instrument
cluster in the "At a glance" section
(Y page 26).
G Risk of accident
Only use the on-board computer when road
and traffic conditions permit. You would otherwise be distracted and unable to concentrate properly on driving, and could cause an
accident.
G Risk of accident
If the instrument cluster or multifunction display fails, no messages can be displayed.
This means that you will not see information
about the driving situation, such as the speed,
outside temperature, warning/indicator
lamps, display messages or system failures.
Handling characteristics may be affected.
Adapt your driving style and speed accordingly.
Immediately consult a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for
this purpose. In particular, work relevant to
safety or on safety-related systems must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
The on-board computer only records and displays malfunctions and warnings from certain
systems. For this reason, you should always
make sure that your vehicle is safe to use. You
could otherwise cause an accident by driving
an unsafe vehicle.
G Risk of accident and injury
The operating safety of your vehicle could be
jeopardised if maintenance work is carried
out incorrectly. As a result, you could lose
control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
In addition, the safety systems may no longer
be able to protect you or others as they are
designed to do.
Always have maintenance work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop. The qualified
specialist workshop must have the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Displays and operation
Coolant temperature gauge
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †.
The coolant temperature may rise to the top
end of the scale at high outside temperatures
and on long uphill stretches.
Rev counter
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
The fuel supply is interrupted to protect the
engine when the red band is reached.
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
Outside temperature display
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 196).
G Risk of accident
At temperatures just above freezing point, the
street may be icy, especially in wooded areas
or on bridges. If you do not adapt your driving
style to the conditions, the vehicle could skid.
For this reason, adapt your driving style and
speed to the weather conditions.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Speedometer with segments
The segments in the speedometer indicate
which speed range is available.
Cruise control (Y page 152) activated:
The segments light up from the stored speed
to the maximum speed.
Variable SPEEDTRONIC (Y page 162) activated:
The segments light up from the start of the
scale to the selected limit speed.
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 154) activated:
One or two segments in the set speed range
light up.
:
Multifunction display
;
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits phone book/redial memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume or operates the
RACETIMER in AMG vehicles
8
Mute
=
?
Switches on LINGUATRONIC; see the
separate operating instructions
?
% Press briefly:
Back
Switches off LINGUATRONIC
Hides display messages or calls up
the last Trip menu function used
Operating the on-board computer
The on-board computer is activated as soon
as you turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
% Press and hold:
Calls up the standard display in the
Trip menu
A
195
=;
Calls up the menu and menu bar
Z
On-board computer and displays
196
Displays and operation
9: Press briefly:
Selects the submenu or scrolls
through lists
In the Audio menu: selects a stored
station, an audio track or a video
scene
In the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone number
9: Press and hold:
In the Audio menu: selects the previous/next station or selects an
audio track or a video scene using
rapid scrolling
In the Tel (telephone) menu: starts
rapid scrolling through the phone
book
a
Confirms selections and messages
In the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
starts dialling
In the Audio menu: stops the station
search function at the desired station
Multifunction display
Values and settings as well as display messages are shown in the multifunction display.
: Description field
; Menu bar
= Drive program
? Transmission position
A Outside temperature or speed
(Y page 206)
X
To show menu bar ;: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Further information on displaying the transmission position (Y page 136).
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
197
Menu overview
The number of menus shown depends on the optional equipment in the vehicle.
Function
:
Trip menu (Y page 198)
;
Navi menu (navigation instructions) (Y page 199)
=
Audio menu (Y page 200)
?
Tel menu (telephone) (Y page 201)
A
Assist. menu (assistance) (Y page 203)
B
Service menu (Y page 205)
Rcalls up display messages (Y page 215)
Rtyre pressure loss warning (Y page 306) or check the tyre pressure electronically (Y page 307)
RASSYST PLUS service interval display (Y page 270)
C
Settings menu (Y page 205)
D
AMG menu in AMG vehicles (Y page 212)
Z
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
198
Trip menu
Standard display
X
Press and hold the % button on the
steering wheel until the Trip menu with
total distance recorder : and trip
meter ; is shown.
Trip computer "From start" or "From
reset"
The values in the After start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey, whilst
the values in the From reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 199).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select From start
or From reset.
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than four hours.
hours have been exceeded.
R9999 kilometres have been exceeded.
The From reset trip computer is automatically reset if the trip exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
R999
Displaying the range and current fuel
consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
current fuel consumption27 and approximate range.
X
The approximate range which can be covered
depends on the fuel level and your current
driving style. If there is only a small amount
of fuel left in the fuel tank, the display shows
a vehicle being refuelled C instead of the
range.
Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Trip computer "From start" (example)
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average fuel consumption
The From start trip computer is reset automatically when
: Digital speedometer
27 Not
AMG vehicles.
Menus and submenus
Route guidance inactive
On-board computer and displays
Resetting values
You can reset the values of the following functions:
meter
computer "From start"
Rtrip computer "From reset"
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the function
that you wish to reset.
X Press a.
Rtrip
Rtrip
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
Resetting the trip computer "From start" (example)
X
Press : to select Yes and press a
to confirm.
: Distance to the destination
; Distance to the next change of direction
= Current road
Navigation menu
Displaying navigation instructions
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. For more
information, see the separate operating
instructions.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
APS (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
199
? Symbol for "follow the road's course"
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Current road
? Symbol for change of direction
When a change of direction has been
announced, you will see visual distance display ; next to the symbol for change of
Z
On-board computer and displays
200
Menus and submenus
direction =. This decreases in size as you
approach the announced change of direction.
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
ROff
map or Off road: the vehicle position
is outside the area of the digital map (offmap position).
RNo route: no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
: Road to which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
You can only change the waveband and store
new stations using the audio system or
COMAND APS.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
APS and select Radio (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
= Lane recommendation
? Symbol for change of direction
On multi-lane roads, lane recommendation
= may be shown for the next change of
direction. Lanes may be added during a
change of direction.
: Waveband28
; Station
To select a stored channel: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X To select a station using the station
search29: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
Lane recommendation display (example)
: Uninterrupted lane
; New lane during a change of direction
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO:
you have reached the destination.
RNew route... or Calculating route: a
new route is being calculated.
28 When
29 Only
i DAB radio mode (Digital Audio Broadcasting); see separate operating instructions.
station ; has been stored, the memory position will also be displayed.
if no station list is received.
Operating audio devices or media
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
X Switch on the audio system or COMAND
APS and select the audio device or medium
(see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
: Current channel
To select a stored channel: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
X
Operating the video DVD
Switch on COMAND APS and select video
DVD (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X
CD player display (example)
: Current track
To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until the desired track
has been reached.
X
If you press and hold 9 or :, the rapid
scrolling speed is increased. Not all audio
devices or media support this function.
If track information is stored on the audio
device or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and name of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Operating the TV
Switch on COMAND APS and select TV (see
the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X
: Current scene
To select the next or previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or the : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
9 or : button until the desired
scene has been reached.
X
Telephone menu
Introduction
Functions and displays are dependent on the
optional equipment installed in your vehicle.
You can place your mobile phone in the
mobile phone bracket (Y page 259), or set
up a Bluetooth® connection to the audio sysZ
201
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
202
tem or COMAND APS (see the separate operating instructions).
G Risk of accident
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
the use of mobile phones in the vehicle.
If it is permitted to use mobile phones while
the vehicle is in motion, you should only use
them when the road and traffic conditions
allow. Otherwise, you may be distracted from
the traffic conditions, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
Switch on the mobile phone and audio system or COMAND APS (see the separate
operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease enter PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
X Enter the PIN using the mobile phone, LINGUATRONIC, the audio system or
COMAND APS.
The mobile phone will search for a network.
In the meantime, the Telephone No
Service message appears in the multifunction display.
RTelephone
ready or the name of the network provider: the mobile phone has found
a network and is ready to receive.
RPhone No Service: no network is available.
Accepting a call
If someone calls you when you are in the
Telmenu, a display message appears in the
multifunction display, for example:
X
Press 6 on the steering wheel to accept
an incoming call.
If you are not in the Tel menu, you can still
accept a call.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
If you are not in the Tel menu, you can still
reject or end a call.
Dialling a number from the phone book
If your mobile phone is able to receive calls,
you can search for and dial a number from the
phone book in the audio system or COMAND
APS at any time.
X Copy the telephone book of the mobile
phone into the audio system or to COMAND
APS (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to call
up the phone book.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
To start scrolling rapidly, press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one
second. After a short time, the rapid scroll
speeds up.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X
If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialling.
or
If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ button.
X
Redialling
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialled in the redial memory.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialling.
Assistance menu
Speed Limit Assist
Displaying Speed Limit Assist
In the Speed Lim. Asst. function, a detected speed limit is displayed under certain
conditions.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Speed Lim.
Asst.
X Press a.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
When a limit speed is detected, this is
shown in the multifunction display until:
Rthe
speed limit ceases to apply.
pass city limits.
Rthe type of road changes, e.g. motorway
or country road.
Rthe speed limit is no longer detected
after a certain distance.
Ryou
Activating/deactivating the Speed Limit
Assist message function
You can set Speed Limit Assist (Y page 178)
to display a detected speed limit automatically for five seconds. Other messages in the
multifunction display will be faded out for this
length of time.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Speed Lim.
Asst.
X Press a.
The multifunction display shows Speed
Limit Assist.
X Press :.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate or deactivate: press a.
When Speed Limit Assist is operational and
the message function is activated, the multifunction display shows the Ä symbol
when the ignition is switched on.
Showing the distance display
This function is only available with DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Distance display.
X Press a.
The DISTRONIC PLUS distance display
(Y page 160) appears in the multifunction
display.
Z
203
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
204
Deactivating/activating ESP®
G Risk of accident
If the ÷ warning lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes, proceed as follows:
RUnder no circumstances should you deactivate ESP®.
RWhen pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as is necessary.
RAdapt your driving style to the prevailing
road and weather conditions.
The vehicle may otherwise begin to skid.
If you drive too fast, ESP® cannot reduce the
risk of an accident. ESP® cannot override the
laws of physics.
For further information about
ESP®(Y page 58).
This function is not available in AMG vehicles.
Activating/deactivating ESP® in AMG vehicles (Y page 60).
X Start the engine.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select ESP.
X Press the a button.
X To deactivate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster comes on.
G Risk of accident
If the å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the engine is running,
ESP® is deactivated or is unavailable due to a
malfunction. The risk that your vehicle may
start to skid then increases in certain situations.
Always adapt your driving style to the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
To activate: press a again.
The å warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
Activating/deactivating the PRE-SAFE®
Brake
This function is only available with DISTRONIC PLUS.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select PreSafe
Brake.
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
When PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 61) is activated, the multifunction display shows the
Ä symbol as long as the HOLD function is
not activated (Y page 165).
Activating/deactivating Attention
Assist
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
Attention Asst. function.
X Press a.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
X
When ATTENTION ASSIST (Y page 177) is
activated, the À symbol appears in the
multifunction display when the ignition is on.
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
You can use the Blind Spot Asst. function
to activate or deactivate Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 183) or Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 186).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Blind Spot
Asst..
Press a.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
X
Setup menu
Introduction
Activating/deactivating Lane Keeping
Assist
You can use the Lane Keep. Asst. function
to activate/deactivate Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 185) or Active Lane Keeping Assist
(Y page 189).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Assist. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Lane Keep.
Asst..
X Press a.
If the function is activated, the road markings are shown in red in the multifunction
display.
X To activate/deactivate: press a
again.
When Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane
keeping Assist is activated, the multifunction
display shows the à symbol when the ignition is switched on.
Service menu
In the Settings menu, you have the following
options:
Rchanging the instrument cluster settings
Rchanging the time/date settings30
Rchanging the light settings
Rchanging the vehicle settings
Rchanging the auxiliary heating settings
Rchanging the convenience settings
Rrestoring the factory settings
Instrument cluster
Selecting the unit of measurement for distance
The Display unit Speed-/odometer function allows you to choose whether certain
displays appear in kilometres or miles.
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
total distance recorder and the trip
meter
Rthe trip computer
Rthe current consumption and the range
Rthe navigation instruction in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RSPEEDTRONIC
RDISTRONIC PLUS
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rthe
Rthe
In the Service menu you can:
Rcall up display messages (Y page 215)
Rreset the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 306) or check the tyre pressure
electronically (Y page 307)
Rcall up the service due date (Y page 270)
30 This
function is not available on vehicles with Audio 50 APS, Audio 55 APS or COMAND APS.
Z
205
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
206
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display unit Speed-/odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Selecting the permanent display function
i Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this
function is not available.
The Permanent display function allows you
to choose whether the status area in the multifunction display always shows the outside
temperature or the speed in mph.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Perma‐
nent display function.
You will see the selected setting Outside
temperature or Dig. speedom [mph].
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Time/date
This submenu is only available on vehicles
with Audio 20.
In the Time/date submenu, you can set the
time and date.
The set time is also used for the analogue
clock in the centre console.
Your vehicle could have the following audio
equipment:
A: Audio 20
B: Audio 50 APS
C: COMAND APS
X
Refer to the separate operating instructions to find out which audio system is fitted in your vehicle.
Depending on the audio system, the time and
date are received from GPS satellites and
cannot be set using the on-board computer
(see the following table).
A B C
Setting using the on-board com- X
puter
Automatic GPS satellite reception
X X
Setting the time zone once; see
the separate operating instructions
X X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Time/Date submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Time: or Date:.
The current time or date set is displayed.
X Press a to change the setting.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display you want to change: hour, minute,
day, month, year.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
X
Lights
Setting brightness for display/switches
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Brightness Display/switches: function.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Level 1 to
Level 5 (bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Switching the daytime driving lights on/
off
If you have activated the Day lights function and the light switch is set to c, the
daytime driving lights are automatically
switched on during daylight hours when the
engine is running. When it is dark, the side
lamps and the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on automatically.
The factory setting is on.
X Switch off the engine.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Day lights function.
If the Day lights have been switched on,
the cone of light and the W symbol in
the multifunction display are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the Intelligent
Light System
If you activate the Intell. Light Sys.
function, you activate the following functions:
Rmotorway mode
Ractive light function
Rcornering light function
Rextended range foglamps
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Intell.
Light Sys. function.
If the Intell. Light Sys. function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
L symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left (Y page 207), the
multifunction display shows the System
inoperative display message under the
image of the vehicle for the Intell. Light
Sys. function in the Light submenu.
Setting the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left
This function is only available on vehicles with
the Intelligent Light System.
You can use this function to switch between
symmetrical beam and asymmetrical dipped
beam (Y page 98).
If you set the dipped-beam headlamps for
driving on the right/left, then motorway
mode and the extended range foglamps are
not available.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Dipped
headl. Setting for: function.
You will see the selected setting: Rightside traffic or Left-side traffic.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
When you change the setting, conversion
does not take place until the next time the
vehicle is stationary.
Z
207
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
208
Menus and submenus
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist on/
off
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Adapt.
main beam function.
If the Adapt. main beam function has
been switched on, the cone of light and the
_ symbol in the multifunction display
are shown in red.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light +/- function.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to any level from Off to Level
5 (bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Setting the ambient lighting colour
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. light col. function.
X Press the a button to confirm.
31 Only
32 Only
for vehicles without Intelligent Light System.
vehicles with Intelligent Light System.
Press the : or 9 button to set the
colour to SOLAR, NEUTRAL or POLAR.
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the surround
lighting and exterior lighting delayed
switch-off
The Surround lighting: function allows
you to set whether the exterior lighting should
come on when it is dark
Rfor 40 seconds after unlocking the vehicle
with the key
The exterior lighting switches off when you
open the driver’s door.
Rfor 15 seconds after switching off the
engine and closing the doors
If the engine is switched off and then none
of the doors are opened, or if an open door
is not closed, the exterior lighting goes out
after 60 seconds.
If you activate the Surround light‐
ing:function, the following light up:
Rthe side lamps
Rthe dipped-beam headlamps31
Rthe daytime driving lamps32
Rthe licence plate lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Surround lightingfunction.
When the Surround lighting function is
activated, the light cone and the area
around the vehicle are displayed in red in
the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Deactivating the delayed switch-off temporarily:
Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock and back to position 0.
The delayed switch-off is deactivated.
X
Delayed switch-off is reactivated the next
time you start the engine.
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If the Light. delay function is activated and
you remove the key from the ignition lock, the
interior lighting remains on for 20 seconds.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light. delay function.
When the Light. delay function is activated, the vehicle interior is displayed in
red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Vehicle
Setting permanent SPEEDTRONIC
You can set permanent SPEEDTRONIC
(Y page 164) using the Limit speed (win‐
ter tyres): function.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Limit
speed (winter tyres): function.
You will see the current setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to adjust permanent
SPEEDTRONIC in increments of 10
(240 km/h to 160 km/h). The Off setting
switches permanent SPEEDTRONIC off.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
If you select the Automatic door lock function, the vehicle is centrally locked above a
speed of around 15 km/h.
i For further information on the automatic
locking feature, see (Y page 74).
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic door lockfunction.
When the Automatic door locks function is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking confirmation
If you activate the Acoustic Lock function,
an acoustic signal sounds when you lock or
unlock the vehicle. When unlocking, the signal sounds once. When locking, it sounds
three times.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press : or 9 to select the Acous‐
tic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol is displayed in red in the
multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Z
209
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
210
Menus and submenus
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
i You must deactivate the radar sensor system in certain countries and near radio
telescope facilities. Further information
(Y page 327).
Vehicles with a navigation system: the radar
sensor system is deactivated automatically if
you are close to radio telescope facilities.
The following systems are switched off when
the radar sensor system is deactivated:
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 154)
RBAS PLUS (Y page 57)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 61)
RBlind Spot Assist (Y page 183)
RActive Blind Spot Assist (Y page 186)
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar sensor (See Owner's Man.):.
You will see the selected setting: on or
off.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Heating menu
Auxiliary heating departure time
This function is only available on vehicles with
auxiliary heating (Y page 119).
In the Heating submenu, you can select a
stored departure time or change a departure
time.
The auxiliary heating timer function calculates the switch-on time according to the outside temperature so that the vehicle is preheated by the departure time. When the
departure time is reached, the auxiliary heating continues to heat for a further five
minutes and then switches off. The auxiliary
heating adopts the THERMATIC or THERMATRONIC temperature setting.
You can switch off the auxiliary heating by
using the remote control or the auxiliary heating button on the centre console.
G Risk of poisoning
Exhaust fumes are produced when the auxiliary heating is in operation. Inhaling these
exhaust fumes can be poisonous. You should
therefore switch off the auxiliary heating in
confined spaces without an extraction system, e.g. a garage.
G Risk of fire
When operating the auxiliary heating parts of
the vehicle can get very hot. Make sure that
the exhaust system does not under any circumstances come into contact with easily
ignitable material such as dry grass or fuels.
The material could otherwise ignite and set
the vehicle alight. Choose your parking spot
accordingly.
Operating the auxiliary heating is thus prohibited at filling stations or when your vehicle
is being refuelled. You must therefore switch
off the auxiliary heating at filling stations.
! Operating the auxiliary heating/ventila-
tion draws on the vehicle battery. After you
have heated or ventilated the vehicle a
maximum of two times, drive for a longer
distance.
i Switch the auxiliary heating on regularly
once a month for about ten minutes.
Selecting the departure time or deactivating a selected departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
off (no timer active).
X Press the a button to confirm.
When a departure time is selected, the yellow indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
X
Changing the departure time
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Heating submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
Change A, B or C.
X Press the a button to confirm.
You can now change the departure time.
X Press the = or ; button to select the
display to be changed: hours, minutes.
X Press the : or 9 button to set the
selected display.
X Press the a button to store the entry.
The yellow indicator lamp on the auxiliary
heating button lights up.
Convenience
Activating/deactivating the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature
You can use the Easy Entry/Exit: function
to activate or deactivate the EASY ENTRY/
EXIT feature (Y page 92).
G Risk of injury
The steering wheel moves when the EASYENTRY/EXIT feature is active. There is a risk
of occupants becoming trapped. Before activating the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature, make
sure that nobody can become trapped.
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could open the
driver's door and thereby unintentionally activate the EASY-ENTRY/EXIT feature and
become trapped.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Easy Entry/Exit: function.
When the Easy Entry/Exit: function is
activated, the vehicle steering wheel is displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Switching the belt adjustment on/off
For further information on belt adjustment
(Y page 43).
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Belt adjustment function.
When the Belt adjustment function is
activated, the vehicle seat belt is displayed
in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Switching the fold-in mirrors when locking function on/off
If you switch on the Auto. fold in function,
the exterior mirrors fold in when you lock the
vehicle. When you unlock the vehicle and then
open the driver's or front-passenger door, the
exterior mirrors fold out again.
If you have switched the function on and you
fold the exterior mirrors in using the button
on the door (Y page 93), they will not fold out
automatically. The exterior mirrors can then
only be folded out using the button on the
door.
Z
211
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
212
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Convenience submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Auto. fold in function.
When the Auto. fold in function is activated, the vehicle's exterior mirror is displayed in red in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Resetting to factory settings
For safety reasons, not all functions are reset:
the Limit Speed (winter tyres) function
in permanent SPEEDTRONIC can only be set
in the Vehicle submenu. If you want to reset
the Daytime driving lights in the Light
submenu, you must turn the key in the ignition lock to position 1.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press the a button to confirm.
The Reset all settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
No or Yes.
X Press the a button to confirm the selection.
If you select Yes, the multifunction display
shows a confirmation message.
: Digital speedometer
; Gear indicator
= Upshift indicator
? Engine oil temperature
A Coolant temperature
Upshift indicator UP = indicates that the
engine has reached the overrevving range
when in the manual gearshift program.
Upshift indicator UP = fades out other messages until you have shifted up.
When the engine temperature is below
80 †, the oil temperature gauge flashes.
Avoid driving at full engine output during this
time.
RACETIMER
Displaying and starting RACETIMER
You can use the RACETIMER to store lap
times.
When RACETIMER is displayed, you cannot
adjust the volume using the W and X
buttons on the steering wheel.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
RACETIMER is shown.
X
AMG menu in AMG vehicles
AMG displays
X
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
: Lap
; RACETIMER
You can start the RACETIMER when the
engine is running or if the key is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
To start: press the W button to start the
RACETIMER.
X To display the intermediate time: press
the X button to show the intermediate
time.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X To stop: press the W button to stop the
RACETIMER.
X
Resetting the current lap
X Press the W button on the steering
wheel to stop the RACETIMER.
X Press X to reset the lap time to "0”.
Deleting all laps
X Press the W button on the steering
wheel to stop the RACETIMER.
X Press the a button.
Reset Race Timer? appears in the multifunction display.
The RACETIMER interrupts timing when you
stop the vehicle and turn the key to position
1 in the ignition lock. When you turn the key
to position 2 or 3 and then press the W
button, timing is continued.
Storing the lap time and starting a new lap
It is possible to store a maximum of sixteen
laps.
X Press the X button on the steering
wheel to show the intermediate time during
timing.
The intermediate time is displayed for five
seconds.
X Press the X button again within five
seconds.
The displayed intermediate time is stored
as a lap time.
Timing starts for a new lap. The new lap is
timed from when the intermediate time is
called up.
X
Press : to select Yes and press a
to confirm.
All laps are deleted.
Overall evaluation
This function is shown if you have stored at
least one lap and stopped the RACETIMER.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
overall evaluation is shown.
X
: RACETIMER overall evaluation
; Total time driven
: RACETIMER
; Fastest lap time (best lap)
= Lap
= Average speed
? Distance covered
A Top speed
Z
213
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
214
Lap evaluation
This function is only available if you have
stored at least two laps and have stopped the
RACETIMER.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the AMG menu.
X Press the 9 button repeatedly until the
lap evaluation is shown.
Each lap is shown in a separate submenu.
The fastest lap is indicated by flashing symbol :.
X
: Lap
; Lap time
= Average lap speed
? Lap length
A Top speed during lap
X
Press the 9 or : button to select a
different lap evaluation.
Display messages
Hiding display messages
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
X Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red.
You cannot hide display messages of the highest priority. The multifunction display shows
these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in
this Owner's Manual.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages. You can call up the display messages
in the message memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows, for example, 2 messages.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 messages.
X Confirm with a.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 44).
ý
G Risk of injury
If the symbol appears in the multifunction display, a seat belt
tongue has not been clipped into a rear seat belt buckle.
X If necessary, ask the occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts.
For further information on the status indicator for the rear seat
belts: (Y page 44).
Z
215
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
216
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
PRE-SAFE
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷ and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
Important functions of PRE-SAFE® have failed. All other occupant
safety systems, e.g. airbags, remain available.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
PRE-SAFE
Functions cur‐
rently limited See
Owner's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
PRE-SAFE® Brake is temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille is dirty.
sensors in the bumpers are dirty.
Rits function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
Ryou deactivate ESP®33
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
PRE-SAFE® Brake is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rthe
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
RReactivate ESP®33.
Rthe system is within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
Clean the DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille
(Y page 274).
X Clean the bumpers (Y page 274).
X Restart the engine.
X Wait until the battery is sufficiently charged.
X
PRE-SAFE
Functions limited
See Owner's Manual
G Risk of accident
PRE-SAFE® Brake is faulty. BAS PLUS or the distance warning signal may also have failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Child seat in
G Risk of injury
wrong position
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontSee Owner's Manual passenger seat: the child seat is positioned incorrectly.
X Fit the child seat in the correct position.
33 AMG
vehicles only.
Z
217
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
218
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of injury
Vehicles with automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat: the automatic child seat recognition sensor is
faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
G Risk of injury
6
G Risk of injury
Restraint sys. mal‐ There is a malfunction in the SRS (Supplemental Restraint System). The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusfunction Consult
ter.
workshop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left malfunc‐ SRS has malfunctioned at the front on the left or right. The 6
tion Consult work‐ warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
shop
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
or
Front right mal‐
function Consult
workshop
6
Rear
tion
shop
or
Rear
tion
shop
left malfunc‐
Consult work‐
G Risk of injury
SRS has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or right. The 6
warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
right malfunc‐
Consult work‐
6
G Risk of injury
Left windowbag mal‐ There is a malfunction in the left-hand and/or right-hand windowbag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusfunction Consult
ter.
workshop
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Right windowbag
malfunction Con‐
sult workshop
Brakes
Display messages
!÷
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill
start assist are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start
assist are temporarily unavailable.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps light up in
the instrument cluster.
For example, the on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
Z
219
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
220
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
!÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
T!
÷
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
J
Release parking
brake
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRE-SAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start
assist are not available due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the J, ÷, å and ! warning lamps light
up in the instrument cluster.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
G Risk of accident
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, PRESAFE®, the HOLD function and hill start assist are not available
due to a malfunction.
The adaptive brake lights, BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, å and ! warning lamps in the instrument cluster light up and a warning tone sounds.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You are driving with the parking brake applied. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Release the parking brake
Display messages
J
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
Check brake fluid
level
There is insufficient brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir. In addition, the red J warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up and a warning tone sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
#
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check brake wear
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left cornering
light
or
Right cornering
light
b
Left dipped beam
or
Right dipped beam
b
Rear left indicator
or
Rear right indica‐
tor
The left or right-hand dipped-beam headlamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
221
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
222
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Front left indica‐
tor
or
Front right indica‐
tor
b
The turn signal in the left-hand and/or right-hand exterior mirror
is faulty.
Left mirror indica‐ X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
tor
or
Right mirror indi‐
cator
b
Third brake lamp
b
Left-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
or
Right-hand tail
lamp/brake lamp
b
Left main beam
or
Right main beam
b
Rear left fog lamp
or
Rear right fog lamp
b
Front left parking
lamp
or
Front right park‐
ing lamp
The third brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The left or right-hand high beam is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The rear foglamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The front left or front right parking lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand reversing lamp is faulty.
X Replace the bulb (Y page 104).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Left revers. lamp
or
Right revers. lamp
b
Left daytime driv‐
ing lamp
or
Right daytime driv‐
ing lamp
b
Intell. Light Sys‐
tem inoperative
b
Malfunction See
Owner's Manual
b
AUTO lights inoper‐
ative
b
Switch off lights
The left or right-hand daytime driving lamp is defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The Intelligent Light System is faulty. The lights remain available
without the Intelligent Light System.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The exterior lighting is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The light sensor is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to c.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist inoperative
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Adaptive Main-beam
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
X Clean the windscreen.
Rvisibility
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is available again if:
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
The Adaptive Main-beam Assist available again message
is displayed.
Rthe
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
224
Display messages
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The coolant level is too low.
X Top up the coolant, observing the warning notes before doing
so (Y page 268).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
?
Coolant Stop vehi‐
cle Switch engine
off
The coolant is too hot.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
The poly-V-belt may have torn.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Wait until the display message disappears before restarting the
engine. Otherwise, there is a risk of engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
?
The fan motor is faulty.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The battery is not being charged.
Possible causes are:
Ra
faulty alternator
torn poly-V-belt
Ra malfunction in the electronics
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Open the bonnet.
X Check whether the poly-V-belt is torn.
Ra
If the poly-V-belt is torn:
! do not continue driving. The engine could otherwise overheat.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the poly-V-belt is OK:
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
4
Check eng. oil
lev. when next
refuelling
8
Reserve fuel level
C
The engine oil level has dropped to a critical level.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the oil level (Y page 267).
X If necessary, top up the engine oil (Y page 268).
X Have the engine checked for leaks if the engine oil needs topping up more often than usual.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
drops into the reserve range.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
There is only a very small amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
The auxiliary heating cannot be operated.
X Refuel at the nearest filling station without fail.
¸
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the engine air filter is dirty and must
be replaced.
Replace air cleaner X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
Vehicles with a diesel engine: there is water in the fuel filter. The
water must be drained off.
Clean the fuel fil‐ X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ter
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
226
Display messages
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on specific criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has determined that
the driver is tired or paying less attention. A warning tone also
sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Drowsiness detec‐
ted
À
Attention Assist
inoperative
¨
During long journeys, take regular breaks in good time so you get
enough rest.
ATTENTION ASSIST has failed.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
Vehicle rising
¨
Vehicle rising
Please wait
¨
Stop vehicle Vehi‐
cle too low
The vehicle level is too low when the vehicle is stationary. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not pull away.
The vehicle level is set when the display message disappears.
You have pulled away while the vehicle level is still too low.
AIRMATIC sets the vehicle to the selected level after a short
period.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
G Risk of accident
AIRMATIC is faulty. A warning tone also sounds.
X Do not exceed a maximum speed of 80 km/h.
X Make only slight steering movements. Otherwise, the front wing
or the tyres could be damaged if the steering movement is too
large.
X Listen for scraping sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road
and traffic conditions, and select a higher vehicle level.
Depending on the malfunction, it may be possible to raise the
vehicle.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
¨
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
Malfunction
The AIRMATIC function is restricted. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
X Do not exceed a maximum speed of 80 km/h.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Speed Limit Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
Speed Limit Assist is deactivated and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Speed Limit Assist is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rvisibility
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
X
Clean the windscreen.
Speed Limit Assist: Speed Limit Assist is only available in certain countries.
Unavailable in
X Drive on.
this country
Speed Limit Assist is available again as soon as you drive into a
country in which its use is approved.
Speed Limit Assist
inoperative
Speed Limit Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
HOLD
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 165).
Radar sensor
deactivated See
Owner's Manual
The radar sensor system is deactivated.
X Check whether or not the radar sensor system may be activated
(Y page 327).
X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 210).
Z
227
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
228
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Radar sensor
deactivated autom.
See Owner's Manual
Vehicles with a navigation system: the vehicle is close to a radio
telescope facility and is therefore prohibited from transmitting any
radar signals. The radar sensor system has switched off automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS (Y page 154) is switched off automatically if it
is activated. A warning tone also sounds.
If Blind Spot Assist (Y page 183) or Active Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 186) are activated, they are switched off automatically.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
BAS PLUS (Brake Assist PLUS) (Y page 57) and the
PRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 61) are also not available.
X Drive on.
These functions are available again as soon as the vehicle is far
enough away from the radio telescope facility (Y page 327).
Lane Keeping
Assist currently
unavailable. see
Owner's Manual
or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist cur‐
rently unavailable
see Owner's Manual
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is deactivated
and temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
windscreen is dirty in the camera's field of vision.
is impaired due to heavy rain, snow or fog.
Rthere are no lane markings for a longer period.
Rthe lane markings are worn, dark or covered, for example by dirt
or snow.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is operational
again and the display message disappears if:
Rvisibility
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the camera is fully operational again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
X
Lane Keeping
Assist inoperative
or
Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist inoper‐
ative
Clean the windscreen.
Lane Keeping Assist or Active Lane Keeping Assist is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Blind Spot Assist
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
or
Active Blind Spot
Assist currently
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
sensors are dirty.
function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is operational again
and the display message disappears if:
Rthe dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
Rthe system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
Rthe radar sensor system is back within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rits
X
X
Clean the sensors (Y page 274).
Restart the engine.
Blind Spot Assist
inoperative
or
Active Blind Spot
Assist inoperative
Blind Spot Assist or Active Blind Spot Assist is faulty.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist
cancelled
The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You have inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel
while steering intervention was active.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Park Assist again later (Y page 173).
Z
229
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
230
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist
inoperative
You have just performed a large number of turning or parking
manoeuvres.
Active Park Assist will become available again after approximately
10 minutes (Y page 173).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
X If the warning message does not disappear: consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Park Assist
switched off
The vehicle is parked. A warning tone also sounds.
The display message disappears automatically.
DISTRONIC PLUS
off
DISTRONIC PLUS has been deactivated (Y page 160). If it is deactivated automatically, a warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS
available again
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again after having been temporarily unavailable. You can now reactivate DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 154).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
DISTRONIC PLUS
currently unavail‐
able See Owner's
Manual
DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated and is temporarily inoperative if:
Rthe
DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille is dirty.
sensors in the bumpers are dirty.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
Rits function is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
A warning tone also sounds.
DISTRONIC PLUS is operational again and the display message
disappears if:
Rthe
Rthe
dirt (e.g. slush) drops away while the vehicle is in motion.
system detects that the sensors are fully available again.
Rthe system is within the operating temperature range.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Rthe
Clean the DISTRONIC PLUS cover in the radiator grille
(Y page 274).
X Clean the bumpers (Y page 274).
X Restart the engine.
X
DISTRONIC PLUS
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS is faulty. BAS PLUS and PRE-SAFE® Brake may
also have failed.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
DISTRONIC PLUS
suspended
You have depressed the accelerator pedal. DISTRONIC PLUS is no
longer controlling the speed of the vehicle.
X Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
DISTRONIC PLUS
--- km/h
An activation condition for DISTRONIC PLUS is not fulfilled.
X Check the activation conditions for DISTRONIC PLUS
(Y page 154).
DISTRONIC PLUS and
SPEEDTRONIC
inoperative
DISTRONIC PLUS and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise control and
SPEEDTRONIC
inoperative
Cruise control and SPEEDTRONIC are faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
231
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
232
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Cruise control
--- km/h
A condition for activating cruise control has not been met.
You have tried to store a speed below 30 km/h, for example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 30 km/h and store the
speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control
(Y page 152).
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
The maximum speed has been exceeded34.
X Drive slower.
Tyres
Display messages
Tyre pressure
Check tyres
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system has detected a significant
loss in pressure.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Check the tyres and, if necessary, change the wheel
(Y page 309).
X Check the tyre pressures and, if necessary, set to the correct
tyre pressure.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system when the tyre
pressure is correct (Y page 306).
Check tyre pres‐
sures
then restart Run
Flat Indicator
The tyre pressure loss warning system generated a display message and has not been restarted since.
X Set the correct tyre pressure in all four tyres.
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system (Y page 306).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor The tyre pressure monitor is faulty.
inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
34 Only
for certain countries.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tyre press. moni‐
tor inoperative
No wheel sensors
The wheels fitted do not have a suitable tyre pressure sensor. The
tyre pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Fit wheels with suitable tyre pressure sensors.
The tyre pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving for a few minutes.
Check
tyre(s)
Caution,
tyre defect
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Correct the tyre pressure (Y page 307).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 309).
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is displayed in the multifunction display.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 309).
Rectify
tyre pressure
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tyre pressure (Y page 307).
Wheel sensor(s)
missing
There is no signal from the tyre pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tyre is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tyre pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre press. monitor Due to a source of radio interference no signals can be received
currently unavail. from the wheel sensors. The tyre pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
X Drive on.
The tyre pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
problem has been solved.
Z
233
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
234
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
h
Tyre pressure Cau‐
tion, tyre malf.
h
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped suddenly.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 309).
G Risk of accident
Tyre pressure
Check tyre(s)
The tyre pressure in one or more tyres has dropped significantly.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 309).
X Check the tyre pressure. If necessary, correct the tyre pressure
(Y page 307).
h
The tyre pressure is too low in at least one of the tyres or the tyre
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tyre pressures at the next opportunity. If necessary,
correct the tyre pressure (Y page 307).
Please correct the
tyre pressure
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To start engine,
shift to P or N
You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Auxiliary battery
malfunction
The auxiliary battery for the automatic transmission is no longer
being charged.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Apply brake to
deselect Park (P)
position
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position D, R or N without depressing the brake pedal.
X Depress the brake pedal.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Vehicle
not in position P
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N
or D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Apply the parking brake.
Without changing
gear,
consult workshop
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only select Park
(P)
when vehicle is
stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
N
The boot lid is open.
X Close the boot lid.
M
C
D
G Risk of accident
The bonnet is open.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Close the bonnet.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors.
G Risk of accident
Power steering mal‐ The power steering assistance is faulty. You will need to use more
force to steer.
function See Own‐
A warning tone also sounds.
er's Manual
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Z
235
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
236
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
&
The on-board voltage is too low. The auxiliary heating has switched
itself off or cannot be switched on (Y page 119).
X Drive for a longer distance.
The battery is being charged. The auxiliary heating can be reactivated as soon as the on-board electrical system voltage is sufficient.
inoperative Bat‐
tery low
&
inoperative Refuel
vehicle
&
inoperative See
Owner's Man.
The fuel level in the fuel tank is too low. The auxiliary heating cannot be switched on (Y page 119).
X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
The auxiliary heating has a temporary malfunction or is faulty.
X When the vehicle is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down, make up to four attempts to switch on the auxiliary heating, waiting several minutes between each attempt
(Y page 119).
X If the auxiliary heating does not switch on, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Top up washer fluid X
Top up the washer fluid (Y page 269).
Key
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
You have put the wrong key in the ignition lock.
X Use the correct key.
Key does not
belong to vehicle
Â
Replace key
Â
Change key batter‐
ies
The key needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The batteries of the KEYLESS-GO key are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 70).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Â
The KEYLESS-GO key is not in the vehicle.
A warning tone also sounds.
If the engine is switched off, you can no longer lock the vehicle
centrally or start the engine.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Locate the KEYLESS-GO key.
Key not detected
(red display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key is not detected while the engine is running
because there is interference from a strong source of radio waves.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
Â
Key not detected
(white display message)
The KEYLESS-GO key cannot be detected at present.
X Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
If the KEYLESS-GO key is still not detected:
Change the location of the key with the KEYLESS-GO functions
in the vehicle.
X Operate the vehicle with the key in the ignition lock if necessary.
X
Â
Key still in vehi‐
cle
Â
Remove starting
button, then
insert key
Â
Close doors to
lock vehicle
The KEYLESS-GO key has been detected inside the vehicle during
locking.
X Remove the KEYLESS-GO key from the vehicle.
KEYLESS-GO is temporarily malfunctioning or is defective. A warning tone also sounds.
X Insert the key into the ignition lock and turn it to the desired
position.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
Z
237
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
238
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Brakes
Problem
J
The yellow brake system warning lamp
lights up while the
engine is running.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The brake system is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
X If the multifunction display shows a display message, please
observe this.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
J
You are driving with the parking brake applied.
The red brake system X Release the parking brake
warning lamp comes on
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
while the vehicle is
moving. A warning tone
also sounds.
J
G Risk of accident
The red brake system The brake boosting effect is malfunctioning and the braking charwarning lamp comes on acteristics may be affected.
while the engine is runX Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
ning. A warning tone
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
also sounds.
under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
J
G Risk of accident
The red brake system There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is run- X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
ning. A warning tone
under any circumstances.
also sounds.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Do not top up the brake fluid. This does not correct the error.
Seat belt
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
7
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
The red seat belt warn- to fasten their seat belts.
ing lamp lights up for
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
six seconds after the
engine starts35.
7
G Risk of injury
After starting the
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
engine, the red seat
belt warning lamp lights X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
The warning tone ceases.
up. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up
to 6 seconds.35
7
G Risk of injury
The red seat belt warn- The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
ing lamp lights up after
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
the engine starts, as
The warning lamp goes out.
soon as the driver's or
the front-passenger
G Risk of injury
door is closed.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out.
35 Only
for certain countries.
Z
239
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
240
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
7
G Risk of injury
The red seat belt warn- The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. At
ing lamp flashes and an the same time, you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly
intermittent audible
driven faster than 25 km/h.
warning sounds.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
G Risk of injury
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. At the same time,
you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have briefly driven faster
than 25 km/h.
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) has been deactivated due to a fault.
lamp is lit while the
For this reason, BAS (Brake Assist), BAS PLUS, ESP® (Electronic
engine is running.
Stability Program), EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution),
PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and adaptive brake light are also deactivated, for example.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
!
G Risk of accident
The yellow ABS warning
ABS is temporarily unavailable. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®,
lamp is lit while the
EBD, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start
engine is running.
assist and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are also deactivated.
Self diagnosis is not yet complete.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements, at a speed above 20 km/h.
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
241
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
242
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
Problem
֌!
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running. A warning tone
also sounds.
J֌!
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps and the yellow
ABS warning lamp are
lit while the engine is
running.
÷
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
EBD is faulty. Therefore, ABS, BAS, BAS PLUS, ESP®, PRE-SAFE®,
PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist and the
adaptive brake lights, for example, are not available either.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ABS and ESP® are faulty. Therefore, BAS, BAS PLUS, EBD,
PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD function, hill start assist
and the adaptive brake lights, for example, are not available either
due to a malfunction.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
The yellow ESP® warn- ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
ing lamp flashes while skidding or at least one wheel has started to spin.
the vehicle is in motion.
Cruise control or DISTRONIC PLUS is deactivated.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when
pulling away.
X Release the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 58).
Problem
å
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The yellow ESP® OFF
ESP® is deactivated. ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle if it starts
warning lamp is lit while to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
the engine is running.
X Reactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 58).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
M
AMG vehicles only:
The yellow SPORT handling mode warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
SPORT handling mode is activated. ESP® only stabilises the vehicle in extreme situations. ESP® intervention may not be able to
provide sufficient assistance in such situations and the vehicle
may start to skid.
X
Reactivate ESP®.
Exceptions: (Y page 58).
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
֌
The yellow ESP® and
ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
engine is running.
6
The red SRS warning
lamp is lit while the
engine is running.
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
ESP®, BAS, BAS PLUS, PRE-SAFE®, PRE-SAFE® Brake, the HOLD
function, hill start assist and the adaptive brake lights are not
available due to a malfunction. ESP® will not stabilise the vehicle
if it starts to skid or if a wheel starts to spin.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of injury
The restraint systems are malfunctioning. The airbags or belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of
an accident, not be triggered at all.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
243
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
244
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Engine
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
;
There may be a fault, for example:
The yellow engine diag- Rin the engine management
nostics warning lamp
Rin the fuel injection system
lights up while the
Rin the exhaust system
engine is running.
Rin the ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
Rthe fuel system
The emission limit values may be exceeded and the engine may
be running in emergency mode.
X Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified
specialist workshop.
;
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the fuel tank has been run dry
The yellow engine diag- (Y page 146).
nostics warning lamp
X Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
lights up while the
If the yellow engine diagnostics warning lamp goes out, emerengine is running.
gency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
8
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
The yellow reserve fuel Operation of the auxiliary heating is deactivated when the fuel level
warning lamp lights up drops into the reserve range.
while the engine is run- X Refuel at the nearest filling station.
ning.
?
The red coolant warning lamp lights up while
the engine is running
and the coolant temperature gauge is at the
start of the scale.
The temperature sensor for the coolant temperature gauge is
faulty.
The coolant temperature is no longer being monitored. There is a
risk of engine damage if the coolant temperature is too high.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue
driving under any circumstances.
X Apply the parking brake.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
If the coolant level is correct, the airflow to the engine radiator
may be blocked or the electric engine radiator fan may be malfunctioning.
The coolant is too hot and the engine is no longer being cooled
sufficiently.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Allow the engine and coolant to cool.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 268).
Observe the warning notes.
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.
?
The red coolant warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running. A warning tone
also sounds.
The coolant temperature has exceeded 120 †. The airflow to the
engine radiator may be blocked or the coolant level may be too
low.
The engine is not being cooled sufficiently and may be damaged.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine,
paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Allow the engine and coolant to cool.
X Check the coolant level and top up the coolant (Y page 268).
Observe the warning notes.
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
engine coolant system checked.
X Make sure that the air supply to the engine radiator is not
blocked, e.g. by snow, slush or ice.
X If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g. driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-start driving.
Z
245
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
246
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
G Risk of accident
The red distance warn- The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
ing lamp lights up while selected.
the vehicle is in motion.
X Increase the distance.
·
G Risk of accident
The red distance warn- A warning is issued if:
ing lamp lights up while
the vehicle is in motion. Ryou are approaching a vehicle in front at too great a speed
RDISTRONIC PLUS or PRE-SAFE® Brake has detected a stationary
A warning tone also
obstacle in your line of travel
sounds.
X Be prepared to brake immediately.
X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
brake or take evasive action.
Tyres
Problem
h
The yellow tyre pressure monitor warning
lamp is on.
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
least one of the tyres.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
manoeuvres. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do
so.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tyre pressure. If necessary, correct the tyre pressure
(Y page 307).
X If necessary, change a wheel (Y page 309).
247
248
248
248
255
Stowing and features
Vehicle equipment ............................
Loading guidelines ............................
Stowage areas ..................................
Features .............................................
248
Stowage areas
Vehicle equipment
Stowing and features
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Loading guidelines
G Risk of injury
Secure and position the load as described in
the loading guidelines.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could
be injured by the load being thrown around in
the event of sharp braking, a sudden change
in direction or an accident.
You will find further information in the "Securing a load" section.
Even if you follow all the loading guidelines,
the load will increase the risk of injury in the
event of an accident.
G Risk of poisoning
Keep the boot lid closed while the vehicle is
in operation. Otherwise, you could be poisoned by exhaust fumes entering the vehicle.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. For this reason, you
should observe the following notes when
transporting a load:
Rwhen transporting a load, never exceed the
maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle
(including occupants).
Rposition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the boot as possible.
Rthe load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
Ralways
place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
Ralways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
Rsecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant lashing material. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Stowage areas
Stowage compartments
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
The stowage compartments must be closed
when items are stored in them. Luggage nets
are not designed to secure heavy items of
luggage.
You or other vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Sharp-edged and fragile objects must not be
placed in the luggage net.
Do not place hard objects in the map pockets.
Objects must not protrude from the map
pockets.
Front stowage compartments
Glove compartment
i The glove compartment can be ventilated
(Y page 124).
Stowage areas
249
To open: pull handle : and open glove
compartment flap ;.
X To close: fold glove compartment flap ;
upwards until it engages.
X
The glove compartment can only be locked
and unlocked using the emergency key element.
To lock: insert the emergency key element
into the lock and turn it 90° clockwise to
position 2.
X To unlock: insert the emergency key element into the lock and turn it 90° anticlockwise to position 1.
Front stowage compartment
To open: slide the cover forwards by handle : in the direction of the arrow until it
engages.
X To close: briefly press the front of handle :.
X
X
Rear stowage compartment
X
Briefly press chrome catch ; in the direction of the arrow.
Cover : swings upwards.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment, a
12 V socket, a USB connection and AUX IN
connection or Media Interface is installed
in the stowage compartment. A Media
Interface is a universal interface for portable audio equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or
USB device (see the separate Audio or
COMAND APS operating instructions).
Z
Stowing and features
Stowage compartments in the centre console
Stowage areas
250
Rear stowage compartments
Stowing and features
Stowage compartments in the rear centre
console
X
To open: pull handle : upwards.
The armrest folds out.
Stowage compartment under the front
seats
G Risk of injury
Only load the stowage compartment with the
maximum permissible load of 1.5 kg. Otherwise, the transported load could, for example,
be thrown out of the stowage compartment if
you change direction suddenly or brake
sharply and could injure you or others.
To open: slide covers : and ; in the
direction of the arrow.
i There is a 12 V power socket in the front
stowage compartment.
X
Stowage compartment in the rear seat
armrest
i On vehicles with a fire extinguisher
instead of a stowage compartment, the fire
extinguisher is installed under the driver's
seat.
To open: fold down seat armrest ;.
X Fold cover : of the armrest upwards.
X
Luggage nets
X
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
G Risk of injury
Only place lightweight objects in the luggage
net. Do not use it to transport heavy, sharpedged or fragile objects. The luggage net cannot secure the objects sufficiently in the event
of an accident.
Stowage areas
Through-loading facility in the rear
bench seat
Important safety notes
Vehicles without memory function: if necessary, move the driver's or frontpassenger seat forwards.
X Open the boot.
X Pull right-hand or left-hand rear seat backrest release handle :.
The corresponding rear seat backrest is
released.
X
G Risk of injury
Do not carry heavy or hard objects inside the
vehicle or in the boot unless they are secured.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around the vehicle in the event of sharp braking, a sudden change in direction or an accident.
G Risk of poisoning
Always drive with the boot lid closed. Exhaust
fumes could otherwise enter the vehicle interior.
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded down separately to
increase the boot capacity.
Fold rear seat backrest ; forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Folding back the seat backrest
Folding the seat backrest forwards
X
i Vehicles with memory function: when you
fold one or both parts of the rear seat backrest forwards, the respective front seat
moves forward slightly, when necessary, in
order to avoid contact.
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
X
Fold rear seat backrest : back until it
engages.
Z
Stowing and features
Luggage nets are located in the frontpassenger footwell and on the left and righthand sides of the boot.
251
Stowage areas
252
Stowing and features
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the rear seat backrest is correctly engaged. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
If the rear seat backrest is not engaged, this
will be shown in the multifunction display in
the instrument cluster.
i You should always engage the rear seat
backrests if you do not need the throughloading feature. This will prevent unauthorised access to the boot from the vehicle
interior.
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
Securing a load
Lashing eyelets
: Lashing eyelets
Bag hook
G Risk of injury
Only hang light loads on the bag holders. Do
not use them to transport heavy, sharp-edged
or fragile objects. When braking sharply,
changing direction quickly or in the event of
an accident, the bag hooks will not secure the
items sufficiently. This could result in injury to
yourself or others.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load
of 3 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
G Risk of injury
Distribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if you:
Rbrake
sharply
direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Please observe the loading guidelines.
Rchange
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Rsecure
the load using the lashing eyelets.
not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
Rdo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
Rpad sharp edges for protection.
There are six lashing eyelets in the boot.
Rdo
X
Pull bag hook ; down by tab :.
EASY-PACK boot box
Important safety notes
G Risk of injury
Only load the EASY-PACK convenience box to
the maximum permissible load of 10 kg. To
prevent overloading, the floor of the box
Stowage areas
To raise the load surface: press switch
=.
Load surface ; of the box moves up automatically.
X To stow the box: push the box in by handle : all the way to the stop.
X
Removing and fitting
Stowing and features
moves down onto the boot floor mat when
loaded with more than approx. 5 kg.
Do not transport sharp-edged and fragile
objects in the box.
Otherwise, e.g. in the event of a rapid change
of direction or heavy braking, the objects
could be thrown out of the EASY-PACK convenience box and injure you and others.
! When the EASY-PACK convenience box is
pulled out, no objects may be placed on the
frame of the box or pushed onto the frame
from above. Otherwise, the box could be
damaged.
Adjusting the height to any position
X
Pull the box out by handle : in the direction of the arrow all the way to the stop.
X Lowering the load surface: push the
centre of load surface ; down by hand in
the direction of the arrow until load surface ; has reached the desired position
and the box is the desired size.
To install: insert retainer ; of box : into
slots =
X
G Risk of injury
Make sure that your hands are not inside the
EASY-PACK convenience box when the load
surface moves up. Otherwise, you could be
injured.
253
Raise box : and press hooks A into
anchorage ? as far as they will go.
X Turn left-hand rotating catch B clockwise
and right-hand rotating catch B anti-clockwise by 90˚.
X To remove: turn left-hand rotating catch
B anti-clockwise and right-hand rotating
catch B clockwise by 90˚.
X Move box : downwards and pull it out
from anchorages ?.
X
Z
Stowage areas
254
i Store the EASY-PACK boot box on a flat
surface after removal, e.g. on a suitable
shelf.
Stowage well under the boot floor
Stowing and features
The TIREFIT kit, the vehicle tool kit, etc. are
located in the stowage compartment.
around and could injure you or others or
cause an accident. Follow the roof carrier/ski
rack manufacturer's installation instructions
and special instructions for use.
The roof load raises the vehicle's centre of
gravity, thereby affecting vehicle handling.
You must always observe the maximum roof
load of 100 kg. Always adapt your driving style
to the prevailing road, traffic and weather
conditions and drive with particular care if the
roof is laden.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
X
only use roof carriers that have been tested
and approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof carrier in such
a way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Ensure that, depending on the vehicle's
equipment, you can raise the sliding sunroof fully and open the boot lid fully when
the roof carrier is fitted.
To open: pull handle : upwards.
! To avoid damaging or scratching the covers, do not use metallic or hard objects to
open them.
Attaching the roof carrier
X
Hook handle : into rain trough ;.
! Remove the handle again before closing
the boot lid and snap it in tightly to prevent
the handle flap from protruding. Otherwise,
you could damage the handle.
Roof carrier
Important safety notes
G Risk of accident and injury
An incorrectly secured roof carrier, ski rack or
load could become detached from the vehicle. These objects might then be thrown
Open covers : carefully in the direction of
the arrow.
X Fold covers : upwards.
X
Features
Features
Cup holder
Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage space.
X Slide catch : outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
X
Cup holder in the rear-compartment
centre console
Stowing and features
Only secure the roof carrier to the anchorage points under covers :.
X Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
X
Points to observe before use
G Risk of injury
Keep the cup holder closed while the vehicle
is in motion. Otherwise, vehicle occupants
could be injured by objects being thrown
around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Only use the cup holders for containers of a
suitable size and which have lids. Otherwise,
the drinks could spill.
Cup holders should not be used for hot drinks.
Otherwise, you may scald yourself.
Cup holder in the centre console
The cup holder can be removed for cleaning.
Clean the cup holder with clear, lukewarm
water only.
X To open: slide cover : to the front.
X To remove the insert: slide catch ;
inwards in the direction of the arrow.
X Remove cup holder insert = upwards.
X To refit the insert: place the insert in the
stowage space.
X Slide catch ; outwards in the direction of
the arrow until it engages.
Cup holder in the rear seat armrest
! Do not sit or lean on the armrest when it
is folded down as you could otherwise damage it.
The cup holder can be removed for cleaning.
Clean the cup holder with clear, lukewarm
water only.
X To open: lightly press the front of
cover ;.
X To remove the insert: slide both sides of
catch : inwards in the direction of the
arrow.
255
! Do not fold the armrest up unless the cup
holder is closed. Otherwise, the cup holder
could be damaged.
Z
Features
Stowing and features
256
Fold down the rear seat armrest.
X To open: raise the armrest cover.
X Press release catch :.
Cup holder ; folds out forwards.
X Swing the armrest cover back down, if necessary.
X
To close: raise the armrest cover.
X Swing cup holder ; back until it engages.
X
Press the outer edge of button : and slide
in the direction of the arrow until the bottle
fits into the opening.
X Insert the bottle into the bottle holder.
X
Sun visors
Sun visor overview
G Risk of accident
Bottle holder
G Risk of injury
Do not transport heavy, sharp-edged and fragile bottles in the bottle holder. In the event of
an accident, the bottle holder can not secure
the bottles adequately.
Keep the mirrors in the sun visors covered
while driving. You could otherwise be dazzled,
which may impair your view of traffic conditions and as a result could cause an accident.
! Make sure that any bottles weighing more
than 0.5 kg that are stored in the bottle
holder rest on the vehicle floor. The bottle
holder could otherwise be damaged.
The bottle holder is suitable for bottles with a
capacity from 0.7 l to 1.5 l.
The bottle holder does not secure the bottles;
it merely prevents them from tipping over.
: Mirror light
; Bracket
= Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Features
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover
A has been folded up.
Glare from the side
X
Fold down the sun visor.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To extend or retract: briefly press button :.
The roller sunblind fully extends or fully
retracts.
X
Ashtray
Ashtray in the cockpit
i There is a stowage space under the ashtray.
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
Pull sun visor : out of retainer ;.
X Swing sun visor : to the side.
X Slide sun visor : in the direction of the
arrow as desired.
X
Rear window roller sunblind
! Make sure that the roller sunblind can
move freely. Otherwise, the roller sunblind
or other objects could be damaged.
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: hold insert = by
the ribbing at the sides and lift it up and out
in the direction of arrow ;.
X To refit the insert: press insert = into the
holder until it engages.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
Z
Stowing and features
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
257
Features
258
Stowing and features
Ashtray in the rear compartment
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Slide cover : forwards until it engages.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
12 V sockets
Points to observe before use
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X To remove the insert: lift insert ; up and
out.
X To refit the insert: replace insert ; from
above.
X Press insert ; into the holder until it
engages.
X
Cigarette lighter
! If you are using all sockets in the vehicle,
make sure that you do not exceed the maximum current draw of 55 A. Otherwise, you
will overload the fuses.
The socket can be used for accessories with
a maximum power consumption of 180 W,
e.g. lamps or chargers for mobile phones.
If you use the sockets for long periods when
the engine is switched off, the battery may
discharge.
Dashboard socket
G Risk of injury and fire
Only hold the hot cigarette lighter by its knob.
Otherwise, you might burn yourself.
Make sure that children travelling in the vehicle are not able to injure themselves on the
hot cigarette lighter or cause a fire with it.
Open the stowage space under the armrest
(Y page 249).
X Lift up the cover of socket :.
X
An additional socket is fitted in the centre
console on vehicles without an ashtray or a
cigarette lighter.
Centre console, front
Features
X
259
Lift up the cover of socket :.
Mobile phone
To open: slide cover : forwards until it
engages.
X Lift up the cover of socket ;.
X To close: press cover : briefly at the
front.
The cover moves back.
X
Socket in the rear compartment
Observe the legal requirements of the country
in which you are currently driving regarding
operating mobile communications equipment
in a vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you must only do so if the traffic situation permits. Otherwise, you could be distracted from the traffic conditions, cause an
accident and injure yourself and others.
Two-way radios and fax equipment used without low-reflection exterior aerials can interfere with the vehicle's electronics and thereby
jeopardise the operating safety of the vehicle
and your safety. Therefore, you must only use
this equipment if it is correctly connected to
a separate reflection-free exterior aerial.
G Risk of injury
X
X
Slide cover : forwards until it engages.
Lift up the cover of socket ;.
Socket in the boot
Excessive levels of electromagnetic radiation
may cause damage to your health and the
health of others. Using an exterior aerial takes
into account current scientific discussions
relating to the possible health risk posed by
electromagnetic fields.
To ensure optimum reception quality for
mobile phones in the vehicle and to minimise
mutual influences between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones, Mercedes-Benz
recommends the use of an approved exterior
aerial. An exterior aerial conducts the electromagnetic fields generated by a wireless
device to the exterior of the vehicle; the field
strength within the vehicle interior is lower
than in a vehicle that does not have an exterior aerial.
i There are various mobile phone brackets
that may be fitted to your vehicle; in some
cases, these are country-specific. You can
obtain these mobile phone brackets from a
Z
Stowing and features
G Risk of accident
Features
Stowing and features
260
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Further information about the mobile
phone brackets supported can also be
found on the Internet at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect.
Inserting the mobile phone
Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 249).
X Depending on the model of the mobile
phone bracket, install the sliding adapter
(Y page 260).
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate mobile
phone bracket installation instructions.
X
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, you can speak to the person
you are calling using the hands-free system.
You can operate the telephone using the
6 and ~ buttons on the multifunction
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 201).
If you are making a call and you would like to
take the key out of the ignition lock, first
remove the mobile phone from the bracket.
Otherwise, the call will be ended.
Sliding adapter for mobile phone
bracket36
Certain mobile phone brackets require a sliding adapter so the bracket can be installed
correctly.
36 Vehicles
: Previous model: example of a mobile
phone bracket
; New model: example of a mobile phone
bracket
= Sliding adapter
Fitting the sliding adapter
Insert sliding adapter : by aligning the
openings with lugs ; of contact plate =.
X Attach the mobile phone bracket to sliding
adapter :; see the separate mobile phone
bracket fitting instructions.
X Press both release buttons 4 and press
sliding adapter : with the mobile phone
bracket down until it engages.
X
X
Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate mobile
phone bracket installation instructions.
with automatic transmission and DIRECT SELECT lever.
Features
Removing the sliding adapter
261
Programming the integrated garage
door opener in the rear-view mirror
Programming
Only press the transmitter button on the integrated remote control if there are no persons
or objects present within the sweep of the
garage door. Persons could otherwise be
injured as the door moves.
Remove the mobile phone from its bracket;
see the separate mobile phone bracket fitting instructions.
X Press both release buttons ; and press
sliding adapter : with the mobile phone
bracket upwards until it disengages.
X Remove the mobile phone bracket from
sliding adapter :; see the separate mobile
phone bracket fitting instructions.
X Detach sliding adapter : using suitable
tool = and remove.
X
Garage door opener
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not part of
this integrated garage door opener.
i To achieve the best results, insert new
batteries in garage door remote control
A before programming.
Important safety notes
The HomeLink® remote control integrated in
the rear-view mirror allows you to operate up
to three different door and gate systems.
i The garage door opener is only available
for certain countries. Observe the legal
requirements in each country.
The HomeLink® garage door opener is
compatible with most European garage and
gate opener drives. More information on
HomeLink® and/or compatible products is
available from:
Rany Mercedes-Benz Service Centre
Rthe HomeLink® hotline
(0) 08000 466 354 65 (free of charge) or
+49 (0) 6838 907 277 (charges apply)
Ron the Internet at: http://
www.homelink.com
Before programming for the first time, clear
the memory of the integrated garage door
opener (Y page 263).
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press and hold one of the transmitter buttons ; to ? on the integrated garage door
opener.
After a short time, indicator lamp : will
start flashing. It flashes about once per
second.
i Indicator lamp : flashes immediately
the first time that the transmitter button is
programmed. If this transmitter button has
already been programmed, indicator
lamp : will only start flashing at a rate of
X
Z
Stowing and features
G Risk of accident
Features
262
once a second after 20 seconds have
elapsed.
Keep the transmitter button depressed.
Point transmitter button B of garage door
remote control A towards the transmitter
buttons on the rear-view mirror at a distance of 5 to 20 cm.
i The required distance between garage
door remote control A and the integrated
door opener depends on the garage door
drive system. You might require several
attempts. You should test every position for
at least 20 seconds before trying another
position.
X
Stowing and features
X
Press and hold transmitter button B on
garage door remote control A until the
indicator lamp : starts to flash rapidly.
The programming has been successful if
indicator lamp : flashes rapidly.
X Release transmitter button ;, = or ? on
the integrated garage door opener and
transmitter button B on garage door
remote control A.
X
If indicator lamp : goes out after approximately 20 seconds and has not flashed rapidly:
X
Repeat the programming procedure for the
transmitter button. This time, change the
distance between the garage door remote
control and the rear-view mirror.
i If the garage door system works with a
rolling code, you must synchronise the
remote control integrated in the rear-view
mirror with the garage door system
receiver after programming.
You will find further information in the
garage door opening system's operating
instructions, e.g. the sections on "Synchronising the transmitter" or "Registering a
new transmitter". You can also call the hotline mentioned above.
Problems when programming
If you experience problems when programming the garage door opener integrated in the
rear-view mirror, note the following:
Rcheck
the transmitter frequency of garage
door remote control A (this can usually be
found on the rear of the remote control).
Rchange the batteries in garage door remote
control A. This increases the likelihood
that garage door remote control A will
send a strong and precise signal to the
integrated remote control in the rear-view
mirror.
Rwhen programming, hold garage door
remote control A at different distances
and angles from the transmitter button that
you are programming. Try various angles at
distances from 5 to 30 cm or the same
angle but varying distances.
RIf there is another remote control for the
same garage door drive, perform the programming steps again using the other
remote control. Before performing these
steps, make sure that new batteries have
been fitted in the garage door remote control.
RAlign the aerial cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Opening or closing the garage door
Once programmed, the integrated remote
control will assume the function of the garage
door system's remote control. Please also
read the operating instructions for the garage
door system.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press transmitter button ;, = or ? in the
overhead control panel that you have programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Features
263
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
i The transmitter will transmit a signal for
Stowing and features
as long as the transmitter button is
pressed. The transmission is halted after a
maximum of 10 seconds, and indicator
lamp : flashes yellow. Press the transmitter button again, if necessary.
Clearing the memory of the integrated
garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Press the transmitter buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp lights up yellow.
X Press and hold transmitter buttons ;
and ? until the indicator lamp turns green.
X
i Make sure that you clear the memory of
the integrated garage door opener before
selling the vehicle.
Z
Features
264
Frequencies for the garage door opener
The radio type approval number and the frequency range for the garage door opener can be
found on the Internet at: http://www.mercedes-benz.de/betriebsanleitung.
Floormat on the driver's side
Stowing and features
G Risk of accident
Make sure that there is sufficient clearance
around the pedals when floormats are used,
and that the floormats are properly secured.
The floormats must be correctly secured at all
times using retainers and press-studs.
Before you drive off, check the floormats and
secure if necessary. A floormat which is not
properly secured can slip and, thereby, interfere with the movement of the pedals.
Do not place floormats on top of one another.
Slide the seat backwards.
To fit: place the floormat in position.
X Press studs : onto retainers ;.
X
X
To remove: pull the floormat off retainers ;.
X Remove the floormat.
X
Retrofitted anti-glare film
Retrofitted anti-glare film on the inside of the
windows can interfere with radio/mobile
telephone reception. This is particularly the
case for conductive or metallic-coated films.
Information about anti-glare film can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
265
266
266
269
270
Maintenance and care
Vehicle equipment ............................
Engine compartment ........................
Maintenance ......................................
Care ....................................................
266
Engine compartment
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
Maintenance and care
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Engine compartment
Bonnet
Opening the bonnet
G Risk of accident
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle
is in motion. If you do so, the bonnet may open
up and block your view.
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of injury if the bonnet is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become very
hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Owner's Manual
and observe the relevant safety notes.
G Risk of injury
The radiator fan between the radiator and the
engine can start automatically, even if the key
has been removed from the ignition lock. For
this reason, you must not reach into the fan
rotation area. You could otherwise be injured.
Vehicles with a petrol engine: The electronic ignition system uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch ignition
system components (ignition coil, ignition
cables, spark plug connectors or test socket)
while:
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on and the engine
is being cranked by hand
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Vehicles with a diesel engine: The electronic injection control uses high voltage. For
this reason, you must never touch injection
system components while:
Rthe
Rthe
engine is running
engine is being started
Rthe ignition is switched on
You could otherwise suffer an electric shock
and be seriously or even fatally injured.
Rthe
X
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
G Risk of injury
The windscreen wipers and wiper linkage
could be set in motion.
When the bonnet is open, you or others could
be injured by the wiper linkage.
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off. Remove the key or make sure
that no ignition position has been selected
with KEYLESS-GO. All indicator lamps must be
off in the instrument panel.
Engine compartment
267
Engine oil
Notes on the oil level
X
Pull release lever : on the bonnet.
The bonnet is released.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
not folded away from the windscreen. Otherwise, you could damage the windscreen
wipers or the bonnet.
X
Reach into the gap, pull bonnet catch handle ; up and lift the bonnet.
Checking the oil level using the oil dipstick
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may
be installed at a different location.
When checking the oil level:
Rpark
the vehicle on a level surface.
engine should be switched off for
approximately five minutes if the engine is
at normal operating temperature.
Rthe
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
Closing the bonnet
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped
as you close the bonnet.
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Open it again and close
it with a little more force.
X
Example: vehicles with a diesel engine
Pull oil dipstick : out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick :.
X
Z
Maintenance and care
Depending on driving style, the vehicle consumes a maximum of 0.8 l oil per 1000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds.
Engine compartment
268
Slowly insert oil dipstick : into the oil dipstick tube to the stop, and take it out again.
The oil level is correct if the level is between
MIN mark = and MAX mark ;.
X Top up the oil if necessary.
X
Adding engine oil
Maintenance and care
H Environmental note
When topping up the oil, take care not to spill
any. If oil enters the soil or waterways, it is
harmful to the environment.
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking the coolant level
Only check the coolant level when the vehicle
is on a level surface and the engine has cooled
down.
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 129) in
the ignition lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the
Start/Stop button twice (Y page 129).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
G Risk of injury
The cooling system is pressurised. Therefore,
only unscrew the cap once the engine has
cooled down. The coolant temperature gauge
must display less than 70 † . Otherwise, you
could be scalded if hot coolant escapes.
Example: engine oil cap
Turn cap : anti-clockwise and remove it.
X Top up with the amount of oil required.
X
Fill carefully to the maximum mark on the oil
dipstick.
i Depending on the engine, the difference
between the minimum mark and the maximum mark is approximately 1.5 – 2 litres.
! Do not add too much oil. If the oil level is
above the "max" mark on the dipstick, too
much oil has been added. This can lead to
damage to the engine or the catalytic converter. Have excess oil siphoned off.
Further information on engine oil
(Y page 320).
X Replace cap : on the filler neck and
tighten clockwise.
Ensure that the cap locks into place
securely.
Slowly turn cap : half a turn anti-clockwise and allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap : further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar
= in the filler neck when cold, there is
enough coolant in coolant expansion
tank ;.
If the coolant level is approximately 1.5 cm
above marker bar = in the filler neck when
warm, there is enough coolant in coolant
expansion tank ;.
X
Maintenance
If necessary, top up with coolant that has
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
X
269
! Do not use distilled or de-ionised water in
the washer fluid reservoir. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
i Add windscreen washer concentrate, e.g.
MB SummerFit, to the washer fluid all year
round.
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 322).
The washer fluid reservoir is used for both the
windscreen washer system and the headlamp
cleaning system.
i Vehicle components and their service
products must match. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use products that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. These are listed under the relevant
section in this Mercedes-Benz Owner's
Manual.
You can recognise service products
approved by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations
that relate to a level of quality or a specification in accordance with an MB Sheet
number (such as MB 229.5) have not necessarily been approved by Mercedes-Benz.
You can obtain further information from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of fire
Windscreen washer fluid is highly flammable.
Fire, naked flames and smoking are prohibited when handling washer fluid concentrate.
! Only use washer fluid concentrate which
is suitable for plastic lamp lenses. Unsuitable washer fluid concentrate could damage the plastic lamp lenses of the headlamps.
Example: washer fluid reservoir
Mix the windscreen washer fluid in a container beforehand.
X At temperatures above freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
and windscreen washer concentrate (e.g.
MB SummerFit).
X At temperatures below freezing: fill the
washer fluid reservoir with a mix of water
and windscreen washer concentrate (e.g.
MB WinterFit). Adapt the mixing ratio to the
outside temperatures.
X
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Top up with the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
Maintenance
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Service messages
Information on the type of service and service
intervals (see separate Service Booklet).
You can obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
Maintenance and care
Windscreen washer system and headlamp cleaning system
Care
Maintenance and care
270
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you when the next service is due.
If a service due date has been exceeded, you
also hear an acoustic signal.
The multifunction display shows a service
message for a few seconds, e.g.
Next service A due in .. days
Service A due
Service A overdue by ... days
The letter indicates which service is due. A
stands for a minor service and B for a major
service. A number or another letter may be
displayed after the letter. This figure indicates
any necessary additional maintenance work
to be performed.
If you report this displayed information to a
qualified specialist workshop, for example a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, they can
inform you of the costs the service will incur.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
Subtract the battery disconnection periods
from the service date shown on the display
after reconnecting the battery.
Hiding a service message
X
Press % or a on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
X
Switch on the ignition.
Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select the ASSYST
PLUS submenu and press a to confirm.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
Please bear the following in mind
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service interval display after
the necessary service work has been carried
out.
You can obtain further information, e.g.
regarding service work, from a MercedesBenz Service Centre or directly from
Mercedes-Benz.
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval indi-
cator has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Have the service work carried out as described in the Service Booklet. There may otherwise be increased wear, resulting in damage to the vehicle or to the major assemblies.
Care
Notes on care
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
Rabrasive
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and
brake pads, thus drying them. The vehicle
can then be parked up.
Care of the exterior
Automatic car wash
G Risk of accident
Braking efficiency is reduced after washing
the vehicle. This could cause an accident. For
this reason, following a car wash, drive with
particular care until the brakes are dry.
G Risk of accident
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate the HOLD function and DISTRONIC
PLUS before the vehicle is washed in an automatic car wash.
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before
cleaning it in an automatic car wash.
! In car washes with a towing mechanism,
make sure that the automatic transmission
is in transmission position N, otherwise the
vehicle could be damaged.
RVehicles with a key:
do not remove the key from the ignition
lock. Do not open the driver's door or
front-passenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels. You
can prevent this by shifting the automatic transmission to N beforehand.
RVehicles with KEYLESS-GO:
do not open the driver's door or frontpassenger door when the engine is
switched off. Otherwise, the automatic
transmission selects park position P
automatically and locks the wheels.
Observe the following to make sure that the
automatic transmission stays in position N:
X Make sure the vehicle is stationary and the
ignition is switched off.
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 129) in
the ignition lock.
Use the key instead of the Start/Stop button on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the parking brake.
X Switch off the ignition and leave the key in
the ignition lock.
! Make sure that:
Rthe side windows and sliding sunroof are
closed completely.
blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off (OFF button is depressed).
Rthe windscreen wiper switch is at position 0.
The vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windscreen and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windscreen.
Z
271
Maintenance and care
Care
272
Care
High-pressure cleaning equipment
G Risk of accident
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your
vehicle, in particular the tyres. You could otherwise damage the tyres and cause an accident.
Maintenance and care
! Always maintain a distance of at least
30 cm between the vehicle and the highpressure cleaner nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints etc.
components
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim elements
Rventilation slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Relectrical
Cleaning the wheels
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park up the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and
brake pads, thus drying them. The vehicle
can then be parked up.
Cleaning the paintwork
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X Remove impurities immediately, where
possible, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin,
oils, fuels and greases by rubbing gently
with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Care and treatment of matt paintwork
If your vehicle has a clear matt finish, observe
the following instructions in order to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
care.
These notes also apply to light alloy wheels
with a clear matt finish.
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing makes the paintwork
shiny.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matt finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Care
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
cles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
! Do not pull on the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
Cleaning the windows
G Risk of injury
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, press the Start/Stop
button repeatedly until all indicator lamps in
the instrument cluster have gone off. The
windscreen wipers could otherwise move and
injure you.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
agent that is recommended and approved
by Mercedes-Benz.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Do not use hard objects to clean the insides
of the windows, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Clean the wiper blades carefully using a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windscreen wipers back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windscreen could be damaged if
the wiper arm hits against it suddenly.
Cleaning the exterior lighting
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the exterior lighting.
Cleaning the wiper blades
G Risk of injury
Switch off the windscreen wipers and remove
the key from the ignition lock before cleaning
the windscreen or the wiper blades. On vehiZ
Maintenance and care
Always have paintwork repairs performed
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
273
Care
274
Cleaning the sensors
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
Impurities combined with the effects of road
grit and corrosive environmental factors may
cause flash rust to form on the surface. You
can restore the original shine of the exhaust
tail pipe by cleaning it regularly, especially in
winter and after washing.
! Do not clean the exhaust tail pipes with
Maintenance and care
alkaline-based cleaning agents, such as
wheel cleaner.
X
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
! If you clean the sensors with a high-pressure cleaner, make sure that you keep a
distance of at least 30 cm between the
vehicle and the high-pressure cleaner nozzle. Information about the correct distance
is available from the equipment manufacturer.
Cleaning the reversing camera
Clean the exhaust tail pipes with a chrome
care product tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Interior care
Cleaning the display
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially-available microfibre cloth and TFT/
LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfibre cloth.
X
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or petrol
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Rabrasive
Cleaning Night View Assist Plus
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the reversing camera with a highpressure cleaner.
! Never clean the camera lens. When clean-
ing the field of vision of the driving systems,
make sure that you do not spray glass
cleaner on the camera lens. If the camera
lens is dirty, visit a qualified specialist work-
Care
shop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
275
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come in contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfibre cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change colour temporarily. Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
Fold down the camera cover by recess :.
Cleaning real wood and trim strips
Wipe the wooden trim and trim strips with
a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfibre
cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use car care and cleaning
products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
X
Use a soft cloth to clean the windscreen in
front of camera ;.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G Risk of injury
When cleaning the steering wheel boss and
dashboard, do not use cockpit sprays or
cleaning agents containing solvents. Cleaning
agents containing solvents cause the surface
to become porous, and as a result plastic
parts may break away and be thrown around
the interior when an airbag is deployed, which
may result in severe injuries.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You could otherwise damage the plastic.
Cleaning the seat covers
! Do not use microfibre cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or
Alcantara® covers. If used often, these can
damage the cover.
! Observe the following when cleaning:
Rclean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth. Make sure that
the leather does not become soaked. It
may otherwise become rough and
cracked. Only use leather care agents
that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. You can obtain these
from a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
a Mercedes-Benz Service centre.
Rclean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
Z
Maintenance and care
X
Care
276
Rclean cloth covers with a microfibre cloth
Maintenance and care
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid). Rub
carefully and always wipe entire seat sections to avoid leaving visible lines. Leave
the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning
results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
Rclean Alcantara® covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure you wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
i Note that regular care is essential to
ensure that the appearance and comfort of
the covers is retained over time.
Cleaning the seat belts
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seatbelts
at temperatures above 80 † or by exposing
them to direct sunlight.
277
278
278
281
290
294
295
298
Breakdown assistance
Vehicle equipment ............................
Where will I find...? ...........................
Flat tyre .............................................
Battery ...............................................
Jump-starting ....................................
Towing and tow-starting ..................
Electrical fuses .................................
Where will I find...?
278
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Fold feet = down and out to the side.
X Pull side reflectors ; upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
upper press-stud :.
X
First-aid kit
Open the boot lid.
Slide down the luggage net.
X Open the stowage compartment.
X
X
Breakdown assistance
Where will I find...?
Warning triangle
Removing the warning triangle
X
Open the boot lid.
X
X
Release strap :.
Remove first-aid kit ;.
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
at least once a year. Replace the contents
if necessary, and replace missing contents.
X
Turn the catch 90° in the direction of the
arrow and remove warning triangle :.
Setting up the warning triangle
Fire extinguisher
The fire extinguisher is located in the stowage
compartment underneath the driver's seat.
Where will I find...?
Pull handle : upward and fold cover ;
forward.
X Remove the fire extinguisher from the
stowage compartment.
X
! Keep the stowage compartment closed
279
= Tyre inflation compressor
? Fuse allocation chart
X
Vehicles with a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel: lift up the boot floor
(Y page 254).
while the vehicle is in motion. It may otherwise be damaged.
each use and checked every one or two
years. It may otherwise fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements in all countries concerned.
Vehicle tool kit
The vehicle tool kit can be found in the stowage well under the boot floor.
i Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit are not equip-
ped with the tools needed to change a
wheel when they leave the factory, e.g. a
jack or wheel wrench. Country-specific differences are possible. Some tools for
changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. To obtain tools approved for your vehicle, visit a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: lift up the
boot floor (Y page 254).
: Towing eye
; Tyre sealant filler bottle
37 AMG
vehicles only.
: Vehicle tool kit tray
; Stowage well
= "Minispare" emergency spare wheel
The vehicle tool kit contains:
Rfoldable
Rfuse
wheel chock
allocation chart
Rjack
Rcentring
pin
pair of gloves
Rwheel wrench
Rtowing eye
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel37: lift up the boot floor
(Y page 254).
Rone
Breakdown assistance
i Have the fire extinguisher refilled after
280
Where will I find...?
Turn stowage tray ; anti-clockwise and
remove together with vehicle tool kit
tray :.
X Remove "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel =.
X
Removing the collapsible emergency
spare wheel: AMG vehicles
: Towing eye
Breakdown assistance
; One pair of gloves
= Jack
? Folding wheel chock
A Centring pin
B Sheet for faulty wheel
C Tyre inflation compressor
D Wheel wrench
E Fuse allocation chart
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel/
collapsible emergency spare wheel
Removing the "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel/collapsible emergency
spare wheel
The emergency spare wheel can be found in
the stowage well under the boot floor.
Removing the "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
X Lift the boot floor upwards (Y page 254).
Reach into cutout : in the tool holder and
lift it up.
X Remove collapsible emergency spare
wheel ;.
X
For further information on changing a wheel
and fitting the spare wheel, see
(Y page 284).
Stowing a used collapsible emergency
spare wheel
Take the following steps to store a used collapsible emergency spare wheel; otherwise,
it does not fit in the spare wheel well.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
this work carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
! Only place the collapsible emergency
spare wheel in the vehicle when it is dry.
Otherwise, moisture may get into the vehicle.
X
Unscrew the valve cap from the valve.
i Fully deflating the tyre can take a few
minutes.
Flat tyre
Flat tyre
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Ra
TIREFIT kit
emergency spare wheel
RMOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) (Y page 289)
Ran
i Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOExtended tyres.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
properties, e.g. winter tyres. You can obtain
a TIREFIT kit from a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, for example.
Vehicles with AIRMATIC: make sure that
"normal" level is selected (Y page 167).
X Stop the vehicle as far away as possible
from traffic on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X
X
Move the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X
Switch off the engine.
Vehicles without KEYLESS-GO: remove
the key from the ignition lock.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: open the
driver's door.
The on-board electronics have status 0,
which is the same as the key having been
removed.
X Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: remove the
Start/Stop button from the ignition lock
(Y page 129).
X
All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area whilst a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X Place the warning triangle (Y page 278) a
suitable distance away. Observe legal
requirements.
X
TIREFIT kit
Using the TIREFIT kit
You can use the TIREFIT kit to seal small
punctures, particularly those in the tyre tread.
You can use TIREFIT at outside temperatures
down to -20 †.
G Risk of accident
In the following situations, your safety is at
particular risk as tyre sealant is unable to provide sufficient breakdown assistance:
Rthere
are cuts or punctures in the tyre
greater than 4 mm.
Rthe wheel rim is damaged.
Ryou have driven at very low tyre pressures
or on a flat tyre.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Breakdown assistance
Screw the valve insert back into the valve.
X Screw the valve cap back on.
X
281
Flat tyre
282
If you get TIREFIT on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle, the accompanying "max. 80 km/h" sticker and the
tyre inflation compressor from the stowage
well underneath the boot floor
(Y page 279).
Breakdown assistance
X
Pull connector ? with the cable and hose
A out of the housing.
X Screw hose A onto flange B of tyre sealant bottle :.
X Place tyre sealant bottle : head downwards into recess ; of the tyre inflation
compressor.
X
Affix part : of the sticker within the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part ; of the sticker near the valve
on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
G Risk of injury
TIREFIT must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes or clothing.
RIf TIREFIT comes into contact with your
eyes or skin, immediately rinse thoroughly
with clean water.
RChange out of clothing which has come into
contact with TIREFIT immediately.
RIf an allergic reaction occurs, consult a doctor immediately.
Keep TIREFIT away from children.
RIf TIREFIT is swallowed, immediately rinse
your mouth out thoroughly and drink plenty
of water.
RDo not induce vomiting. Consult a doctor
immediately.
RDo not inhale TIREFIT fumes.
i If TIREFIT leaks out, allow it to dry. It can
then be removed like a layer of film.
Remove the cap from valve C on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose D onto valve C.
X Insert plug ? into the cigarette lighter
socket (Y page 258) or into a 12 V socket
in your vehicle (Y page 258).
X Turn the key to position 1(Y page 129) in
the ignition lock.
X Press on/off switch = on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated.
X
Flat tyre
pressure can briefly rise to approximately
500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tyre inflation compressor during this phase.
X
Allow the tyre inflation compressor to run
for five minutes. The tyre should then have
attained a pressure of at least 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi).
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
been achieved after five minutes, see
(Y page 283).
If a pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi) has
not been achieved after five minutes, see
(Y page 283).
Tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi) is not reached
If, after five minutes, a pressure of 180 kPa
(1.8 bar/26 psi) has not been achieved:
X Press the on/off switch on the tyre inflation
compressor to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Unscrew the filler hose from the valve.
X Very slowly drive forwards or reverse
approximately 10 m.
X Pump up the tyre again.
G Risk of accident
If after five minutes a pressure of 180 kPa
(1. 8 bar/26 psi) cannot be achieved, the tyre
is too severely damaged.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tyre pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi) is reached
Press the on/off switch on the tyre inflation
compressor to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Remove the tyre sealant bottle from the
wheel.
X
! After use, excess TIREFIT may run out of
the filler hose. This may cause stains.
Therefore, place the filler hose in the plastic
bag which contained the TIREFIT kit.
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Pull away immediately.
X
G Risk of accident
Do not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
The "max. 80 km/h" label must be affixed in
the driver's field of vision.
The vehicle's handling characteristics may be
affected.
X
Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the tyre inflation compressor.
G Risk of accident
If the tyre pressure is less than 130 kPa
(1.3 bar/20 psi), the tyre is too severely damaged. Do not drive any further. Consult a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular,
work relevant to safety or on safety-related
systems must be carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
Breakdown assistance
i First, TIREFIT is pumped into the tyre. The
283
Flat tyre
Breakdown assistance
284
X
Correct the tyre pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/20 psi) (for the values,
see the fuel filler flap).
X
To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the tyre inflation compressor.
X
To reduce the tyre pressure: press pressure release button E next to pressure
gauge F.
Stow the tyre sealant bottle, the tyre inflation compressor and the warning triangle.
X Drive to the nearest workshop and have the
tyre changed there.
X Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced as
soon as possible at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
X
H Environmental note
Have the used tyre sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X
Have the tyre sealant bottle replaced every
four years at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Changing a wheel and fitting the spare
wheel
Preparing the vehicle
G Risk of accident
The wheel and tyre size of the emergency
spare wheel/spare wheel may differ to that of
the damaged wheel. When using an emergency spare wheel/spare wheel the handling
characteristics of the vehicle may change.
Adapt your style of driving accordingly.
Never operate the vehicle with more than one
emergency spare wheel/spare wheel that differs in size.
Only use an emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel of a differing size briefly and do not
switch off ESP®.
When using an emergency spare wheel you
must not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
G Risk of accident
Have the emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel replaced with a new wheel as soon as
possible at a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Vehicles without an emergency spare
wheel/spare wheel are not equipped with
a tyre-change tool kit at the factory. For
more information on which tools are
required to perform a wheel change on your
vehicle, e.g. wheel chock, centring pin or
wheel wrench, consult a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Flat tyre
285
Prepare the vehicle as described
(Y page 281).
X Remove the following items from the stowage well under the boot floor:
Rthe emergency spare wheel
Rthe tyre inflation compressor38
Rthe vehicle tool kit
Rthe folding wheel chock
Rthe jack
X
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
Securing the vehicle to prevent it from
rolling away
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the vehicle tool kit
(Y page 279).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
securing measure to prevent the vehicle from
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
On downhill gradients: place chocks or
other suitable items in front of the wheels
of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
X
38 Vehicles
G Risk of injury
The jack is intended only for lifting the vehicle
briefly for wheel changes.
The vehicle must be placed on stands if you
intend to work under it.
Make sure that the jack is placed on a firm,
non-slip, level surface. Do not use wooden
blocks or similar objects as a jack underlay.
The vehicle could otherwise slip off the jack
and seriously injure you.
with a collapsible emergency spare wheel.
Z
Breakdown assistance
X
Flat tyre
286
Do not start the engine at any time while the
wheel is being changed.
Do not lie under the vehicle when it is being
supported by the jack. If you do not raise the
vehicle as described, it could slip off the jack
(e.g. if the engine is started or a door or the
boot lid is opened or closed) and seriously
injure you.
G Risk of accident
Breakdown assistance
If you fail to position the jack correctly, the
vehicle may:
Rslip
off the jack
you or others
Rbe damaged.
Therefore, make sure that the jack is positioned correctly in the respective jacking
points. Before positioning the jack, remove
any dirt that may have collected in the jacking
points. Please note that you must position the
jack in the opening of the jacking point.
Rinjure
X
Using wheel wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
The jacking points for the jack are located
behind the wheel housings of the front wheels
and in front of the wheel housings of the rear
wheels (arrows).
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned directly under the jacking point.
X Turn crank ? clockwise until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn crank ? until the tyre is raised a maximum of 3 cm from the ground.
X
Removing a wheel
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repositioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
Flat tyre
G Risk of accident
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel. Other wheel bolts could
work loose or damage the brake system.
Do not tighten the wheel bolts completely
while the vehicle is still jacked up. The vehicle
could topple off the jack.
X
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt completely.
X Screw centring pin : into the thread
instead of the wheel bolt.
X Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
X
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
! AMG vehicles: during removal and repositioning of the wheel, the wheel rim can
strike the ceramic-brake disc and damage
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or dirt.
The threads of the wheel bolts and wheel
hubs could otherwise be damaged when
the bolts are tightened.
X
Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G Risk of accident
Replace damaged or corroded wheel bolts.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. This could
cause the bolts to loosen in the wheel hub.
G Risk of accident
If a wheel hub thread is damaged, you must
not drive the vehicle any further. Consult a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre or Service 24h for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Slide the emergency spare wheel onto the
centring pin and push it on.
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X Unscrew the centring pin.
X Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is fingertight.
X Vehicles with a collapsible emergency
spare wheel: inflate the collapsible emerX
Z
Breakdown assistance
it. Therefore, take precautions and get a
second person to assist you. Alternatively,
you can use a second centring pin.
287
Flat tyre
288
gency spare wheel (Y page 288) and then
lower the vehicle (Y page 288).
! Do not operate the tyre inflation com-
pressor for longer than eight minutes at a
time without a break. It may otherwise
overheat.
The tyre inflation compressor can be operated again once it has cooled down.
or
X
Vehicles with a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel: lower the vehicle
(Y page 288)
Pump the tyre to the specified tyre pressure.
The specified tyre pressure is printed on
the yellow label of the emergency spare
wheel.
X When the specified tyre pressure has been
reached, press on/off switch A on the
electric air pump to 0.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
off.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock.
X
Inflating the collapsible emergency
spare wheel
Breakdown assistance
G Risk of accident
Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel
before lowering the vehicle. You could otherwise damage the wheel rim.
If the tyre pressure is higher than the specified pressure, press pressure release button ; until the correct tyre pressure has
been reached.
X Unscrew union nut : on the air hose from
the valve.
X Screw the valve cap onto the collapsible
emergency spare wheel valve again.
X Stow plug ? and the air hose in the lower
section of the pump housing.
X Stow the tyre inflation compressor in the
designated place in the vehicle.
X
Pull plug ? and the air hose out of the
housing.
X Remove the cap from the valve on the collapsible emergency spare wheel.
X Screw union nut : on the air hose onto the
valve.
X Make sure on/off switch A of the tyre
inflation compressor is set to 0.
X Insert plug ? into the socket of the cigarette lighter (Y page 258) or into a 12 V
power socket (Y page 258) in your vehicle.
X
Make sure that the key is in position
1(Y page 129) in the ignition lock.
X Press on/off switch A on the tyre inflation
compressor to I.
The tyre inflation compressor is switched
on. The tyre is inflated. The tyre pressure is
read at pressure gauge =.
X
Lowering the vehicle
G Risk of accident
Inflate the collapsible emergency spare wheel
before lowering the vehicle. You could otherwise damage the wheel rim.
Turn the crank of the jack anti-clockwise
until the vehicle is once again standing
firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
Flat tyre
289
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated
(: to A ). The tightening torque must be
130 Nm.
G Risk of accident
Have the tightening torque checked immediately after a wheel is changed. The wheels
could work loose if they are not tightened to
a torque of 130 Nm.
X
Turn the jack back to its initial position and
store it together with the rest of the vehicle
tool kit in the stowage well under the boot
floor.
For further information on stowing the collapsible emergency spare wheel:
(Y page 280).
i When you are driving with the collapsible
emergency spare wheel fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system or the tyre
pressure monitor cannot function reliably.
Only restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system/tyre pressure monitor when the
defective wheel has been replaced with a
new wheel.
Vehicles with tyre pressure monitor: all fitted wheels must be equipped with functioning sensors and the defective wheel
should no longer be in the vehicle.
MOExtended tyres (tyres featuring run-flat
characteristics) enable your vehicle to continue its journey even with a complete loss of
tyre pressure in one or more tyres.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with the activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or with the activated tyre
pressure monitor.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode depends on the
load in the vehicle. It is 80 km if the vehicle
is partially laden and 30 km if fully laden.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tyre pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
G Risk of accident
The handling characteristics of your vehicle
deteriorate in run-flat mode, for example:
Rwhen
cornering
braking
Rwhen accelerating rapidly
Adapt your driving style accordingly and avoid
sudden changes in direction and sudden
acceleration, as well as driving over obstacles
(i.e. kerbs, potholes), and driving off-road.
This is particularly the case when the vehicle
is heavily laden.
The maximum permissible distance that can
be driven in run-flat mode depends to a large
extent on the loads placed on the vehicle. It
can be shorter due to high speeds, a heavy
load, sudden changes in direction, the road
surface condition, outside temperature, etc.,
or further if you drive carefully and conservatively.
Do not continue to drive in run-flat mode if:
Rwhen
Ryou
Rthe
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Z
Breakdown assistance
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
290
Battery
Ryou
see smoke and smell rubber.
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tyre.
After driving in run-flat mode, you must have
the wheel(s) checked for damage at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. The faulty tyre must be
replaced in every case.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or
on safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
Rthere
i When replacing one or all tyres, make
sure that you only use tyres marked
MOExtended and of the specified size for
the vehicle.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
properties, e.g. winter tyres. A TIREFIT kit
can be obtained from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
Battery
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre if
you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for
a long period of time.
G Risk of injury
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and
smoking are prohibited
when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic.
Avoid contact with the skin,
eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular
gloves, an apron and a face
mask.
Immediately rinse acid
splashes off with clean
water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Important safety notes
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period.
To prevent damage from corrosion, only
replace the battery with one that has a central
ventilation cover.
Only replace a battery with a battery that has
been recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Observe this Owner's Manual.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain pollutants.
It is against the law to dispose of them with the household rubbish. They must be
collected separately and
Battery
G Risk of injury
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event
of an accident.
To prevent acid burns, observe the following
safety notes when handling batteries:
Rdo not lean over the battery.
Rdo not place any metal objects on a battery.
Otherwise, you could cause a short circuit
and the battery's gas mixture could ignite.
Rmake sure that you do not create an electrostatic charge, e.g. by wearing synthetic
clothing or as a result of friction on fabrics.
Therefore, you should not pull or slide the
battery over carpets or other synthetic
materials.
Rnever touch the battery first. To discharge
a possible electrostatic charge, step out of
the vehicle first and touch the bodywork.
Rdo not wipe the battery using a cloth. The
battery may explode as a result of electrostatic charge or due to flying sparks.
may otherwise destroy electronic components, such as the alternator.
i Remove the key if you park the vehicle
and do not require any electrical consumers. The vehicle will then use very little
energy, thus conserving battery power.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you do not
carry out work on batteries yourself, e.g.
removing, charging or replacing. Always have
this work performed at a qualified specialist
workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Installation location of the battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a battery in the
engine compartment. It is located on the front
bulkhead under the filter box on the righthand side of the vehicle when viewed in the
direction of travel.
X Firmly depress the parking brake and move
the transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g.
radio, blower, etc.).
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 129) in
the ignition lock and remove it, or, on vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the
ignition has been switched off
(Y page 129). All indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster must be off.
X Open the bonnet (Y page 266).
! Switch off the engine and remove the key
before disconnecting the terminal clamps
from the battery. On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, make sure that the ignition is
switched off. Check that all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster are off. You
Release clamps ; on filter box :.
X Remove filter box :.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
recycled in an environmentally responsible manner.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, or to a special collection point for old batteries.
291
Battery
292
i Information on disconnecting the battery
(Y page 292).
Disconnecting the battery
Breakdown assistance
G Risk of accident
If the battery is disconnected:
Rthe brake boosting effect will not be available. Greater braking force will then be
required and brake pedal travel will be longer. If necessary, depress the brake pedal
with maximum force.
Rthe transmission is locked in position P.
! Always disconnect the battery in the
order described below. Never mix up the
terminal clamp disconnection/connection
order and never mix up the terminal
clamps. You may otherwise damage the
vehicle electronics.
Removing/fitting the battery
To remove: disconnect the battery
(Y page 292).
X Loosen the bolt which holds the battery in
place.
X Remove the battery.
X To fit: follow the steps described in "To
remove" in reverse order.
X
Charging the battery
G Risk of injury
Only charge the battery in a well-ventilated
area. As the battery is being charged, gases
can escape and generate minor explosions.
This could injure you and other persons or
cause damage to the paintwork or acid corrosion on the vehicle.
You can obtain information about battery
chargers which allow the battery to be
charged while still installed from a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of acid burns during the charging process due to the gases which escape
from the battery. Do not lean over the battery
during the charging process.
: Battery
; Positive terminal
= Negative terminal
? Breather hose
Remove the negative terminal clamp from
the battery.
X Remove the cover from the positive terminal clamp.
X Remove the positive terminal clamp from
the battery.
X Disconnect the breather hose.
X
G Risk of injury
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with the
skin, eyes or clothing.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while still installed.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstart connection point.
Battery
293
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 294).
X Open the bonnet (Y page 266).
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and earth point in the same order
as when connecting the donor battery in
the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 294).
Reconnecting the battery
! Always connect the battery in the order
Breakdown assistance
described below. Never swap the terminal
clamps. You may otherwise damage the
vehicle electronics.
Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g.
radio, blower, etc.).
X Connect the positive terminal clamp and
secure the cover.
X Connect the negative terminal clamp.
X Put the filter box back in place, then clip in
and close the retaining clamps.
X Close the bonnet.
X
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
e.g. if the battery has been reconnected,
you must carry out the following tasks:
Rset
the clock (Y page 206).
the function for automatically folding the exterior mirrors in/out by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 93).
Rreset
Z
Jump-starting
294
Jump-starting
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of acid burns when jump-starting a vehicle due to the gases which escape from
the battery. Do not lean over the battery while the engine is being jump-started.
G Risk of explosion
Breakdown assistance
Gases escaping from the battery during jump-starting may cause minor explosions. Avoid creating sparks. Keep naked flames away from the battery, and do not smoke.
Comply with safety precautions when handling batteries. You will find these under "Battery" in
the index.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts. Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may dam-
age the catalytic converter39 and create a risk of fire.
Do not use a rapid-charging device to start the engine.
Make sure the jump leads are not damaged.
Make sure the jump leads are not touching any other metal objects when they are connected
to the battery.
If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the engine can be jump-started from another vehicle
or from a second battery using jump leads.
Observe the following points:
X The battery is not accessible in all vehicles. If the other vehicle's battery is not accessible,
jump-start the vehicle using a second battery or a jump-starting device.
X Only jump-start the vehicle when the engine is cold and the catalytic converter system has
cooled down40 .
X Do not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
X Jump-starting may only be performed from batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
X Only use jump leads that have a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps.
X Make sure that the jump leads cannot come into contact with parts, such as the pulley or
the fan. These parts move when the engine is started and while it is running.
X If the battery is fully discharged, leave the battery that is being used to jump-start connected
for a few minutes before attempting to start. This charges the empty battery a little.
i Jump leads and further information about jump-starting can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Make sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
Apply the parking brake firmly.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers (e.g. radio, blower, etc.).
X Open the bonnet (Y page 266).
X
X
39 Only
40 Only
vehicles with a petrol engine.
vehicles with a petrol engine.
Position number B identifies the charged battery of the other vehicle or an equivalent jumpstarting device.
X Slide cover : of positive terminal ; in the direction of the arrow.
X Connect positive terminal ; on your vehicle to positive terminal = of donor battery B
using the jump lead, beginning with your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal ? of donor battery B to earth point A of your vehicle using
the jump lead, connecting the jump lead to donor battery B first.
X Start the engine.
X First remove the jump lead from earth point A and negative terminal ?, then from positive
terminal ; and positive terminal =, each time disconnecting from the battery on your own
vehicle first.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
Towing and tow-starting
Important safety notes
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing and tow-starting.
G Risk of accident
If you tow the vehicle, you must use a rigid
towing bar if:
Rthe engine is not running.
Rthere is a brake system malfunction.
Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply
or the vehicle's electrical system.
The power steering and the brake force booster do not work when the engine is not running. You will then need considerably more
force to steer and to brake and the brake
pedal travel will be longer. If necessary,
depress the brake pedal with maximum force.
Before towing away, make sure that the steering can be moved and is not locked.
If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
Z
295
Breakdown assistance
Towing and tow-starting
296
Towing and tow-starting
Deactivate tow-away protection
(Y page 64) before the vehicle is towed.
G Risk of accident
The vehicle is braked when the HOLD function
or DISTRONIC PLUS is activated. Therefore,
deactivate HOLD and DISTRONIC PLUS if the
vehicle is to be towed.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
Breakdown assistance
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum
of 50 km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must
not be exceeded.
For towing distances over 50 km, the entire
vehicle must be lifted up and transported.
Fitting/removing the towing eye
Fitting the towing eye
X
Remove the towing eye from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 279).
! Only secure the tow rope or towing bar to
G Risk of injury
The exhaust tail pipe may be hot. You could
burn yourself if you touch the tail pipe. Be
particularly careful when removing the rear
cover.
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are located in the bumpers. They are at the
front and at the rear, under the covers.
the towing eyes. The vehicle may otherwise
be damaged.
as this could damage the vehicle. If in
doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! Pull away smoothly when towing away or
tow-starting a vehicle. If the tractive power
is too high, the vehicles could be damaged.
! To tow vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use
the key instead of the Start/Stop button.
The automatic transmission may otherwise
switch to position P when you open the
driver's or front-passenger door which
could damage the transmission.
! Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow-started. The transmission
may otherwise be damaged.
The automatic transmission must be in position N when the vehicle is being towed.
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2
Rcannot shift the automatic transmission to
position N
i Switch off the automatic locking feature
(Y page 74) before the vehicle is towed. You
could otherwise be locked out when pushing or towing the vehicle.
Towing eye covers (example)
Towing and tow-starting
297
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 101).
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X When leaving the vehicle take the key or
the KEYLESS-GO key with you.
Towing eye covers (AMG vehicles)
Pull cover : out of the bumper in the
direction of the arrow by inserting your fingers into the recess.
X Press the mark on cover ; inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X
X
X
Take cover ; off the opening.
Screw the towing eye in clockwise to the
stop and tighten it.
Removing the towing eye
X
Loosen the towing eye and unscrew it.
Place the towing eye in the vehicle tool kit.
X Position the top of cover : in the bumper
and press it in at the bottom until it
engages.
X Attach cover ; to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
Only possible on vehicles without
4MATIC.
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 295).
Towing the vehicle with both axles on
the ground
It is important that you observe the safety
instructions when towing away your vehicle
(Y page 295).
G Risk of accident
The power steering and the brake force booster do not work when the engine is not running. You will then need much more effort to
brake and steer the vehicle. Adapt your style
of driving accordingly.
The automatic transmission automatically
shifts to position P when you open the driver's
or front-passenger door or when you remove
the key from the ignition lock. In order to
ensure that the automatic transmission stays
in position N when towing the vehicle, you
must observe the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary and
the key in the ignition lock is in position 0.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
On vehicles with KEYLESS-GO, use the key
instead of the Start/Stop button
(Y page 129).
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X
Z
Breakdown assistance
X
Electrical fuses
298
Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 101).
X Leave the key in position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X
i When towing with the hazard warning
Breakdown assistance
lamps switched on, use the combination
switch as usual to signal a change of direction. In this case, only the turn signals for
the desired direction flash. When the combination switch is reset, the hazard warning
lamps start flashing again.
Transporting the vehicle
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transporting
purposes.
X Vehicles with automatic transmission:
turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Shift the automatic transmission to position N.
G Risk of fire
Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have the
correct fuse rating for the systems concerned. Do not attempt to repair or bridge
faulty fuses. Otherwise, a circuit overload
could cause a fire. Have the cause traced and
rectified at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and value. The fuse ratings are listed in the fuse allocation chart. A MercedesBenz Service Centre will be happy to advise
you.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
As soon as the vehicle is loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the parking brake.
X Turn the key in the ignition lock to position
0 and remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels
or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle
such as axle or steering components. Otherwise, the vehicle could be damaged.
Electrical fuses
Important safety notes
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions will
fail.
Before changing a fuse
Park the vehicle and apply the parking
brake.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
Rfuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
Rfuse box in the boot on the right when
viewed in the direction of travel
The fuse allocation chart is located in the
vehicle tool kit (Y page 279) in the stowage
compartment under the boot floor.
Electrical fuses
Fuse box in the engine compartment
X
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
turned off.
299
Fuse box in the boot
X
Open the boot lid (Y page 75).
G Risk of injury
X
Open the bonnet (Y page 266).
To open: release cover : at the top right
and left-hand sides with a flat object.
X Open cover : downwards in the direction
of the arrow.
X
Remove any existing moisture from the
fuse box using a dry cloth.
X Take lines ; from the guides.
X Move aside lines ;. Route the lines behind
connection = to do this.
X To open: open clamps :.
X Remove the fuse box cover forwards.
X
To close: check whether the rubber seal is
lying correctly in the cover.
X Insert the cover at the rear of the fuse box
into the retainer.
X Fold down the cover and close clamps :.
X Secure lines ; in the guides.
X
! The cover must be fitted properly, other-
wise moisture or dirt could impair the function of the fuses.
X
Close the bonnet (Y page 267).
Z
Breakdown assistance
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
turned off and the key is pulled out of the ignition lock before you open the cover of the fuse
box. Otherwise, the windscreen wipers and
the wiper rods above the cover could be set
in motion. This could lead to you or others
being injured by the wiper rods.
300
301
302
302
302
303
305
309
310
Wheels and tyres
Vehicle equipment ............................
Important safety notes ....................
Operation ...........................................
Winter operation ...............................
Tyre pressure ....................................
Changing a wheel .............................
Wheel and tyre combinations ..........
302
Operation
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Important safety notes
Wheels and tyres
G Risk of accident
Tyres, wheels or accessories which have not
been approved by Mercedes-Benz for your
vehicle or are not used as they should be, can
impair driving safety. As a result, you could
cause an accident. Before purchasing and
using them, enquire about their suitability,
legal stipulations and factory recommendations at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted, nor is the use of
spacer plates or brake dust shields. This invalidates the General Operating Permit for the
vehicle.
i Further information about tyres and
wheels can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Operation
Notes on driving
RWhile
driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or tyres are damaged.
If you suspect that a tyre is defective,
reduce your speed immediately. Stop the
vehicle as soon as possible to check the
wheels and tyres for damage. Hidden tyre
damage could also be causing the unusual
handling characteristics. If you find no
signs of damage, have the wheels and tyres
examined at a specialist workshop, for
example at a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
RWhen parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb
or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over kerbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse
angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the
sidewalls, can get damaged.
Notes on regularly inspecting wheels
and tyres
RRegularly
check the wheels and tyres of
your vehicle for damage (e.g. cuts, punctures, tears, bulges on tyres and deformation,
cracks or severe corrosion on wheels), at
least every 14 days, as well as after driving
off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tyre pressure.
RRegularly check the tyre tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the whole
width of the tyre (Y page 303). If necessary, turn the front wheels to full lock in
order to inspect the inner side of the tyre
surface.
RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not
fit anything onto the valve (such as tyre
pressure monitoring systems) other than
the standard valve cap or other valve caps
approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle.
RRegularly check the pressure of all the tyres
including the emergency spare wheel or the
spare wheel, particularly prior to long trips,
and correct the pressure as necessary
(Y page 305).
Winter operation
G Risk of accident
Bear in mind that:
Rtyre
grip decreases rapidly on wet roads
when the tread depth is less than 3 mm.
Thus, you should replace tyres that have
insufficient tread.
Rwinter tyres should be replaced when the
tread depth is 4 mm or less as they no longer provide adequate grip.
Rthe tread on a tyre may not wear evenly.
Thus, you should regularly check the tread
depth and the condition of the tread across
the entire width of all tyres. If necessary,
turn the front wheels to full lock in order to
inspect the tyre tread more easily.
Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident due to the reduced
grip of the tyres on the road.
Notes on selecting, fitting and replacing tyres
ROnly
fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
ROnly fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RAfter fitting new tyres, run them in at moderate speeds for the first 100 km, as they
only reach their full performance after this
distance.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth, as this significantly reduces
the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
RReplace the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear. This also applies to
the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat
characteristics)
MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) allow you to continue driving the
vehicle even when one or more tyres lose all
air pressure.
MOExtended tyres may only be used in conjunction with the activated tyre pressure loss
warning system or with the activated tyre
pressure monitor and on wheels specifically
tested by Mercedes-Benz.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with the TIREFIT
kit if you fit tyres that do not feature runflat properties, e.g. winter tyres. You can
obtain a TIREFIT kit from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, for example.
You will find notes on driving with a flat tyre
in the "Breakdown assistance" section
(Y page 289).
Winter operation
Please bear the following in mind
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 309).
Driving with summer tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, summer tyres
lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power – change the tyres on your
vehicle to M+S tyres. Using summer tyres at
very cold temperatures could cause tears to
form, thereby damaging them permanently.
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept responsibility
for this type of damage.
M+S tyres
At temperatures below +7 †, use winter tyres
or all-season tyres. Both types of tyre are
identified by the M+S marking.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Tyre tread
303
Winter operation
304
Only winter tyres bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tyres will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter, as these tyres
have been designed specifically for driving on
snow.
Use M+S tyres of the same make and tread
on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Wheels and tyres
G Risk of accident
M+S tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced. They are no longer
suitable for winter use and can no longer provide sufficient grip. This could cause you to
lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tyres you have
fitted.
If you fit M+S tyres which have a lower maximum permissible speed than that of the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign in the
driver's field of vision. This can be obtained
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent SPEEDTRONIC so that it
does not exceed the maximum permissible
speed for the M+S tyres(Y page 164).
When you have fitted the M+S tyres:
X
X
Check the tyre pressures (Y page 305).
Restart the tyre pressure monitor
(Y page 308).
G Risk of accident
If you fit the spare wheel when driving with M
+S tyres, bear in mind that driving stability will
be impaired due to unstable cornering characteristics caused by the different tyres. You
should therefore adapt your driving style and
drive carefully.
Have the spare wheel replaced at the nearest
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. Mercedes-Benz
recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular,
work relevant to safety or on safety-related
systems must be carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Snow chains
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specially approved for your vehicle
by Mercedes-Benz, or that are of a corresponding standard of quality.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Ryou
may not attach snow chains to all
wheel-tyre combinations; see the information under "Wheels and tyres" in the "Technical data" section.
Rsnow chains must not be fitted to emergency spare wheels, e.g. a "Minispare" or
collapsible emergency spare wheel.
Ronly fit snow chains in pairs and to the rear
wheels, even on vehicles with 4MATIC.
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
! Vehicles with steel wheels
If you wish to fit snow chains to steel
wheels, make sure that you remove the
respective wheels' hubcaps first. The hubcaps may otherwise be damaged.
On vehicles with AIRMATIC, you must drive at
raised vehicle level if snow chains have been
fitted (Y page 167).
Do not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
i You may wish to deactivate
ESP®(Y page 58) when pulling away with
snow chains fitted. This way you can allow
the wheels to spin in a controlled manner,
Tyre pressure
305
achieving an increased driving force (cutting action).
Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure specifications
Instead of the complete tyre size, the rim
diameter alone, for example R16, may be listed.
Rim diameter : is part of the tyre size and
can be found on the tyre sidewall.
G Risk of accident
Tyre pressure that is either too high or too low
has a negative effect on the vehicle's driving
safety, which could lead you to cause an accident. Therefore, you should regularly check
the pressure of all the tyres, particularly prior
to long trips, and correct the pressure as necessary.
If a tyre size precedes a tyre pressure, the tyre
pressure information following is only valid
for that tyre size.
To test tyre pressure, use a suitable pressure
gauge. The outer appearance of a tyre does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the
tyre pressure. On vehicles fitted with the electronic tyre pressure monitor, the tyre pressure can be checked using the on-board computer.
G Risk of accident
Do not fit anything else to the tyre valve other
than the standard valve cap. In particular, retZ
Wheels and tyres
You will find a table of tyre pressures for various operating conditions on the inside of
your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
The applicable value for the emergency spare
wheel is stated on the spare wheel and in the
technical data section.
For trailer towing, adjust the tyre pressure of
the rear tyres to the maximum tyre pressure
value stated on the table inside the fuel filler
flap.
The load conditions "partially laden" and "fully
laden" are defined in the table for different
numbers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The actual number of seats may vary –
for more information please refer to the vehicle's registration documents.
If no other data is stated, the tyre pressures
specified on the fuel filler flap apply for all
tyres approved for this vehicle.
306
Tyre pressure
rofitted tyre pressure monitors which are
screwed on to the valve may overload it and
cause it to fail. Due to their design, the valve
is kept open continuously, which may lead to
air loss.
G Risk of accident
Tyre pressure loss warning system
Should the tyre pressure drop repeatedly:
Important safety notes
Rcheck
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of
a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multifunction display.
the tyre for foreign bodies.
Rcheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
sure that only a valve cap approved
by Mercedes-Benz is fitted on the tyre
valve.
Tyre pressures that are too low have a negative effect on vehicle safety, which could lead
you to cause an accident.
Rmake
Wheels and tyres
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
If possible, only correct tyre pressures when
the tyres are cold. The tyres are cold when
the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours or has been driven less than 1.5 km.
Depending on the ambient temperature, the
speed you are driving at and the load on the
tyres, the tyre temperature and thus the tyre
pressure may change by approximately
10 kPa (0.1 bar, 1.5 psi) per 10 †. Take this
into account when checking the pressure of
warm tyres and only correct it if it is too low
for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
increased tyre damage
Rhave a negative effect on handling characteristics and thus the driving safety (e.g. by
causing aquaplaning)
Rcause
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. The table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap will help you decide whether the tyre
pressures should be corrected.
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not replace the need to regularly check your
vehicle's tyre pressures, since an even loss of
pressure on several tyres at the same time
cannot be detected by the tyre pressure loss
warning system.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object.
In the event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring
the vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Do
not make any sudden steering movements
when doing so.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow
chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad conditions are wintry.
Ryou are driving on sand or gravel.
Tyre pressure
adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged
the tyre pressure
the wheels or tyres
Rfitted new wheels or tyres
X Before restarting, consult the table of tyre
pressures on the inside of the fuel filler flap
to ensure that the tyre pressure in all four
tyres is set correctly for the respective
operating conditions.
X Observe the notes in the section on tyre
pressures (Y page 305).
Rchanged
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set the
correct tyre pressure.
If an incorrect tyre pressure is set, these
incorrect values will be monitored.
A tyre with insufficient pressure results in
vehicle instability when driving, thus increasing the risk of an accident.
Make sure that the key is in position 2(Y page 129) in the ignition lock.
X Press = or ; on the steering wheel
to select the Serv. menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Tyre pres‐
sure.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator active
Restart with OK message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. now OK? message
appears in the multifunction display.
X Press 9 or : to select Yes.
X Press the a button.
The Run Flat Indicator restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
X
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
or
If the Tyre press. now OK? message
appears, press 9 or : to select
Cancel.
X Press the a button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
X
Tyre pressure monitor
Important safety notes
If a tyre pressure monitor system is fitted, the
vehicle's wheels have sensors fitted that
monitor the tyre pressures in all four tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor warns you if the
pressure drops in one or more of the tyres.
The tyre pressure monitor only functions if
the correct wheel electronics units are fitted
to all wheels.
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. The table
on the inside of the fuel filler flap will help you
decide whether the tyre pressures should be
corrected.
The tyre pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
tyre is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
Z
Wheels and tyres
Ryou
307
Tyre pressure
308
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Do not
make any sudden steering movements when
doing so.
Information on tyre pressures is displayed in
the multifunction display. After a few minutes
of driving, the current tyre pressure of each
tyre is shown in the multifunction display.
i The tyre pressure values indicated by the
Wheels and tyres
on-board computer may differ from those
measured at a filling station with a pressure
gauge. The tyre pressures shown by the onboard computer refer to those measured at
sea level. At high altitudes, the tyre pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge
are higher than those shown by the onboard computer. In this case, do not reduce
the tyre pressures.
i The operation of the tyre pressure monitor can be affected by interference from
radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio
headphones, two-way radios) that may be
being operated in or near the vehicle.
Checking tyre pressure electronically
Make sure that the key is in position 2(Y page 129) in the ignition lock.
X Use the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Use the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure for each wheel
will be displayed in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for longer than
20 minutes, you will see the Tyre pressure
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message.
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
monitor automatically recognises new
wheels or new sensors. As long as a clear
allocation of the tyre pressure values to the
individual wheels is not possible, the Tyre
pressure monitor active message is
shown instead of the tyre pressure display.
The tyre pressures are already being monitored.
i If a spare wheel/emergency spare wheel
is fitted, for a few minutes the system may
continue to show the tyre pressure of the
wheel that has been removed. If this
occurs, note that the value displayed for
the position where the spare tyre is fitted
is not the same as the spare wheel/emergency spare wheel's current tyre pressure.
Tyre pressure monitor warning messages
If the tyre pressure monitor detects a significant pressure loss on one or more tyres, a
warning message is shown in the multifunction display. A warning tone also sounds and
the tyre pressure warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster.
Each tyre that is affected by a significant loss
of pressure is highlighted with a colour.
If the Please correct tyre pressure(s)
message appears in the multifunction display:
X Check the tyre pressure on all four wheels
and correct it if necessary.
i If the wheel positions on the vehicle are
interchanged, the tyre pressures may be
displayed for the wrong positions for a
short time. This is rectified after a few
minutes of driving, and the tyre pressures
are displayed for the correct positions.
Restarting the tyre pressure monitor
When you restart the tyre pressure monitor,
all existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tyre pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tyre pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tyre pressure.
Changing a wheel
(Y page 197).
If you wish to define the new reference values
manually:
Use the table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap to ensure that the tyre pressure is set
correctly in all four tyres for the current
operating conditions.
Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 305).
X Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X
Use the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
X Use the 9 or : button to select
Tyre pressure.
X Press the a button.
The current tyre pressure of the individual
wheels is displayed in the multifunction display or the Tyre pressures will be
displayed after a few minutes of
driving message appears.
X Press the : button.
The Use current pressure values as
new reference values message appears
in the multifunction display.
X
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Press the a button.
The Tyre press. monitor restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tyre
pressures are within the specified range.
The new tyre pressures are then accepted
as reference values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Changing a wheel
Flat tyre
The "Breakdown assistance" section
(Y page 281) contains information and notes
on how to deal with a flat tyre. It also provides
instructions on changing a wheel or fitting the
spare wheel or emergency spare wheel.
Interchanging the wheels
G Risk of accident
Interchange the front and rear wheels only if
they have the same dimensions: for example
size, offset, etc.
After every wheel interchange/change, have
the tightening torque checked at a qualified
specialist workshop that has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
The wheels could work loose if they are not
tightened to a torque of 130 Nm.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use wheel bolts of the
correct size which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, you can interchange the wheels
every 5000 km to 10,000 km depending on
the degree of tyre wear. Do not reverse the
direction of tyre rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is interchanged. Check the tyre pressure and,
Z
Wheels and tyres
i For an overview of the menus, see
309
310
Wheel and tyre combinations
if necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system or the tyre pressure monitor.
! If your vehicle is equipped with the tyre
pressure monitor, there are electronic
components in the wheels.
Fitting tools must not be used in the area
of the valve. Otherwise, the electronic components could be damaged.
Always have the tyres replaced at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
Wheels and tyres
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
You may fit an emergency spare wheel/spare
wheel against the direction of rotation.
Observe the time restriction on use as well as
the speed limitation specified on the emergency spare wheel/spare wheel.
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
Cleaning the wheels
G Risk of accident
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean your
vehicle, in particular the tyres. You could otherwise damage the tyres and cause an accident.
Wheel and tyre combinations
Please bear the following in mind
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These tyres have been specially adapted
for use with the control systems, such as
ABS or ESP®, and are marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tyres with run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
tain AMG tyres)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tyres, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tyre dimension variations could cause the tyres to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tyres or the vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tyres,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Further information about tyres, wheels
and approved combinations can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not
fit used tyres if you have no information
about their previous usage.
Wheel and tyre combinations
311
i You will find a table of tyre pressures on
the inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
For further information on tyre pressure,
see (Y page 305).
i Notes on the vehicle equipment – always
fit the vehicle:
Rwith tyres of the same size on a given axle
(left/right)
the same type of tyres at a given
time (summer tyres, winter tyres,
MOExtended tyres)
Rwith
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres are not
Wheels and tyres
equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle with a TIREFIT kit
if you fit tyres that do not feature run-flat
properties, e.g. winter tyres. You can obtain
a TIREFIT kit from a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre, for example.
i Overview of abbreviations used in the following tyre tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
RFA:
In the following table, the wheel/tyre combinations are allocated to the vehicle models
through variants, e.g. V1, V2 etc.:
V1 CLS 250 CDI41
V2 CLS 35041, CLS 350 CDI41,
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC41
V3 CLS 50041, CLS 500 4MATIC41
V4 CLS 63 AMG
41 BlueEFFICIENCY.
Z
312
Wheel and tyre combinations
Wheels and tyres
Tyres
Summer tyres
Light-alloy wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
BA
245/45 R17 99 Y XL
8.0J x 17 H2 ET 30
#
—
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 Y XL
MOExtended42
8.0J x 17 H2 ET 30
#
—
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 Y XL
8.5J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 Y XL
MOExtended42
8.5J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
—
—
BA
255/40 R18 99 Y XL
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
#
—
BA
255/40 R18 99 Y XL
MOExtended42
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
255/40 R18 99 Y XL
285/35 R18 97 Y43
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
9.5J x 18 H2 ET 48
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
255/40 R18 99 Y XL
MOExtended42
285/35 R18 97 Y
MOExtended42,43
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
9.5J x 18 H2 ET 48
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
255/35 R19 96 Y XL
285/30 R19 98 Y XL43
8.5 J x 19 H2 ET 34.5
9.5 J x 19 H2 ET 48
#
#
#
—
FA
RA
255/35 ZR 19 (96 Y) XL
285/30 ZR19 (98 Y) XL43
9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
—
—
—
#
Winter tyres
Light-alloy wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
BA
245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
8.0J x 17 H2 ET 30
#
—
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 H XL
M+SiMOExtended42, 44
8.0J x 17 H2 ET 30
#
—
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 H XL M+Si
8.5J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
—
—
BA
245/45 R17 99 H XL
M+SiMOExtended42
8.5J x 17 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
—
—
BA
255/40 R18 99 V XL M+Si
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
#
—
42 MOExtended
tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an activated tyre pressure loss warning system.
43 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
44 Not available from the factory.
Wheel and tyre combinations
Winter tyres
Light-alloy wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
BA
255/40 R18 99 V XL
M+SiMOExtended42,44
8.5 J x 18 H2 ET 34.5
#
#
#
—
BA
255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si
9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
—
—
—
#
FA
RA
255/35 R19 96 V XL M+Si
9.0 J x 19 H2 ET 37
10.0 J x 19 H2 ET 47
—
—
—
#
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
T 155/60 R18 107 M
Tyre pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar/61 psi)
4.5 B x 18 H2 ET 36
#
#
#
—
Tyres
Light-alloy wheels
V1
V2
V3
V4
175/50 - 19 97 P
Tyre pressure: 350 kPa (3.5 bar/51 psi)
6.5 B x 19 H2 ET 14
—
—
—
#
285/30 R19 98 V XL
M+Si43
313
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel43
Depending on the country, the engine and the wheels fitted, your vehicle may be equipped
with TIREFIT, a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel or a collapsible emergency spare wheel.
i The specified tyre pressure is printed in yellow on the emergency spare wheel.
42 MOExtended
tyres (tyres featuring run-flat characteristics) only in combination with an activated tyre pressure loss warning system.
44 Not available from the factory.
43 Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Z
Wheels and tyres
Collapsible emergency spare wheel43
314
315
316
316
316
316
318
319
323
326
327
Technical data
Vehicle equipment ............................
Notes on the technical data .............
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Vehicle electronics ...........................
Vehicle identification plates ............
Service products and capacities .....
Vehicle data ......................................
Boot lid opening dimensions ...........
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview) .....................................
316
Vehicle electronics
Vehicle equipment
i This manual describes all the standard
and optional equipment of your vehicle
available at the time of publication of the
Owner's Manual. Country-specific differences are possible. Please note that your
vehicle may not be equipped with all features described. This also applies to safetyrelevant systems and functions.
Notes on the technical data
i The technical data was determined in
Technical data
accordance with EC Directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. Therefore, the data may differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
You can find technical data on the Internet at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories which have
been specifically approved for your vehicle for
their reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to evaluate other parts. MercedesBenz therefore accepts no responsibility for
the use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles, even if they have been independently or
officially approved.
In Germany and some other countries, certain
parts are only officially approved for installation or modification if they comply with legal
requirements. All genuine Mercedes-Benz
parts meet this requirement. The use of nonapproved parts may invalidate the vehicle's
general operating permit. This is the case if:
Rthey
cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted.
Rother road users could be endangered.
Rthe emission or noise levels are adversely
affected.
The use of non-approved parts could affect
your vehicle's operating safety. Therefore,
Mercedes-Benz recommends genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts and conversion parts
and accessories that have been approved for
your vehicle.
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same warranty applies as for new parts.
Always specify the vehicle identification number and engine number when ordering genuine Mercedes-Benz parts. You will find these
numbers on the vehicle identification plates
on your vehicle, for example (Y page 318).
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
G Risk of accident
Only have work on the engine electronics and
related components carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary
specialist knowledge and tools to carry out
the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Otherwise, the vehicle's
roadworthiness could be affected.
! Only have maintenance work on the
engine electronics and its associated parts,
such as control units, sensors and connector leads, carried out at a qualified special-
Vehicle electronics
ist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Vehicle components may otherwise wear more quickly and the vehicle's
operating permit may be invalidated.
317
The following aerial positions may be used if
RF transmitters have been properly installed:
Retrofitting of two-way radios and
mobile phones (RF transmitters)
! Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified
specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose.
The transmission output at the aerial base
must not exceed the maximum values below.
Waveband
Maximum transmission output
(PEAK)
Short wave (f <
54 MHz)
100 W
4 m waveband
30 W
2 m waveband
50 W
Trunked radio/Tetra 35 W
70 cm waveband
35 W
GSM 900/AMPS
10 W
GSM 1800
10 W
UMTS
10 W
: Front roof area46
; Rear roof area
= Rear wing47
? Boot lid
G Risk of accident
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
cause the vehicle electronics to malfunction.
The vehicle's operating safety and thus your
own safety are impaired.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose.
G Risk of injury
Incorrect retrofitting of RF transmitters can
lead to increased electromagnetic radiation in
the vehicle interior. Using an exterior aerial
takes into account current scientific discussions relating to the possible health hazards
that may result from electromagnetic fields.
Have aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equipment installed at a qualified specialist workshop. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose.
45 ISO/TS
21609 – Technical Specification for Road Vehicles (EMC) guidelines for installation of aftermarket
radio frequency transmitting equipment.
46 Vehicles with sliding sunroof: observe the roof's sweep.
47 Recommended installation position: on the side which faces the centre of the road.
Z
Technical data
Use the Technical Specification
ISO/TS 2160945 implementation regulation
when retrofitting RF (radio frequency) transmitters.
If your vehicle has fittings for two-way radio
equipment (e.g. taxis, hire cars or official vehicles), use the power supply or aerial connections intended for use with the basic wiring.
Be sure to observe the manufacturer's additional instructions when installing the fittings.
Vehicle identification plates
318
Deviations with respect to aerial locations,
output and frequencies must be approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
There is no restriction for aerial positions in
the outer area of the vehicle for these wavebands: trunked radio/Tetra, 70 cm waveband, GSM 900/AMPS, GSM 1800 and
UMTS.
Legal provisions for fittings must be
observed.
RF transmitters with a maximum transmission output of 100 mW (PEAK) may be used
in the vehicle without restrictions.
! The operating permit may be invalidated
if the instructions for installation and use of
RF transmitters are not observed, e.g.
approved wavebands, maximum output
and aerial positions on the vehicle.
Technical data
Vehicle identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN) and
paint code number
X
Open the front right-hand door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
Vehicle identification plate illustration
: Vehicle identification plate
; Vehicle manufacturer
= EU type approval number
? Vehicle identification number (VIN)
A Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight
B Maximum permissible front axle load
C Maximum permissible rear axle load
D Paint code
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
In addition to being stamped on the vehicle
identification plate, the vehicle identification
number (VIN) is also stamped onto the vehicle
body.
It is located on the floor in front of the frontpassenger seat.
Service products and capacities
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold floor covering : upwards.
You will see vehicle identification number
(VIN) ;.
X
Engine number
The engine number is stamped on the crankcase. More information can be obtained from
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Service products and capacities
319
G Risk of injury
When handling, storing and disposing of any
service products, please observe the relevant
regulations, as you could otherwise endanger
yourself and others.
Keep service products away from children.
To protect your health, do not allow service
products to come into contact with your eyes
or open wounds. See a doctor immediately if
any service product is swallowed.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Important safety notes
Rfuels
(e.g. petrol, diesel)
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen washer fluid
Vehicle components and their respective
lubricants must match. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use products that have
been tested and specially approved by
Mercedes-Benz. These products are listed in
this Mercedes-Benz Owner's Manual in the
relevant section.
You can recognise service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations that
relate to a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet number (such
as MB 229.5) have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Fuel
Important safety notes
G Risk of explosion
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Switch off the engine and the auxiliary heating
before refuelling.
G Risk of injury
Do not come into contact with fuels.
It is hazardous to your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuels or you
breathe in fuel vapours.
Tank capacity
Total capacity
CLS 50048
CLS 500 4MATIC48
Total capacity
CLS 63 AMG
80 l
66 l49
48 BlueEFFICIENCY
49 Optional:
80 l
Z
Technical data
Service products include the following:
320
Service products and capacities
Total capacity
all other models
59 l50
Reserve
CLS 50048
CLS 500 4MATIC48
Approximately 9 l
Reserve
CLS 63 AMG
Approximately 14 l
Reserve
all other models
Approximately 8 l
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even small
amounts of the wrong fuel result in damage
to the fuel system and the engine.
Technical data
Further information on refuelling and on fuels
(Y page 142).
Notes on fuel consumption
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in
the following situations:
Rat
very low temperatures
Rin urban traffic
Ron short trips
Rin mountainous terrain
i Only for certain countries: the respective
current consumption and emission values
of your vehicle can be found in the COC
papers (EC CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These documents are supplied when
the vehicle is delivered.
The consumption figures for vehicles up to
the EURO 4 standard have been determined in accordance with EU Directive
80/1268/EEC while figures for vehicles
complying with the EURO 5 standard or
higher have been determined in accordance with Regulation (EC) No. 715/2007,
in each case based on the currently appli-
50 Optional:
80 l with 9 l reserve.
48 BlueEFFICIENCY
cable version. Deviations from these values
may occur under normal operating conditions.
! Do not use any fuel additives, as they can
cause malfunctions and engine damage.
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible for
global warming (the greenhouse effect). Your
vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly related to
fuel consumption and therefore depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving style
Rother non-technical factors, such as environmental influences or road conditions
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
Engine oil
Please bear the following in mind
The quality of engine oils is decisive for the
function and service life of an engine. After
extensive tests, Mercedes-Benz approves
engine oils which correspond to the current
technical standard.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz approved
engine oils may be used in Mercedes-Benz
engines.
Further information on tested and approved
engine oils can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. MercedesBenz recommends that you have the oil
change carried out at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre. Mercedes-Benz approval is
indicated on the oil container by the inscription "MB Approval" and the corresponding
designation, e.g. MB Approval 229.51.
The table shows which engines oil have been
approved for your vehicle.
Service products and capacities
MB Approval
35051
229.3, 229.5
CLS
CLS 50051
CLS 500 4MATIC51
CLS 63 AMG52
229.5
Diesel engines
MB Approval
228.51,
CLS 250 CDI51
229.31, 229.51
51
CLS 350 CDI
CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC51
You can call up an overview of approved
engine oils on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com by entering the designation, e.g. 229.5.
i If the engine oils listed in the table are not
available, you may add a maximum of 1.0 l
of the following engine oils, once only, until
the next oil change:
with a petrol engine53: MB
Approval 229.1 or ACEA A3
Rvehicles with a diesel engine: MB
Approval 229.1 or ACEA C3
Rvehicles
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change
including the oil filter.
Vehicle model
Replacement
amount with oil filter
CLS 250 CDI51
CLS 35051
6.5 l
CLS 350 CDI51
CLS 350 CDI
4MATIC51
8.0 l
CLS 50051
CLS 500 4MATIC51
CLS 63 AMG
8.5 l
Additives
! Do not use additives in engine oil. This
could damage the engine.
Engine oil viscosity
Viscosity describes the flow characteristics
of a fluid. If an engine oil has a high viscosity,
this means that it is thick; a low viscosity
means that it is thin.
Engine oil selection is based on the respective
outside temperatures and in accordance with
the SAE classification (viscosity). The table
below shows you which SAE classifications
are to be used. The low-temperature properties of engine oils can be significantly
impaired during operation due to, for example, ageing or soot and fuel accretion. It is
therefore strongly recommended to observe
regular oil changes using an approved engine
oil with the appropriate SAE classification.
51 BlueEFFICIENCY
52 Restriction:
53 Restriction:
only SAE 0W-40 engine oils may be used.
only SAE 0W-40 engine oils may be used for AMG vehicles.
Z
Technical data
Petrol engines
321
322
Service products and capacities
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
Brake fluid
Technical data
G Risk of accident
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air; this lowers its boiling point.
If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too low,
vapour pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard (e.g. when
driving downhill). This would impair braking
efficiency.
You should have the brake fluid renewed at
regular intervals. The brake fluid change intervals can be found in the Service Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz. Information about approved brake fluids can be obtained from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
i There is usually a notice in the engine
compartment to remind you when the next
brake fluid change is due.
Coolant
Important safety notes
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the
following tasks:
Ranti-corrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
Rantifreeze
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants and on filling can be found in the Mercedes-Benz
Specifications for Service Products, MB
Approval 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com. You can
also consult a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the cooling system will not be
sufficiently protected from corrosion, and
the boiling point will be too low.
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant will be around 130 †.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
around -37 †.
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to - 45 †); otherwise, heat will not be
dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor
which has been approved for Mercedes-Benz.
! The engine cooling system is filled with
coolant that must be renewed after 15
years, or after 250,000 km at the latest.
Vehicle data
Vehicle data
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle data, CLS 350 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle height
1404 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle weights
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Vehicle weights
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
1735 kg
1890 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Vehicle data, CLS 500 4MATIC BlueEFFICIENCY
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Vehicle data, CLS 500 BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle height
1404 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Z
Technical data
Vehicle dimensions
323
324
Vehicle data
Vehicle weights
Technical data
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
Vehicle weights
1940 kg
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
1905 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Vehicle data, CLS 63 AMG
Vehicle data, CLS 250 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4987 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle height54
1411 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
54 The
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
values specified may differ from the actual values, depending on the tyres, load, optional equipment
and the state of the suspension.
Vehicle data
Vehicle weights
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
325
Vehicle weights
1800 kg
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
1815 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Vehicle data, CLS 350 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle data, CLS 350 CDI 4MATIC
BlueEFFICIENCY
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle length
(ECE)
4940 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
2075 mm
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Vehicle height
1416 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Wheelbase
2874 mm
Technical data
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Z
326
Boot lid opening dimensions
Vehicle weights
Unladen weight (in
accordance with
EC directive)
1875 kg
The unladen weight includes the driver
(68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel
tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment
increase the unladen weight and reduce the
maximum payload.
Maximum roof
load
100 kg
Maximum boot
load
100 kg
Vehicle-specific weight information can be
found on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 318).
Technical data
Boot lid opening dimensions
: Opening height
:
1,628 – 1,643 mm
i The values specified may differ from the
actual values, depending on the tyres, load,
optional equipment and the state of the
suspension.
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
327
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
The 24 GHz radar sensor system requires separate approval for each country. When you are
driving in a country in which the radar sensor system is not approved, you must deactivate
the system using the on-board computer (Y page 210). The current country overview can be
obtained from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Vehicles with navigation system: the radar sensor system is deactivated automatically near
radio telescope facilities.
If
RDISTRONIC
PLUS (Y page 154)
Spot Assist (Y page 183)
RActive Blind Spot Assist(Y page 186)
RPRE-SAFE® Brake (Y page 61)
are activated at this point, a corresponding message appears in the multifunction display to
tell you that the radar sensor system is being switched off.
BAS PLUS (Y page 57) is then also unavailable.
If the deactivation does not occur automatically, you must deactivate the radar sensor system
using the on-board computer (Y page 210).
Vehicles without navigation and vehicles for Australia: you must deactivate the radar
sensor system using the on-board computer when you are near a radio telescope facility
(Y page 210).
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Egypt
–
–
–
Andorra
–
–
–
Australia
Parkes
32°59'59" S,148°15'44" E
10 km
Narrabri
30°18'52" S,149°32'56" E
10 km
Canberra
35°23'54" S,148°58'40" E
3 km
Western Australia
26°37'13" S,117°30'40" E
10 km
Bahrain
–
–
–
Belgium
–
–
–
Bosnia-Herzegovina
–
–
–
Bulgaria
–
–
–
Denmark
–
–
–
Germany
Effelsberg
50°31'32" N,06°53'00" E
6.5 km
Z
Technical data
RBlind
328
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Estonia
–
–
–
Finland
Metsähovi
60°13'04" N,24°23'37" E
7 km
Tuorla
60°24'56" N,22°26'31" E
5 km
Plateau de Bure
44°38'01" N,05°54'26" E
35 km
Floirac
44°50'10" N,00°31'37" W
35 km
Gibraltar
–
–
–
Greece
–
–
–
Cambridge
52°09'59" N,00°02'20" E
9 km
Darnhall
53°09'22" N,02°32'03" W
5 km
Jodrell Bank
53°14'10" N,02°18'26" W
9 km
Knockin
52°47'24" N,02°59'45" W
5 km
Pickmere
53°17'18" N,02°26'38" W
5 km
Ireland
–
–
–
Iceland
–
–
–
Medicina
44°31'14" N,11°38'49" E
20 km
Noto
36°52'34" N,14°59'21" E
8 km
Sardinia
39°29'50" N,09°14'40" E
15 km
Yemen
–
–
–
Jordan
–
–
–
Canada
–
–
–
Qatar
–
–
–
Croatia
–
–
–
Kuwait
–
–
–
Latvia
Ventspils
57°33'12" N,21°51'17" E
8.5 km
Lebanon
–
–
–
Lithuania
–
–
–
Luxembourg
–
–
–
Malaysia
–
–
–
France
Technical data
United Kingdom
Italy
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Malta
–
–
–
Macedonia
–
–
–
Mexico
–
–
–
Mongolia
–
–
–
New Zealand
–
–
–
The Netherlands
–
–
–
Norway
–
–
–
Oman
–
–
–
Austria
–
–
–
Pakistan
–
–
–
Cracow-Fort Skala
50°03'18" N,19°49'36" E
1 km
Torún-Piwnice
52°54'48" N,18°33'30" E
1 km
Portugal
–
–
–
Romania
–
–
–
Dimitrov
56°26'00" N,37°27'00" E
35 km
Kalyazin
57°13'22" N,37°54'01" E
35 km
Pushchino
54°49'00" N,37°40'00" E
35 km
Zelenchukskaya
43°49'53" N,41°35'32" E
35 km
–
–
–
Sweden
Onsala
57°23'45" N,11°55'35" E
12 km
Switzerland
Bleien
47°20'26" N,08°06'44" E
3 km
Singapore
–
–
–
Slovakia
–
–
–
Slovenia
–
–
–
Yebes
40°31'27" N,03°05'22" W
15 km
Robledo
40°25'38" N,04°14'57" W
7 km
South Africa
–
–
–
Syria
–
–
–
Poland
Russia
Saudi Arabia
Spain
Technical data
Country
329
Z
330
24-GHz radar sensor system (country overview)
Technical data
Country
Radio telescope
facilities
Geographical latitude and
longitude
Distance to be
maintained
from the facility
Czech Republic
–
–
–
Turkey
–
–
–
Ukraine
–
–
–
Hungary
Penc
47°47'22" N,19°16'53" E
2 km
USA
–
–
–
United Arab Emirates
–
–
–
Cyprus
–
–
–
331
332